Home

QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User`s Guide

image

Contents

1. 220 00 Subs Drywall Install drywall 18 50 50 909 00 Notes P 12 12 13 1093 Subs Carpet Install carpeting 6 48 50 291 00 Subs Tile amp Counter Install tile or counter 21 59 00 1 239 00 Gans eee Customer Message la 775 503 98 Total 12 420 98 Campbell Heat 13 900 00 12 10 13 1092 Balance Due 12 420 98 Cancel Save Abercrombie Kr 4 522 00 1091 Applying classes With a list of classes in place you can start using those classes in transactions to track your income and expenses For example take a look at this invoice QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 143 Invoice Cook Brian Kitc 1 636 69 12 15 13 1098 Bill To Robson Darci 12 420 98 345 Cherry Lane 12 15 13 1097 Middlefield CA 94482 Natiello Ernesto 2 824 03 12 14 13 1096 Natiello Ernesto 8 656 25 Brian Cook Date P 0 Number 12 15 13 Open balance 12 14 13 1095 Natiello Ernesto 2 080 11 12 14 13 1094 Lew Plumbing C 220 00 12 12 13 1093 Cook Brian Kitchen 5 95 Removal 12 11 13 FC 6 Framing Installation Campbell Heat 13 900 00 z Description Gas Rangetop Double oven Dishwasher Greenhouse Window Subtotal LABOR Removal labor Framing labor Installation labor Quantity Rate __ 247 50 350 00 450 00 475 00 Customer Message 12 1
2. Discount percentage e Date Driven Customers to pay by a certain date o Net due before the The day of the month by which payment is due o Due the next month if issued within If you create an invoice that s due in this number of days then the due date is pushed back a month o Discount percentage is The discount percentage a customer earns for early payment of an invoice or that your business earns for early payment of a bill If there is a discount you must also complete the next field Discount if paid If there is no discount enter zero o Discount if paid before the The number of days within which a customer or your business can pay and receive a discount for early payment Be sure to enter the discount percentage in the previous field Discount percentage QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 40 Payment methods Payment methods categorize payments from your customers For example barter cash check or American Express When you receive payments from your customers you can select a payment method and then sort your deposits by payment method and create reports based on payment method Note If you re using QuickBooks to process credit and debit card transactions you must first set up your Merchant Service account When you open an existing credit card payment method the Merchant Service enabled checkbox is selected This check box must be selected to process the c
3. Petty Cash Bank 500 00 11000 Accounts Receivable Accounts Receivable 93 007 93 shoeboxes and that 5 where the 12000 Undeposited Funds Other Current Asset 2 440 00 Chart of Accounts comes in 12100 Inventory Asset Other Current Asset 28 991 23 12800 Employee Advances Other Current Asset 832 00 r 13100 Pre paid Insurance Other Current Asset 4 050 00 Yo urc h art of accounts is a 13400 Retainage Receivable Other Current Asset 3 703 02 com plete list of a business s 15000 Furniture and Equipment Fixed Asset 34 326 00 gt 15100 Vehicles Fixed Asset 78 936 91 accounts and their balances You 15200 Buildings and Improvements Fixed Asset 325 000 00 A 15300 Construction Equipment Fixed Asset 15 300 00 use it to trac k h ow m uch mon ey 16900 Land Fixed Asset 90 000 00 your company has how much 17000 Accumulated Depreciation Fixed Asset 110 344 60 m 18700 Security Deposits Other Asset 1 720 00 money it owes how much mon ey 20000 Accounts Payable Accounts Payable 26 636 92 is coming in and how much is 20500 QuickBooks Credit Card Credit Card 94 20 20600 CalOil Credit Card Credit Card 382 62 going out 20700 Due to Owner Other Current Liability 0 00 23000 Loan Vehicles Van Long Term Liability 10 501 47 23100 Loan Vehicles Utility Truck Long Term Liability 19 936 91 The Chart of Accounts shows the 23200 Loan Vehicles Pickup Truck Long Term Liability 22 641 00 na
4. Q This video explains how to get reimbursed for expenses http www qpblittlesquare com 2011 06 how do i invoice a customer for expenses QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 128 Assigning costs or time to a job When you plan to charge your customer for the actual time and costs for a job here s what you must do to track the time and costs Billable time Job related purchases Items purchased for a job Subcontracted services Other expenses Freight charges Postage etc Mileage Invoicing for actual costs Record the hours spent on the job using either a weekly timesheet or a single activity entry Be sure to mark each entry as billable and to assign the hours to the customer or if you re tracking by job to the job you are doing for the customer To track billable time see the section on time tracking starting on page 132 Use a bill check or credit card charge to record the purchase On the Items tab enter each item or service you purchased In the Customer Job column be sure to assign each item or service to the customer or if you re tracking by job to the job you are doing for the customer To find out how to enter job related items see the sections on entering bills checks and credit card charges Use a bill check or credit card charge to record the expenses On the Expenses tab enter each expense In the Customer Job column be sure to assign each expense to the customer or i
5. is taxable This item v is taxable QuickBooks tracks the tax you collect in your Sales Tax Payable account Sales Tax Payable Register amp Sales Tax Liability Report Checks to your tax agencies collect tax for and at what rates You do this by creating tax items A tax item represents a single tax rate payable to a single agency In your Items list add an item and for the type choose Sales Tax Item If you need help with adding items check the Help in QuickBooks If you collect for more than one agency create a separate tax item for each agency You can then group the items together so that your customers will only see a single tax rate on your sales forms QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 214 Indicate who and what gets taxed After you set up your tax rates and agencies QuickBooks still needs to know which customers you collect tax from and which items you charge tax for when you make a sale Once you enter this information QuickBooks automatically calculates sales tax whenever you sell a taxable item toa taxable customer For each item and customer there s a Taxable checkbox It s up to you to know if you need to use it or not If your customer is purchasing items from you for resale they may not be taxable Also the items you sell products and services may or may not be taxable You may sell services that are not taxed and products that are Again this is where knowing the rules for the
6. 10 Click OK to add the costs you selected to the invoice 11 Before recording the invoice press P and then click Preview to see what will appear on the printed invoice If you see any job costs that should not be on the invoice close the Print Preview window On the invoice select the cost and choose Edit gt Delete Line Why you need to do this You can use a job cost only once on an invoice When you record the job cost on an invoice QuickBooks automatically removes the cost from the Choose Billable Time and Costs window This is a precaution against double billing your customer for the cost The original record for the cost timesheet single activity entry bill check or credit card charge still remains in your financial records it s just that you ll no longer see the cost listed in the Choose Billable Time and Costs window What if you record the invoice by mistake To reinstate a cost after you record the invoice edit the original record of the cost For time entries click the Billable field and click OK to re record the entry For bills checks and credit card charges change something on the form change it back and click OK Doing this restores the cost to the Choose Billable Time and Costs window What if you want more than one summary If you want the printed invoice to show several cost summaries instead of a single summary of all the costs here s what to do To display multiple cost summaries on an invoice
7. 3 Choose an item from the Row Axis list 4 Click OK The Custom Summary Report changes to show your choice by row e Change the subtotaling of transactions You can group and subtotal the data on a transaction detail report 1 Create a transaction detail report for example Transaction Detail by Date 2 On the report buttonbar choose an item from the Total By list e Change the sort order of transactions Transactions usually appear in date order earliest first within a specified group on a report You can sort the transactions by any column on the report 1 Create a transaction detail report 2 On the report buttonbar choose Totals only from the Total By list QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 229 3 To sort the transactions by amount for example click the word Amount at the top of the Amount column second from the right or close to it To reverse the sort order for example by smallest to biggest amount click the word again Viewing more of a report on your screen To view more of a report that s too long or wide to fit on the screen click the vertical and horizontal scroll bars at the right and bottom of the report window You can also see more of a report by clicking these checkboxes on the button bar e Hide Header Hide everything in the report header company name report title date range today s date etc This button does not affect the printed report Click the checkbox again to display the
8. QuickBooks removes the attachment from this transaction or record and deletes it from your Attached Documents Library To preview and open an attachment 1 Choose the attachment you want to preview QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 238 2 Click down at the bottom right of the Attachment window A smallish preview of the attachment opens 3 If you want to open the attachment in its native application or Preview if its an image click Open with in the preview window To scan an attachment 1 Inthe record or transaction click 0 i 2 Click down at the second from the bottom right of the Attachment window The scan window opens 3 Choose the options and settings for the scan Tip Give the scanned file a meaningful name now so you can find it easily later Another Tip If you want OCR to be able to read this scan and let you search for terms inside it later on set the resolution to at least 300 dpi 4 Click Scan After your scanner s finished scanning the Scan window closes and your new attachment shows up in the Attach Documents window Tips and tricks for attaching files in QuickBooks and using the Attached Documents Library e If you need other people to access attachments in QuickBooks multi user mode you ve got to do a couple of things o Set up your Attached Documents Library on a shared drive o Grant your users access to the records and transactions that have attachments you want those users
9. e If you have a sales form open click the Print button at the top of the form e If you re creating several forms like estimates and invoices you can select Print later button on the form and then print them all at one time with File gt Print Forms Printing forms credit memos estimates invoices purchase orders and sales receipts If you need to change how a form looks when it s printed use Layout Designer You can customize a form by adding a logo change margins and using many other design features Print one form 1 Find the form you want to print If you need help try the Transaction Center 2 On the form window press Command P or click Print at the top of the window A Print window appears with options that will be familiar to you if you ve printed from other Mac software 3 Click Print Print a group of forms 1 For each form you want to print select the Print later button at the bottom of the e3 e window 23 ES 2 When you re ready to print choose File gt Print Forms and the type of form you want to print If you want to print different form types at once choose Multiple Forms 3 Optional Click Print Labels to print labels for the forms you re printing Note that if you re printing labels for your forms you must print the labels before the forms 4 Click Print QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 248 Click Print A Print window appears with options that will be familiar t
10. 1 Inthe Choose Billable Time and Costs window select the costs for the first summary Select the Print selected time and costs as one invoice item checkbox and then click OK to return to the invoice form 2 On the invoice edit the description of the line item QuickBooks added to the invoice The description is Total reimbursable expenses but you can change the wording so that it s appropriate for the invoice QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 131 3 Click Time Costs to return to the Choose Billable Time and Costs window Applying a different markup to each expense If you don t want to mark up each expense by the same amount or percentage you can mark up the expenses individually To apply a different markup to each expense 1 Make sure the Markup amount or field is blank 2 Inthe Amount column change the amount of each expense so that it includes the markup you want For example if an expense is 50 00 and you want to mark it up by 10 00 you would change the 50 00 amount to 60 00 Effect on your accounts When you use this method to mark up an expense QuickBooks does NOT post the difference between the original amount and the edited amount to your markup account Instead the entire amount posts to the account you use to track income from that type of reimbursed expense To track markup income separately you must use the Markup amount or field to apply a single markup to all the expenses yo
11. 4 Indicate the date when you want to start assessing finance charges o Due date The day the invoice is due o Transaction date The day you wrote the invoice 5 Choose the account to track income from finance charges This is usually an income account 6 Optional If you don t want to assess finance charges on overdue finance charges clear the checkbox for it 7 Optional To be able to print your finance charge invoices to send to customers select the Mark finance charge invoices as To be printed checkbox If you send statements leave this checkbox cleared Assessing finance charges When you assess finance charges QuickBooks creates an invoice for each charge To assess finance charges 1 Choose Customers gt Assess Finance Charges 2 Select the customers and jobs for which you want to assess finance charges QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 123 Select an individual Click in the Assess column opposite the customer or job customer or job name Select all the Click Mark All customers and jobs listed Unselect everything Click Unmark All you ve selected Important Customers and jobs marked with an asterisk have credits in the form of payments or credit memos that you have not yet applied to any invoice The overdue balance shown in the Assess Finance Charges window does not reflect these credits 3 Optional Change any finance charge amounts by typing over the amounts shown in the Fi
12. Export files only A unique number that identifies the company file from which you exported the Employee list Export files only A unique number that identifies an entry in the list Required The employee s initials The employee s address The employee s Social Security number The employee s phone number An alternate phone number for the employee Your notes about the employee If you are creating an import file the notes appear in the Notepad window for the employee QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 264 FIRSTNAME The employee s first name MIDINIT The employee s middle initial LASTNAME The employee s last name SALUTATION The employee s salutation or title Mr Ms Doctor etc CUSTFLD1 Custom fields let you track information such as the employee s birthday or CUSTFLD2 email address CUSTFLD15 Header information HDR An export file always begins with a header that shows the version and release numbers of the QuickBooks software used to create the file The keyword for the header is HDR If you are creating a file to import you do not need to include a header PROD Identifies the Intuit product that created the export file VER The version number of the QuickBooks software that created the export file REL The release number of the QuickBooks software that created the export file IIFVER The version number of the export file format IIF DATE The date the export file was created TIME The time
13. Note If you are using QuickBooks in multiuser mode you ll need to complete these steps for each computer you want to use to process debit and credit cards Step 1 Set up your account with Intuit Merchant Account Services You only have to do this once You must have a merchant account to process your customer s credit and debit cards Once you sign up you ll be given a connection ticket that authorizes QuickBooks to process credit and debit card transactions Enter this ticket on the Merchant Service preference window QuickBooks gt Preferences Step 2 When you create a sales receipt or receive a payment use a credit debit card payment method Be sure Process credit card is checked When you click OK you ll be asked to enter your customer s card number and other information Note Using the Customer Center you can add a customer s card information then just select it when you re processing a payment Step 3 Track credit or debit card transactions Using your online Merchant Service account you can track all transactions you completed using your customer s credit and debit cards Choose Customers gt Credit Card Services gt Merchant Account Services to access your account You can also download card transactions you ve completed outside of QuickBooks using Go Payments or the Merchant Services Portal Choose Customers gt Credit Card Services gt Merchant Ac What you should know before processing a credit card payment in Quick
14. You need at least one each of the following types of accounts in your chart of accounts to track inventory Inventory Other Current Asset Use this account to track the current value of value your inventory If you want you can set up subaccounts within this account to track the value of different types of inventory Sales Income Use this account to track the income from the resale of inventory items If you want you can set up subaccounts within this account to track the income from different types of inventory Cost of goods sold Cost of Goods Sold Use this account to track the cost to you of the items you have sold If you want you can set up subaccounts within this account to track the costs for different types of inventory sold Ona profit and loss report QuickBooks subtracts the total cost of goods sold from your total income to provide a gross profit before expenses QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 204 Add inventory items You need to set up items for all the things you re going to sell See page 67 to find out how to create inventory items QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 205 Buying inventory There s three different ways to track purchasing inventory in QuickBooks Buying goods on the spot When you go to a vendor and buy your inventory over the counter you can use either the check or the credit card form to record the purchase in QuickBooks To buy inventory over the counter 1 From the Bank
15. more than one user can work in the file at the same time You get QuickBooks server when you buy QuickBooks But you only need it if you are using QuickBooks in multiuser mode To start QuickBooks Server 1 If you haven t already install QuickBooks Server by copying it from your QuickBooks CD or if you downloaded QuickBooks from the DMG file to your Applications folder 2 If the company file isn t on the same computer you are using to run QuickBooks Server move it there The company file must be on the same computer as QuickBooks Server 3 Open the company file in QuickBooks 4 Choose File gt Enable Multiuser Mode QuickBooks Server starts automatically More about QuickBooks Server e You can start QuickBooks server automatically when you log in With QuickBooks Server running right click the icon in your dock and choose Options gt Open at Log In Then every time you log in on that computer QuickBooks Server starts up sharing your company file e You can start and stop sharing a company file Select the file in the left column of QuickBooks Server and click either Start Sharing or Stop Sharing QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 30 e If you close QuickBooks Server everyone will lose their connection to the company file On the computer hosting the company file you can open the file again in QuickBooks and restart multiuser mode File gt Enable Multiuser Mode to share the file Or you can use the file in single u
16. o CLOSED this stamp appears on purchase orders that you mark as closed At the bottom of the Fields window go to the Print Options section and select the size of the stamp Click Preview to see what it will look like on the template Click None if you don t want a stamp QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 242 Formatting a template In Layout Designer use the Formatting Palette to customize how a form looks You can use Layout Designer to customize the look of your invoices sales receipts estimates credit memos statements and purchase orders Tip You can also customize what information is displayed on a form Using Layout Designer to format your template Add logos background graphics and other images to the template In the template window click Add Image on the toolbar Choose the image you want to add and then click Open You can add PDF GIF TIF JPG BMP PICT and PNG images Format text In the template window select the text you want to reformat In the Formatting Palette change the horizontal alignment vertical alignment color or font of the text Add text boxes and lines In the template window click the Text Text Box Box or Line button on the toolbar then draw the object in the template window You can then use the Formatting Palette to customize the way the object looks Note You can t edit the sample data on the template in Layout Designer Move stuff around and resize it Anything on you
17. s Guide 31 You can switch back to single user mode You can turn off multiuser mode so that only one person can access the company file Choose File gt Enable Multiuser Mode You ll see a checkmark by the command name When you choose it again to go into single user mode the checkmark goes away All the computers have to be on the same network For users to be able to share the same company file their computers must all be on the same network You can t share a file with remote computers You may run into each other but it s OK You may try to do something in the company file and see a message that says another user is trying to do the same thing at the same time You can either wait to try again or use your Chat app to communicate with the other user Set up each computer for Merchant Account Services optional For each computer in your multiuser environment that you want to use to process your customer s credit cards you ll need to set up credit card processing using your Merchant Account Services connection ticket Don t forget to back up your company file Backing up your company file is just as critical ina multiuser environment as it is in single user To back up your data stop sharing the company file then back up the file on the computer running QuickBooks server Then you can start sharing the file again QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 32 CHAPTER 2 Lists Lists are one of the most important areas in QuickBooks
18. 1 Open the program with your contacts such as your email or LinkedIn and create a group for contacts you want to import to QuickBooks 2 Export the group you created to a list file such as a CSV file or tab delimited text file 3 Open the export file in your favorite spreadsheet program To import your contacts 1 Goto File gt Import gt From Multiple Or go to the Customer Center Vendor Center or Employee list click m and then click the Import option 2 Open your spreadsheet see the Before you start section above if you don t have a spreadsheet 3 Copy the First Name column in your spreadsheet 4 Click into the first field in the QuickBooks First Name column The field turns white 5 Paste in the column you copied in Step 4 Tip Copy and paste by column not by row 6 Repeat steps 4 6 for every column in your spreadsheet Tip Be sure to scroll over to the right to see and copy in all the available fields 7 Be sure that the Import box is checked for all the contacts you want to import 8 Change or add any info you didn t have in your original spreadsheet 9 Inthe Role column be sure that each contact is labeled as a Customer Vendor or Employee correctly 10 Click Import QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 13 11 Click OK when the status window says Import Complete Fun fact You can use the Add Contacts window to add basic customer info without copying it from someplace else Just type your custome
19. 12 15 13 8059 Terms Net 30 Bill Due 01 14 14 12 28 13 Bill Check 13 759 00 12 20 13 Bill 5 064 00 Sergeant Insurance 4 050 00 12 15 13 Bill Check 400 00 12 15 13 12 15 13 Bill Check 754 50 Keswick Insulation 670 00 12 12 13 Bill 810 00 12 15 13 Items 5 064 00 Notes 4 Cal Gas amp Electric 122 68 12 15 13 12 03 Account Amount CustomerJob Billable Class 0100 Automobile 35 00 special truck rental Balak Mike Utility Shed CU Electric 250 00 p 12 12 13 Lew Plumbing 175 00 12 12 13 20001 Sloan Roofing 1 047 00 12 12 13 Sloan Roofing CR 850 00 12 12 13 CR 1098 eee le Patton Hardware Suppl 810 00 33413132 Memo 6 Cancel Save gt tl Tip If you assign the amount of the bill to various expense accounts customers jobs or classes your reports will show you how much you spend within each of these areas e Account Choose the account that you use to track that type of expense Usually this will be an expense account e Amount QuickBooks enters the amount you entered for Amount Due or Credit Due To assign only part of the amount to the expense you can edit this number Note For inventory item purchases you may want to associate expenses such as tax or freight charges with your Cost of Goods Sold COGS account instead of an expense account e Memo Enter a memo about the expense e Customer Job To pass on the amount as an expense
20. DirectConnect QuickBooks for Mac connects directly to your financial institution s computers After you complete a one time setup process all you need to do is click a button and enter your login and password DirectConnect retrieves your statements and uploads them into QuickBooks ready for you to reconcile at your convenience Here s a portrait of a DirectConnect user e Works with a financial institution that supports DirectConnect e Has a high speed constant Internet connection e Prefers that QuickBooks do most of the work including retrieving more than one statement ina single session e Likes using the Mac keychain function to store passwords QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 178 e Doesn t mind paying a small fee to financial institutions that support DirectConnect There s no rule that says you must use only WebConnect or only DirectConnect Many small business owners keep accounts with more than one financial institution a local credit union for checking accounts PayPal for receiving payments and American Express for corporate credit cards perhaps Knowing how to use both QuickBooks online banking systems gives you the flexibility to keep your online accounts running smoothly If your bank doesn t support QuickBooks for Mac contact them to request support Connecting Directly to Online Banking Using Direct Connect you can automatically download transactions from your financial institution direc
21. Invoices and sales receipts only The customer s shipping address The following table shows the column headings for distribution lines SPLID Required A unique number that identifies the distribution line in the transaction QuickBooks generates the number when you create an QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 270 TRNSTYPE DATE ACCNT NAME CLASS AMOUNT DOCNUM MEMO CLEAR PRICE QNTY INVITEM PAYMETH TAXABLE REIMBEXP export file A keyword that indicates the type of transaction The keyword in this field must match the keyword in the TRNSTYPE field for the transaction The keyword will be one of the following BILL Bills from vendors CHECK Checks DEPOSIT Bank or money market deposits INVOICE Invoices PAYMENT Customer payments The date of the transaction The date in this field must match the date in the DATE field for the transaction Required The income or expense account to which you assigned the amount on the distribution line The name of the customer vendor payee or employee The name of the class that applies to the distribution amount If the class is a subclass the class name includes the names of the parent classes beginning with the highest level class A colon separates each class name Required The distribution amount Credit amounts are negative The number of the transaction For checks the number is the check number for invoices the number is
22. New to QuickBooks Welcome Thanks for choosing QuickBooks This section is just for you I m going to show you how to create your company file which is the file you ll use each time you use QuickBooks Creating company file QuickBooks walks you through a setup process that will create your company file for you 1 Open QuickBooks You ll see the No Company Open window intuit QuickBooks Are you switching from 2014 New to QuickBooks Sees Open Company File Name Date Modified _ WRecent Files Everything Writing Sep11 8 20 13 1 32 PM Shared Files Sample Files Sample Product 8 19 13 7 44 PM Sample Service 8 19 13 7 44 PM 2 Click Get Started 3 On the Create New Company enter information about your company and click Next o Company Name What you call your company o Legal Name Your company name as it appears on legal documents o Address Country The address for your company as you want it to appear on invoices checks and other forms You can also enter different addresses for Shipping and Billing QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide o Company Start Date The date you want to use to start tracking your business transactions in QuickBooks Usually this is the first day of your current fiscal year o Income Tax Form Used Which tax form do you use for your business s taxes If you re not sure check with your accountant o Federal ID The ID you use on your co
23. QuickBooks You set the company file s start date to January 1 even though you ve been in business for three years already So you should enter all your past transactions back to January 1 of this year A little confused Don t be You re just starting your QuickBooks file at a moment in time If you re in doubt about what your start date should be check with your accountant QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 14 Why enter my historical transactions Entering historical transactions gives you an accurate look at how your company is doing in the present and over time After you enter your transactions from your start date up to today you ll have e Accurate balances in your bank accounts and all other accounts e The ability to reconcile your bank and credit card statements with your QuickBooks bank and credit card accounts e Up to date records of what customers owe you and what you owe vendors e Accurate year to date profit and loss statements e Accurate sales tax reports for any period after your start date Do wait to enter current transactions until get the historical data in No Just because you starting to use QuickBooks doesn t mean your business has stopped running You probably have current transactions happening right now that you need to record as well as get your historical data into QuickBooks So this is important to know You can enter historical transactions at any time You don t have to enter all your pa
24. Ss FS 5 eceivable and payro Jee 6 You must enter bills and invoices first before you enter payments If you tell QuickBooks QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide you ve made a payment QuickBooks needs to know what bill that payment is for Likewise if a customer has sent you their payment then QuickBooks needs to know what invoice the payment is for That way QuickBooks knows which bills you ve paid and what invoices your customers have paid Paying attention to these two guidelines will pay off big for you later on You ll have an accurate view of which invoices and bills are paid in full which are partially paid and which aren t paid at all As you record your bill payments and your customers invoice payments QuickBooks updates your bank balance Then you can fill in any other transactions you haven t recorded previously Entering vendor transactions Strictly speaking there s no rule that says you have to enter your transactions in a particular order But recommend that you enter your vendor related transactions first especially if you invoice customers for expenses you want to be reimbursed for Here s why You won t be able to include expenses on an invoice for reimbursement unless that expense is accounted for witha purchase related transaction So it s a good idea to get those vendor transactions in first T Let s get started The first thing to do is enter all your transactions rel
25. To edit an account select the account name and click Edit at the bottom of the Chart of Accounts za 3 Use the options below to set up your account You ll see some subset of these options depending on what type of account you re creating For example you ll only see the Bank No option when you re creating a Bank account o Type The type of account you are creating o Number The account number you want to give the account If you don t see the number field choose QuickBooks gt Preferences and then click Transactions Select the Use account numbers checkbox o Name The name you want to give the account o Description A description for the account and or bank or credit card number o Bank No The number of the bank account associated with this account such as your checking account number o Subaccount of Makes the account the subaccount of an existing account From the list select the account that will be the higher level account for this subaccount o Tax Line Do you want to report this type of income or expense on your income tax forms a If you do Choose a tax line to associate with this account from the Tax Line list The type of tax form you chose in the New Company Setup Assistant QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 50 interview or Company Information window determines the income tax lines that QuickBooks displays in the pop up menu For example if you specified that you file the Form 10
26. To include the name on the printed sales receipt type the name in the Sold To field e Class If you re using classes choose which on you want to use If you don t see this you need to turn classes on in Preferences Sold to The address you have for the customer displays here This is how the customer contact information will appear here You can make any changes you need to Date Today s date which you can change Tip Press to increase the date by one day press to decrease the date by one day Sale No QuickBooks automatically increments this number by one for each new sales receipt Tip Press to increase the number by one press to decrease the number by one e Check No If your customer is paying by check you can enter the check s number here QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 113 e Payment Method Select the payment method you customer is using If you re processing a credit or debit card in QuickBooks select the type of credit card Be sure Process credit card is selected When you click OK enter the card information Item Select what you ve sold this customer You can include anything on the Items list here You also enter a new item and QuickBooks will prompt you to set it up Tip If you need to insert an item between two others select the item line where you want the new one and choose Edit gt Insert Line Likewise if you want to delete an item select the item then choose Edit
27. When you email your invoice to your customer you ll see information about the link that your customer will see Step 3 Get paid Intuit PaymentNetwork sends you an email when a payment has been processed then posted to your account Step 4 Download the payment to QuickBooks for Mac 1 Go to Customers gt Intuit PaymentNetwork gt Download Transactions A browser window opens 2 Log into your IPN account 3 Now you need to choose how you want to download the transactions into QuickBooks 4 To both receive the payment and record the deposit choose the top radio button QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 125 We recommend this option most of the time unless you have a specific need to record this deposit manually it s easier to let QuickBooks handle the IPN fee split and create all the correct records 5 To just receive the payment and group the money with your other undeposited funds choose the lower radio button Don t forget to account for Intuit PaymentNetwork fees when you do record this deposit 6 Check all the transactions in the list that you want to download now 7 Click Download to QuickBooks 8 Close the browser window to go back to QuickBooks After you ve finished downloading the transactions you can go into QuickBooks and see the received payments and recorded deposits if you chose to go that way made for you When you owe a customer One of your customers has returned goods you sold or canceled
28. Your lists are where the things you use in just about any transaction live Take an invoice for example The Bill to name item description rate tax payment terms customer message anything you select from dropdown list are all set up on a list You can get to any list from the List menu In subsequent chapters go into more detail about specific lists like Chart of Accounts Items Customer Jobs and Vendors In this chapter I ll talk about everything else e Classes e Employees Other Names Customer amp Vendor Profile o Customer Types o Vendor Types o Terms o Customer Messages o Payment Methods o Ship Via e Vehicles e Memorized Transactions QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide Company Customers Vendors Chart of Accounts THA Items QKI Classes Employees Banking Customer Jobs TEJ Vendors Employees OSE Other Names Customer amp Vendor Profile Customer Messages Customer Types Job Types Payment Methods Purchase Orders Sales Reps Ship Via Terms Vendor Types Vehicles Memorized Transactions 33 How to use lists You can perform these tasks in your lists e Add an entry to the list Click the menu at the bottom laise list Edit an entry Select an entry on the list and then Whi e Search for an entry Use the search field in the top right corner or the list to find the item you need Or you can search throughout QuickBooks e Change the view By
29. either find your paper bank or account statement or access your online statement Tip It might be easier to print out your online account statement so you don t have to keep switching screens on your computer In QuickBooks choose Banking gt Reconcile The Begin Reconcile window appears In the Account to Reconcile field choose the account you want to reconcile Enter the statement date from your account statement in the Statement Date field Enter the ending balance on your account statement into the Ending Balance field If your bank or credit card company charges you a monthly service charge or fee enter the amount of that fee into the Service Charge Amount field Enter the date your bank charged you this fee the QuickBooks account you want this fee charged to QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 189 Tip If you use Classes to categorize your expenses choose the Class you associate with this fee 7 If this is an interest bearing account like a savings account enter the amount of interest you earned during this statement period in the Interest Earned Amount field Enter the date your bank posted the interest the QuickBooks account you want to add this interest to and the Class you want to associate with this interest 8 Click OK The account window closes Now it s time to reconcile your transactions Step 2 Mark your transactions Start at the top with the first transaction listed in the Deposits and Credits secti
30. gt Delete Line e Description The description of the item you entered when you created the item You can change this if you need to Tip You can enter multiple lines for your description up to 4095 characters Use Option Return to put in a line break e Quantity How many of the items does your customer need to pay you for This could be 400 antennas or 10 hours of web design If you leave this blank QuickBooks assumes the quantity is 1 Rate How much you charge for the item If you entered this when you created the item QuickBooks enters it for you If you didn t or you need to change it just edit this box e Amount This is the total amount Quantity x Rate for this item that QuickBooks calculates for you e Taxable If the item is taxable click this box e Customer Message A message for our customer either on from your Customer Messages list or enter a new one e Tax The tax item you assigned to the customer or the default tax if you have not assigned a tax item to the customer QuickBooks uses the tax item to calculate the tax You can also select a different rate from the list of tax items if you need to e Group with other undeposited funds Deposit to Click Group with other undeposited funds to hold the payment in your Undeposited Funds account To deposit the payment choose Banking gt Make Deposits and select the payment When you record the deposit QuickBooks transfers the payment amount from Undeposit
31. gt Preferences and go to the Transactions preferences Be sure that Use class tracking is checked Now you can create classes on your class list Choose View All Classes Lists gt Classes To add a new class just click the Ee Ww button The example to the right is from one of the sample files that comes with QuickBooks The file is for a landscaping business so you can see that the QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 141 categories reflect the type of work the business does QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 142 Q Filter Invoices Sort by Date v Robson Darci Robson Clinic ly D struction Iv Robson Darci Robson Clinic Summary 4 Invoice Date Phone 415 555 3925 Cook Brian Kitc 1 636 69 nsa Email drobson samplename 12 15 13 1098 Bill To Open balance 12 420 98 Dr Darci Robson Robson Darci 12 420 98 300 Main St Suite 2 Active estimates o 12 15 13 1097 Bayshore CA 94326 Unbilled time expenses 0 00 Natiello Ernesto 2 824 03 Recent Transactions a 12 14 13 1096 12 15 13 Invoice 12 420 98 a iia agree Quantity Rate Amount 12 02 13 Payment 445 00 Removal Removal labor 2 35 00 70 00 12 01 13 Invoice 445 00 Erne Framing Framing labor a2 55 00 605 00 11 24 13 Estimate 12 865 98 Spe di A Subs Electrical Electrical work 12 75 00 900 00 Subs Plumbing Plumbing 16 70 00 1 120 00 Lew Plumbing C
32. list items QuickBooks for Mac uses QuickBooks Payroll for Mac powered by PayCycle and Aatrix Top Pay for payroll services Online banking transactions that have not been accepted into a register transactions that have been accepted will appear as payments deposits and transfers with associated links Online banking aliases Customized price levels Integration with third party applications including Microsoft Word Outlook and ACT Merchant account services Sales order and back order tracking available in Premier versions of QuickBooks for Windows Assembly items available only in Premier versions of QuickBooks for Windows will be converted into non inventory part items Customized settings for forms like invoices estimates statements and purchase orders forms can be customized in QuickBooks for Mac Multiuser data account information for users other than the administrator User passwords QuickBooks for Mac supports administrator password Memorized reports Business planning expert analysis and business optimization tools Budgets created without an associated account Transaction type EFP payroll will convert into a payroll liability check Workers comp list Fixed asset item list Multiple ship to addresses Preferred Send method and payment information for Customer Jobs User added columns to lists Exchanging your file with your accountant Getting your file to your
33. o If you re using Web Connect QuickBooks takes you to your financial institution s website to download your transaction file Then click Import to import the file into QuickBooks o If you re using Direct Connect QuickBooks downloads transactions from the account at your financial institution directly into QuickBooks What to do with matched transactions Select the matched transaction in the Downloaded Transactions window QuickBooks automatically selects the same transaction in the account register Now do one of the following e If QuickBooks correctly matched the imported transaction to a transaction in your account register you re done QuickBooks marks the transaction as cleared in the register and as Matched in the Downloaded Transactions window e If QuickBooks incorrectly matched the transaction click Unmatch e To delete the transaction from the Downloaded Transactions window click Delete What to do with unmatched transactions Select the unmatched transaction in the Downloaded Transactions window Then do one of the following e Match the transaction with a transaction in the register Select the transaction in the register you want to match and then click Match The amount in both transactions must match exactly and if there is a check number or reference number they must match exactly QuickBooks marks the transaction as cleared in the register and as Matched in the Downloaded Transactions window e Add transa
34. separate subtype names Export files only A unique number that identifies the company file from which you exported the Customer Type list Export files only A unique number that identifies an entry in the list Customer Job list CUST Import and export files can contain all the information on your Customer Job list The keyword for the Customer Job list is CUST NAME TIMESTAMP REFNUM BADDR1 5 SADDR1 5 PHONE1 PHONE2 FAXNUM CONT1 CONT2 CTYPE TERMS Required The name of the customer If a job name is included the customer name appears first If you are creating an import file use a colon to separate the customer name from the job name Export files only A unique number that identifies the company file from which you exported the Customer Job list Export files only A unique number that identifies an entry in the list The customer s billing address The customer s shipping address The customer s phone number The customer s alternate phone number The customer s FAX number The name of your primary contact with the customer The name of an alternate contact with the customer Your classification for the customer QuickBooks calls this a customer type If you import a customer type that is not on your Customer Type list QuickBooks adds the new customer type to the list The customer s payment terms with your company QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 263 TAXABLE LIMIT RE
35. 5 As you check your stock fill in the quantities for each item in the Physical Count column of the worksheet Sales tax If you sell stuff sales tax is part of your life Ugh Oh mean lucky you OK tried to be upbeat but there s really no way around the fact that sales tax takes a bite out of your donut But QuickBooks can make it easier for you even if you have to deal with many tax rates in multiple jurisdictions Before go on here are a couple of things you should know It s important you understand the sales tax rules for your area You can learn what these are by contacting the sales tax agencies that will collect sales tax from you Not sure who the agencies are Your state s web site is a good place to start searching for information e When you set up a company that charges sales tax or when you enter your first sale QuickBooks automatically creates a current liability account called Sales Tax Payable The Sales Tax Payable account keeps track of as many tax agencies as you need So working with sales tax in QuickBooks here we go Set up tax rates and agencies Before you can charge and track sales tax you must let QuickBooks know which agencies you Collecting sales tax Paying sales tax Set up tax rates and agencies Indicate who and what gets taxed Apply tax to each sale Find out what you Pay your tax agencies 8 5 State tax board Customer
36. 7 Cal Gas amp Electric 122 68 f 12 15 13 12 03 Item Description Qty Cost Amount CustomerJob Billable Class inets Cabin Cabinet Pulls 300 3 00 900 00 Overhead O Overhead CU Electric 250 00 ght pine kitchen cabinet wall unit 1 1 500 00 1 500 00 Overhead vert fad 12 12 13 Hardware Brass standard interno Oras hig a oa ooo evernesi O Overhead Hardware Door Doorknobs Part DK 3704 20 27 00 540 00 Overhead O Overhead Lew Plumbing 175 00 Hardware Lk Locking interior doorknobs Part 20 34 95 699 00 Overhead O Overhead 12 12 13 20001 Wood Exterior door P 10981 3 105 00 315 00 Overhead O Overhead Wood Interior door P 187055T 6 60 00 360 00 Overhead O Overhead Sloan Roofing 1 047 00 12 12 13 Select PO Clear Qtys Show PO Sloan Roofing CR 850 00 12ans ECR 1090 T Patton Hardware Suppl 810 00 aa413132 Memo 6 Cancel Save Il Did you have an open purchase order PO for the items If so when you enter a vendor at the top of the window QuickBooks asks you whether the items have been received If you marked them as received then QuickBooks adds those to Items pane If you didn t receive all the items on the purchase order you can edit the quantity or cost of any item or delete an item completely Enter the details of the items you are being billed for e Item The item you are being billed for Description Enter a description for that item Qty Enter how many of the item you received Cost
37. CUSTFLD1 CUSTFLD2 CUSTFLD15 1099 Your credit limit with the vendor If you are creating an import file enter the dollar amount Your payment terms with the vendor Your notes about the vendor If you are creating an import file the notes appear in the Notepad window for the vendor The vendor s salutation or title Mr Ms Doctor etc The name of the vendor s company The vendor s first name The vendor s middle initial The vendor s last name The custom field entries for the vendor Custom fields let you track special information about the vendor such as the vendor s birthday or email address Indicates whether you file a 1099 MISC form for this vendor If you are creating an import file enter one of these keywords in the 1099 field Y Yes You file a 1099 MISC form for this vendor N No You do not file a 1099 MISC form for this vendor Vendor Type list VTYPE Import and export files can contain the list of vendor types you use in QuickBooks The keyword for the Vendor Type list is VTYPE NAME TIMESTAMP REFNUM Required The vendor type If the vendor type is a subtype of another vendor type the name includes the name of the parent types beginning with the highest level type If you are creating an import file use a colon to separate subtype names Export files only A unique number that identifies the company file from which you exported the Vendor Type list Export files only A
38. Checks CREDIT CARD Charges you make on a credit card CREDIT MEMO Credit you give to customers for merchandise they return DEPOSIT Bank or money market deposits GENERAL JOURNAL General journal transactions INVOICE Invoices PAYMENT Customer payments PURCHORD Purchase orders The date of the transaction The date is always in MM DD YY format For example 01 30 04 Required The name of the account assigned to the transaction The name of the customer vendor payee or employee The name of the class that applies to the transaction If the class is a subclass the class name includes the names of the parent classes beginning with the highest level class A colon separates each class name Required The amount of the transaction Debit amounts are always positive credit amounts are always negative The number of the transaction For checks the number is the check number for invoices the number is the invoice number etc The memo text associated with the transaction Indicates whether the transaction has cleared These keywords can appear in the CLEARED field Y Yes The transaction has cleared N No The transaction HASN T cleared P Pending Indicates whether a check invoice credit memo or sales receipt has QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 269 ADDR1 5 DUEDATE TERMS PAID PAYMETH SHIPVIA SHIPDATE REP FOB PONUM INVTITLE INVMEMO SADDR1 5 been marked
39. Choose Lists gt Items 2 Click the at the bottom of the list 3 Choose Inventory Part from the Type pop up menu If Inventory Part isn t on the list you need to turn inventory tracking on Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences and then click Inventory Select the Inventory and purchase orders are active checkbox 4 Enter an item name or number You may use letters or numbers up to a maximum of 31 characters The item name you enter here appears on the Item list you choose from while entering a sale or purchase It prints on invoices sales receipts estimates or purchase orders only if you print Item columns 5 Fill in the Purchase Information fields QuickBooks uses the purchase cost and purchase description you enter here on purchase orders and checks credit cards and bills you use to pay for this item o Description on Purchase Transactions What you enter here appears in the Description column of checks bills credit card charges and item receipts when QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 67 you reorder the item Your description may be up to three lines in length You can edit the description when you are filling out a purchase order o Cost Enter the cost you expect to pay when you order or buy this item You can change the cost at the time you purchase the item o COGS Account Select a different cost of goods sold account if you don t want to use the preset account The type of this account should be Co
40. Computer Inc used under license PayCycle is a registered service mark of PayCycle Inc Aatrix is a registered trademark of Aatrix Software Inc Adobe and Acrobat are registered trademarks of Adobe Systems Incorporated in the United States and or other countries American Express is a registered trademark of the American Express Company LightSpeed is a registered trademark of Xsilva Systems Inc Other parties marks are the property of their respective owners and should be treated as such This program uses the following open source components under their respective licenses Blast c Boost Excelsior and SQLite Portions of these components are the copyrighted material of their respective authors QB Mac 2014 1309 5 QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide CHAPTER 1 Welcome to QuickBooks CHAPTER 2 Lists 33 for Mac 2014 1 How to use lists 34 Classes list 36 Running QuickBooks 2 Employees list 37 System requirements 2 Integration compatibility requirements erer nanos lS 28 2 Customer and Vendor Profile lists 38 Installing and Upgrading QuickBooks 3 Torme OG paymeni 39 f Payment methods 41 Converting your file from QuickBooks Ta Other things you can do with lists 42 TOF VINAOMS 3 Merging list entries 42 What s New in 2014 4 gg Exporting names for mail merge 42 New to QuickBooks 6 bles Inactive list entries 43 Creating company file 6 Deleting an item from a list 44 Next steps 8 f oe 3 Adding wh
41. Customer Center o Choose Customer gt Customer Center How do use it Select a customer or job name on the left side of the center to view information about the customer and associated jobs As you click on a customer or job name the right side of the Customer Center displays the information associated with your selection You can perform many tasks within the Customer Center e Add a customer or job Click the menu at the bottom of the center and choose Add Customer or Add Job e Add a customer group Click the menu at the bottom left of the center and choose New Group e Import your existing contacts Click the menu at the bottom of the customer list and click Import Multiple QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 79 E e Create a transaction Click the menu at the bottom of the transactions area to create estimates invoices sales receipts payments and credit memos e Search for a customer Use the search field above the customer list to find the customer name you need e Open accounts receivable Select a customer name and click Open Accounts Receivable for that customer Edit a customer or job Select the name of the customer or job and click Edit Customer or Edit Job in the top right corner of the center Edit a customer group Select the customer group in the top left of the center then click Edit Group in the top right corner of the center e Add customer s credit
42. DUE 36 838 PAID PAID L 94 354 Income I Expenses E Income Breakdown Expense Breakdown E Gross Wages E Job Materials E Subcontractors E Other Total 344 176 85 223 To access the Company Snapshot Click the Snapshot icon on the Home page Purchase Orders a Information found on the Company Snapshot You can find out a lot very quickly on the Company Snapshot including Income Tracker Shows active estimates unbilled time and costs open invoices with overdue invoices called out and what you ve paid in the last 30 days Account Balances Displays all cash credit card accounts receivable accounts payable and liability accounts Double click a line item account to open the register window for that account Click Chart of Accounts to open the Chart of Accounts window Click the Info icon to select the accounts you want to see Income Breakdown Shows a pie chart of your income broken down by account Expense Breakdown Shows a pie chart of your expenses broken down by account Income and Expense Trends Shows money going in and out of your business for a time period It QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 224 gives you a quick snapshot of how your business is doing and lets you compare income and expenses To change the time period use the pull down menu below the graph Place your cursor over a bar in the graph to see the exact amount e Customers Who Owe Money Shows ba
43. From the Lists menu choose the list that contains the item 2 Select the item you want to delete Subitems If the item you want to delete has subitems either delete the subitems or move them to another part of the list QuickBooks does not allow you to delete a list item that has subitems 3 Choose Edit gt Delete or press D The Delete command changes to indicate the type of item you are deleting For example if you are deleting a name from the Employee list the command becomes Delete Employee 4 If you delete an item by mistake choose Edit gt Undo immediately Adding what s important to you with Custom Fields Need to add your own data your own way Custom fields can get it done Add custom information to your items such as Color or Material to your items For the people related to your business customers vendors employees add information that s important to you such as birthdays or the names of spouses Note If you memorize a transaction that has a custom field QuickBooks memorizes what you entered in the field along with the other details of the transaction If you export a list that contains data in custom fields QuickBooks exports that data along with the other data from the list Adding custom fields To add custom fields for customers vendors and employee 1 From the Lists menu edit a customer vendor or employee 2 On the Additional Info pane click Define Fields 3 For each field o Enter the name of t
44. How much was each item Amount QuickBooks multiplies Qty and Cost to calculate the amount of all the items Customer If you ve bought these items for a customer or job select the name from the list Billable Time An icon appears ce indicating this is billable time If it s not click the icon so that an X appears over it Class To assign the amount to one of your QuickBooks classes enter it in the Class column Note This column only appears when you have selected the Use Class Tracking preference choose QuickBooks gt Preferences gt Transactions PO No Since you don t have a PO you can ignore this QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 161 QuickBooks provides some buttons to help you working with POs e Select PO Lists the open POs Select the ones you re being billed for e Receive All or Clear Qtys Click Receive all to tell QuickBooks you ve received all the items listed in open POs for this vendor Click Clear Qtys to tell QuickBooks you haven t received any items e Show PO Displays the open PO for this vendor Bills FAQs Have questions about entering and paying bills Check out these tips don t see the bill I want to pay What do I do o Did you enter the bill Be sure to do that first o If you did enter the bill choose Vendor gt Pay Bill and select All Bills under Show Is your bill in the list You may have to scroll to see it o If you still don t see a bill you entered you may have
45. I print my account descriptions on reports QuickBooks does not print account descriptions on reports However account names can be much longer than in these other programs Also if you use numerical accounts you can have QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 252 both a number and a name and both print on reports Choose Company gt Preferences choose Transactions Select the Use account numbers checkbox Emailing forms You can email any of your forms directly from QuickBooks The form is saved as a PDF file and attached to an email message which is sent using your default email program QuickBooks uses the email address saved in the customer list to send the sales form QuickBooks supports Apple Mail Microsoft Entourage 2008 or Outlook 2011 for Mac To email the form you have open 1 Click the email button at the top of the form To email a group of forms 1 When creating the form select Email later button at the bottom of the form before s ea 5 you save it 2 When you re ready to email the forms choose File gt Email Forms 3 On the Select Forms to Email window review the list of forms to email Be sure the ones you want to send are checked Uncheck the forms you don t want to send 4 Click Send Adding Email Addresses If you do not have an email address for the recipient saved in the customer or vendor list you can add an address on the Select Forms to Email window Click twice in Ema
46. If you ve incurred expenses for your customer such as mileage or other expense you can add that to an invoice to be reimbursed by your customer Invoice your customer in phases Use progress invoicing to send QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 96 invoices for parts of a job over a period of time gB View payment history for the invoice Click history to see the payments for this invoice aa Apply a payment to the invoice Click Payments to enter a payment your customer made for this invoice Apply sales tax If you re charging sales tax for the items click Taxable to apply sales tax es 6 Print email add to iCal or Calendar You can mark the invoice to be printed or emailed later Then choose File gt Print forms or File gt Email forms You can also add a reminder to iCal or Calendar that the invoice is due You can mark an invoice as pending There may be a time when an invoice is only in draft form In that case you can mark it was Pending Edit gt Mark Invoice as Pending and finalize it later Invoicing a customer over time progress invoicing Watch a video on how to use progress invoicing http www qblittlesquare com 2011 09 sneak peek 2 progress invoicing in quickbooks 2012 Using progress invoicing you can invoice for jobs in phases For example you re working on a job where you ask your customer for 25 payment at the beginning of the project then you invoice them periodically throughout th
47. On the Preferences pane select 1099s 3 Set the preferences described below 4 Close Preferences Use 1099 preferences to set up to track the amounts you report on 1099 MISC and 1096 tax forms For each category on the 1099 MISC form you can associate one or more of your QuickBooks accounts If a threshold amount is no longer valid for a particular 1099 category you can change the amount To associate accounts with a category 1 Make sure that the 1099 MISC forms are filed checkbox is selected 2 Inthe Account column click the line that corresponds to the category with which you want to associate accounts 3 Inthe list that appears select the account you have been using to track that type of 1099 payment to your vendors If you have been using more than one account click Selected and then click individually the name of each account The accounts you select should be the same accounts you use to track payments related to your 1099 vendors Typically the accounts will be expense accounts You can also associate a liability account or another current asset account with a 1099 category Assigning a threshold Enter the new amount in the Threshold column The threshold amount is the minimum amount you must report to the IRS The amounts QuickBooks displays are correct as of the date your copy of QuickBooks was manufactured When the IRS changes a threshold amount you must enter the new amount yourself QuickBooks cannot up
48. Schneider PAY CHK split 10079 Gregg O Schneider PAY CHK split SEND _TRANSFR 10300 Savings 115 Patton Hardware Supplies BILLPMT 20000 Accounts Pay 10078 Gre Payee Account Number ecord Restore Splits 1 062 12 13 759 00 Payment C 1 Line 1 062 12 61 290 22 60 228 10 60 728 10 46 969 10 Deposit Ending balance 46 969 10 Sort by Date Type Nu r gt Registers help you track what goes on in your accounts Every balance sheet account in your Chart of Accounts has its own register that lists in chronological order all the transactions in the account If you re familiar with adjusting entries in a general journal you can use the General Journal Entry window to enter debits and credits QuickBooks provides the general journal for bookkeepers who know debits from credits and who prefer to enter certain transactions ina general journal Opening a register You can open an account s register at any time QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 56 From the Chart of Accounts Double click the name of the balance sheet account whose register you d like to open Click Open Register at the bottom of the Chart of Accounts J From a form check invoice etc With the form open Choose Edit gt Use Register Press R What happens QuickBooks opens the register for the account where the check invoice bill or credit card
49. Vendors from the list to limit the report to transactions related to vendors Choose Selected Names to limit the report to specific names e Number Choose transactions based on invoice or check number To include all transactions within a range of numbers enter both a beginning number and ending number To exclude all transactions EXCEPT for one enter the number of that one transaction in the first field and leave the second field blank e Paid Status Include only those invoices and bills that have a specific paid status Closed Open or Either Payroll Item Limit the report to specific payroll items like Vacation Salary Health Insurance and Federal Withholding e Posting Status Posting status of transactions to a register Most transactions post toa register for example when you create an invoice QuickBooks records the amount in your accounts receivable register A few types of transactions estimates pending sales and purchase orders are non posting in that they never appear in a register Received lInclude open purchase orders closed purchase orders or both e Ship Date Include only those invoices and cash sales receipts that have a specific shipping date e Source Account Limit the report to transactions that originated from a particular balance sheet account or a group of balance sheet accounts For example a profit and loss report normally represents all your company s balance sheet accou
50. access your bank account online QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 177 Next Step If you have everything in Before You Begin you re ready to use online banking with QuickBooks Now you need to set up your bank account using Direct Connect or Web Connect Web Connect vs Direct Connect QuickBooks for Mac offers two ways to hook up your accounting to your accounts WebConnect and DirectConnect Whichever of these you choose you ll save tons of time because you won t be entering all those transactions by hand You ll be downloading them from your financial institutions which means you ll be decreasing the introduction of errors into your books So that s great right But which option will work better for your business WebConnect or DirectConnect WebConnect After a one time setup process every time you want to reconcile your accounts you log into your financial institution s website and manually download a QuickBooks compatible file to your computer Then you import the downloaded file into QuickBooks Here s how a WebConnect user might look 1 Works with a financial institution that supports WebConnect 2 Might not have constant connection to the Internet such as dial up 3 Prefers to keep a close hand on all steps of the process including the transfer of information from the bank to QuickBooks 4 Often needs to download statements with specific date ranges 5 Doesn t want to pay a fee for DirectConnect
51. accountant is much the same as it was for you previously You ll save a file and get it to your accountant It s called round tripping which means your company file is going from the Mac to your accountant s Windows computer and back to your Mac In a nutshell what you ll do is save your company file as a Windows backup file File gt Back Up to QuickBooks Windows Then your accountant will open that file do the work she needs to do then QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 26 save the file as a Mac file Then the accountant sends the file back to you and you open it on your Mac That s round tripping One critical thing to note to round trip your file you and your accountant must be on the same version of QuickBooks So if you are using QuickBooks for Mac 2014 your accountant must be on some 2014version of QuickBooks for Windows QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 27 Using QuickBooks in multiuser mode In QuickBooks for Mac 2014 you can run QuickBooks in multiuser mode This means more than One user can work on your company file from different computers at the same time Why would you want to do that Well you may have an employee who does basic tasks like sending out invoices and keeping customer information up to date while you take care of the larger tasks like payroll and paying vendors In single user mode you have to stop working in your company file so your employee can work in it This can be incon
52. activities 1 Choose Employees gt Time Tracking gt Enter Single Activity 2 Enter the name of the person who performed the work and press Tab 3 In the date field enter the date the work was performed and press Tab 4 Inthe Customer Job field enter the customer for whom the work was performed If you are tracking individual jobs as well enter the customer name a colon and a job name Press Tab o Non billable time If you do not intend to invoice your customer you still may want to enter the customer or job name For example if you spent the time correcting an error on a job filling in the Customer Job field gives you a record of your non billable time for the job You can display non billable time on time reports QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 136 o Overhead If the time is truly overhead and has no association with any customer or job then leave the Customer Job field blank 5 Enter the name of the service item that matches this type of work and press Tab 6 Inthe Duration field enter the number of hours worked on this date and this job and press Tab 7 If you are NOT going to invoice your customer for this time clear the Billable checkbox 8 Optional In the Notes field enter any additional information you want to record about this activity Editing time entries You can change time entries after you ve entered them To edit a weekly timesheet 1 Choose Employees gt Time Tracking gt Use Weekl
53. add new ones Then you can add this information if you customize your sales forms Tip Control click a name on the list to choose common tasks from a shortcut menu To open a list Choose Lists gt Customer amp Vendor Profile and then the name of the list you want to open Most of the lists are just labels and can be anything you choose so I m not going to go into detail with those There are two exceptions Terms and Payment Methods These are a little more involved Terms for payment Payment terms say when you expect to receive payment from a customer or when your vendors expect payment from you For example if you expect payment from a customer within 30 days and you give a discount of 2 if payment is received in 10 days the terms are 2 10 Net 30 QuickBooks supplies a list of often used payment terms Because QuickBooks uses terms for both invoices to your customers and bills from your vendors you only need to add a particular set of terms once to the list You can edit a customer or vendor and select the payment terms for each Then QuickBooks automatically enters terms for you in invoices and bills To set up payment terms 1 Choose Lists gt Customer amp Vendor Profile gt Terms 2 Add anew term or open an existing term 3 On the New or Edit Terms window enter the details of the payment term QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 39 Payment terms details e Terms A word or phrase that will help y
54. aes pes Memo 7 Cancel Save a Ul v See how to use POs to order and receive goods http www qblittlesquare com 2011 03 tracking orders for the items you need To create or edit a purchase order 1 If you haven t already turn on inventory and purchase orders QuickBooks gt Preferences gt Inventory 2 Choose Vendors gt Create Purchase Orders You can also create purchase orders using the Vendor Center and Transaction Center QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 154 3 To create a new PO click the Create Purchase Order on the left panel or click the at the bottom of the list To edit a PO select a PO in the list on the left panel If you View m BE don t see this list click the Left View GHJ E 4 Fill in the purchase order then click Next to create another purchase order or Save and close the window Note You can also create POs starting at the Vendor Center and Transaction Center Want to create a PO starting with the info you ve already got on an estimate Here s how 1 Click Create Purchase Order 2 Choose whether you want to create the PO for All allowable items on the estimate good if you ve only got items from one vendor on the estimate or Selected items good if you ve got items from multiple vendors on the estimate 3 Select the items you want on your PO if you chose that option 4 Finish up any additional info on your PO click Save and send the PO off to your ve
55. an order for which you ve already sent an invoice or billing statement and received a payment So you need a credit memo A credit memo reduces the amount the customer owes you You can then issue a refund or apply the credit to future invoices Choose Customers gt Credit Memos Refunds Creating a credit memo and refund If a customer returns something then you give them a credit memo If you re refunding money to a customer create a credit memo first then write a refund check To create or edit a credit memo 1 Choose Customers gt Create Credit Memos Refunds 2 To create a credit memo click the Create a Credit Memo on the left panel or click the at the bottom of the list To edit a credit memo select a credit memo in the list on the left panel and edit the information 3 Enter the information for the credit memo refund and click Save Note You can also create sales forms using the Customer Center and Transaction Center What s on a credit memo e Customer Job Select the customer or job you want to create the credit memo for You can also enter a new customer job name and QuickBooks will prompt you to set it up QuickBooks will automatically alert you if you choose a customer job that has outstanding billable time or costs e Class If you re using classes choose which on you want to use If you don t see this you need to turn classes on in Preferences QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 126 e Customer T
56. and choose Edit gt Insert Line Likewise if you want to delete an item select the item then choose Edit gt Delete Line e Description The description of the item you entered when you created the item You can change this if you need to Tip You can enter multiple lines for your description up to 4095 characters Use Option Return to put in a line break e Quantity How many of the items does your customer need to pay you for This could be 400 antennae or 10 hours of web design If you leave this blank QuickBooks assumes the quantity is 1 Rate How much you charge the item If you entered this when you created the item QuickBooks enters it for you If you didn t or you need to change it just edit this box e Amount This is the total amount Quantity x Rate for this item that QuickBooks calculates for you QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 93 e Taxable If the item is taxable click this box e Customer Message A message for our customer either on from your Customer Messages list or enter a new one e Tax The tax item you assigned to the customer or the default tax if you have not assigned a tax item to the customer QuickBooks uses the tax item to calculate the tax You can also select a different rate from the list of tax items if you need to Other things to know about estimates e Create an invoice using an estimate To create an invoice that uses the info you ve got in an estimate click Create
57. and demand theory and change the prices Here s how To change prices to a specific amount 1 Choose Lists gt Items 2 Control click the item name and choose Change Prices from the shortcut menu 3 Select the type of item for which you want to change prices 4 Enter the new prices in the New Price column 5 Click OK To change prices based on a percentage 1 Choose Lists gt Items 2 Control click the item name and choose Change Prices from the shortcut menu 3 Select the type of item for which you want to change prices 4 Click Calculate Prices 5 Inthe column click the items to which you want the markup to apply Or click Select All to select all the items 6 Enter the markup in the field provided Enter either a dollar amount or a percentage If you are entering a percentage be sure to type a percent sign 7 Specify whether to calculate the markup based on the current sales price or the unit cost of each item 8 Click Apply and then click OK QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 76 Creating subitems Subitems let you create a hierarchy of items so you can group y Plants Trees information about similar items in sales reports and graphs Citrus Trees Fruit Trees To create subitems Hedges amp Shrubs r i i Pe 2 Misc Plants amp Flowers 1 If it doesn t exist yet add the parent item that is Ornamental the item that will have subitems first If you won t be using the parent item on
58. and displays your reports and graphs The selections you make affect the current company file only 1 Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences 2 On the Preferences pane select Reporting 3 Set the preferences described below 4 Close the Preferences window General e Summary Reports Basis Are you running an accrual or cash based business o Accrual QuickBooks reports income as occurring on the date of sale and expenses as occurring on the billing date o Cash QuickBooks reports income and expenses as occurring on the dates you actually receive cash or pay your bills You can always change the setting of an individual report by clicking Options in the report window and then selecting Accrual or Cash To change your sales tax liability report settings choose QuickBooks gt Preferences choose Sales Tax and then select As of invoice date accrual or Upon receipt of payment cash e Aging Reports Use either the due date or the transaction date for tracking unpaid invoices and bills e Show Accounts by Choose the name description or both on reports Also each report has an Options button that displays options you can use to manage the data shown on your report If you d like for the options to display every time you go to a report click Display Report Options window automatically Export Report As You can export reports as for either Microsoft Excel 2008 Apple Numbers 09 XLSX or Microsoft Excel 2004 SYL
59. assets To see the adjustment for this non cash expense in the Operating Activities section of the report click Operating for that account Incorrect You have an account called Truck expense that you use for all vehicle expenses including depreciation repair costs and fuel Removing this account from the report removes real expenses for repair costs and fuel causing numbers in the Statement of Cash Flows report to become incorrect QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 288 GJ Sales amp Invoicing preferences Sales amp Invoicing Sales amp Invoicing preferences control how QuickBooks behaves when you enter a sale 1 Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences 2 On the Preferences pane select Sales amp Invoicing 3 Set the preferences described below 4 Close the Preferences pane e Estimates Click Customer and or job estimates are prepared if you want to use QuickBooks to create estimates When estimating is on QuickBooks adds a Create Estimates command to the Customers menu and an Estimate button to the Customer Job list You can use either option to write a new estimate or display an existing estimate When this setting is off it does not mean that you lose the estimates you have written QuickBooks retains them even though you ve turned estimates off o Warn me about duplicate estimate numbers Select this option if you want QuickBooks to warn you when the estimate you are recording has the same number as an existi
60. begins with the text you enter o contains Apply the rule to any downloaded payee that contains with the text you enter o ends with Apply the rule to any downloaded payee that ends with the text you enter o exactly matches Apply the rule to any downloaded payee that exactly matches the text you enter Note The text you enter is not case sensitive so don t worry about uppercase vs lowercase 5 Use the second line the then line to tell QuickBooks what you want to do with transactions that meet the criteria of the first line o rename to Renames the downloaded payee to a vendor name you select If you don t see the vendor you want you can just enter the name and QuickBooks will prompt you to set up the vendor o don t rename The downloaded payee stays at it is and is not renamed This is useful for transactions such as checks The downloaded name is probably the word Check plus a number and you need to choose which payee that check actually went to You can create a rule that if the downloaded payee name contains check then don t rename it Then you can choose the payee name manually for each check to make sure it s correct QuickBooks adds a default list of these don t rename rules for checks deposits and withdrawals automatically 6 Click OK Editing a renaming rule Once you create a rule you can edit it to get make it work just the way you want To edit a renaming rule 1 Open the rule you
61. but QuickBooks does not provide a field for such as spouse s name or the vendor s birthday QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 152 Types of vendor transactions With vendors it s all about spending money You need stuff to run your business whether that s new inventory or just paper clips Now that you ve added vendors to QuickBooks you can create any transaction for a vendor from the Vendors menu or from the Vendor Center In this section you ll learn about the different transactions you use with vendors and when to use them You receive the things your ordered and need to pay for them OK now you ve received your order and you re ready to pay You have a few choices on how you do that e Check or Credit Card Charge If you want to pay the bill right away you can just write a check or use your credit card to pay the bill You record these transactions with Write Checks or Enter Credit Card Charges on the Banking menu Your balances reflect the payments right away Bill and Bill Payment You may want to pay the bill later say after you ve received payments from your clients or because you pay all your bills at once But QuickBooks should know you received this bill so that it can accurately tell you how much money you actually have Use Vendors gt Enter Bills to enter the information about the bill Once you pay the bill use Vendors gt Pay Bills to enter the payment Item Receipt If you receive the things y
62. choose it 3 Click Open 4 Close the Preferences window your choice is saved automatically That s it Your company file is restored and your Attached Documents Library is restored and connected to your restored company file QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 297
63. customer has a resale number enter the resale number This field is for your information what you enter will not affect your reports or how sales tax works in QuickBooks You can also create custom fields to capture information that is important to your business but QuickBooks does not provide a field for such as spouse s name or the customer s website Payment info if you use Merchant Services Note You must have an Intuit Merchant Account to process credit or debit cards for payment On the Payment Info pane enter customer credit or debit card information You must have a Merchant Service account that is connected to QuickBooks to see this pane You can then use the card s to process payment transactions for this customer To view transaction information for a card click the card in the Card Activity list then double click a transaction in the Card Activity list This accesses your online Merchant Service account Log in to view details on credit card transactions See page 117 for information about accepting credit cards as payment Notes When you open a customer or job in the Customer Center you ll see that each one has a Notes pane This is a notepad where you can keep notes about a customer or job e Click Date Stamp to add the current date to the note e Click New To Do to enter a note e Use To Do notes to remind yourself about tasks you need to complete by a certain date QuickBooks adds each note to the Reminders lis
64. customer or job you want to create the invoice for You can also enter a new Customer Jobs name and QuickBooks will prompt you to set it up QuickBooks will automatically alert you if you choose a Customer Jobs that has outstanding billable time or costs or if there s an open estimate for the customer QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 95 e Account If you have more than one Accounts Receivable account choose which on you want to use If you don t have more than one A R account you won t see this e Class If you re using classes choose which on you want to use If you don t see this you need to turn classes on in Preferences Bill to The address you have for the customer displays here This is how the customer contact information will appear here You can make any changes you need to Date Today s date which you can change Tip Press to increase the date by one day press to decrease the date by one day Invoice Number QuickBooks automatically increments this number by one for each new invoice Tip Press to increase the number by one press to decrease the number by one e PO Number If you re filling a purchase order PO from your customer enter that PO number here Terms When do you want to get paid Select the payment terms for this invoice Item Select what you are invoicing this customer for You can include anything on the Items list here You also enter a new item and QuickBooks will
65. default QuickBooks lists names in a hierarchy For example subitems are listed under the item they are a subitem of Click the arrow beside a name to view the names in the hierarchy below them You can also choose Flat View from the Action menu that lists each name plus the name below it in the hierarchy You can change the view by selecting Hierarchical View or Flat View from the Action menu e Print Save or Email the list Control click in the list and select commands to print save or email what is currently displayed on the list For example on the Item list control click the name of an item and then select Print Item List Save Item List as Text and Email Items List as PDF e View only active or inactive names Use the filters at the bottom of the list to view only active or inactive names e Display a QuickReport Create a report for a selected name that lists year to date income and expense transactions for the class you ve selected Select a name and then click QuickReport from the Action menu e Revert a list back to its default sort order With the list open choose Edit gt Re sort List Tips and tricks Try these tips and tricks to make using the lists even easier e Sort information by clicking the column titles e Rearrange the columns by clicking and dragging the top of a column to move it to another location Select multiple entries in one of these ways o Shift click to select a range of names
66. dollars and cents consider if it s worth it If you decide it s not and want to ignore the difference QuickBooks can enter an adjustment for the amount of the difference That way you ll start with accurate totals the next time you reconcile your account 1 Inthe Reconcile window click Reconcile 2 Inthe Reconcile Adjustment window click Enter Adjustment QuickBooks adds a balance adjustment transaction to your account register There is a 0 01 discrepancy between your statement and the transactions selected Click Return to Reconcile to correct this discrepancy so QuickBooks can have an accurate record of your income and expenses Look for transactions that are on your statement but not in QuickBooks Click Enter Adjustment to force QuickBooks to match your statement QuickBooks will post a journal entry to a Reconciliation Discrepancies expense account on your statement date This option is not recommended unless the discrepancy is too small to be worth correcting _Enter Adjustment _ The balance of the account changes by the amount of the transaction If you find and correct the source of the error later be sure to also delete the adjustment transaction QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 195 Handling bank errors You ll notice throughout this section that I m assuming the error is on your part Sorry to say this but in most cases it is But sometimes it s not you It s them Banks make
67. downloaded payee name that is the same as one of your vendors it goes ahead and creates a renaming rule Note After you create a renaming rule you may find it s too strict or maybe not enough You can always edit a rule if you need to One way to create a renaming rule 1 On the Downloaded Transactions window click the Payee column next toa Downloaded Payee you want to create a rule for 2 Inthe Payee column select or enter the name you want to use for the downloaded payee QuickBooks creates a new rule that renames the downloaded payee 3 Ifthe account is not prefilled for you select an account for the transaction Another way to create a new rule 1 On the Downloaded Transactions window download or import transactions from your financial institution If QuickBooks recognizes a downloaded payee name that is the same as one of your vendors it goes ahead and creates a renaming rule QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 186 2 Click Renaming Rules at the top of the window w Renaming Rules 3 On the Renaming Rules windows click the button at the bottom of the window 4 Setup your rule Think of your rule as an if then sentence If this happens then want QuickBooks to do this Use the first line the If line to tell QuickBooks what text to look for in the downloaded payee name So for the first part of your sentence pick an action and enter text o begins with Apply the rule to any downloaded payee that
68. end of the month Hannah uses Pay Bills to pay both Wright Top Hats and Carol s Rabbit Hutch QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 201 Next I m going to go into the details of what Hannah did when she stocked up QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 202 Hannah manages her inventory After getting operationally prepared to order and receive inventory Hannah has a Grand Opening for Hannah s Illusion Supplies Watch the video Send invoices to customers Following a booming first week of almost 20 orders Hannah creates invoices to include with each shipment The invoices include inventory items she s created QuickBooks automatically reduces her inventory by the number of items Inventory Part 3 Hannah adjusts her in she includes on the invoice Find out more ventory about invoices on page 95 http www qblittlesquare com 2011 03 vide Adjust inventory Only a month after her grand opening a pipe breaks in Hannah s storeroom and a dozen magic wands are damaged Now she ll have to make adjustments to her inventory manually With the sprinkler stopped and mess cleaned up Hannah uses Vendors gt Inventory Activities gt Adjust Quantity Value by Hand and reduces the number of magic wands she has available by 12 Note that you can also adjust value here too When you make an adjustment account work with your accountant about how you want to set that up Return inventory The following week Hannah notices
69. entering customer transactions In the next steps in this series I ll talk about entering banking and credit card transactions QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 19 Entering bank and credit card transactions When you entered your other transactions QuickBooks automatically recorded e Checks you wrote to vendors to pay your bills e Checks you wrote to pay sales tax you collected Deposits of payments your customers made to you And you can see all of this in QuickBooks Just go to your Chart of Accounts on your List menu and open your bank account You can see all of these transactions in that register There it all is Look at all the progress you ve made Why did I have you do this wanted you to see that a lot of your banking related transactions are already there You shouldn t enter any checks or deposits unless you re sure they aren t already in your register You don t want to end up with double payments and deposits You may want to print out this register Command P to use as a reference as you go along Gathering the information you ll need Here s what you ll need to enter your remaining transactions Remember you ll only need to enter transactions from the start date you entered for your company file to today e Checks you ve written Deposits you made Bank statements showing fees interest earned and transfers Credit card statements showing charges and payments made I
70. fast entry of a group of individual items already on the Items list e Discount Use for an amount to be subtracted from the total If you are applying the discount to more than one item you must first use a subtotal item and then apply the discount to the subtotal QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 64 e Payment Use for a payment you received at the time you write an invoice A payment item reduces the amount owed on an invoice e Sales tax item Use for calculating a single sales tax Sales tax group Use for calculating two or more sales taxes grouped together and applied to the same sale Adding or editing items When you choose an item throughout QuickBooks such as on an invoice QuickBooks fills in a description of the line item and calculates its amount for you Add items to your Items list so you can select them in other areas of QuickBooks To add or edit an item 1 Choose Lists gt Items 2 Add a new item or open an existing item o To add new Item click the menu at the bottom of the item list o To edit an existing item Double click the item name Or select the name of the item and click the Edit button at the bottom of the list 4 a Orin the Items list Control click the name of the item you want to edit and choose Edit Item from the shortcut menu 3 From the Type pop up menu choose the item type I ll go into what to enter for each item type in the following sections One thing to keep
71. how you correct them on your statements To correct overcharges if you haven t yet sent the statement 1 Open the customer s register 2 Find any incorrect charges Change the amounts of those charges 3 Click Record to save your changes 4 Reprint the statement QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 107 Tip 1 In the Select Statements to Print window make sure that the date range of the reprinted statement is the same as it was for the original statement Tip 2 If you are reprinting a statement for one customer only be sure to select the One customer option when the Select Statements to Print window appears Normally this window is set to print statements for ALL customers To correct overcharges if you ve already sent the statement 1 Create a credit memo to appear on the customer s next statement o Inthe Item column enter the item you overcharged This ensures correct accounting on your reports o Make the amount equal to the difference between the correct amount and the amount you charged the customer For example if you charged 15 00 when you should have charged 10 00 enter the credit as 5 00 o Inthe Memo field enter the description you want your customer to see on the printed statement For example you could enter Credit for overcharge o Check the date of the credit memo Make sure that the date falls within the date range of the customer s next statement 2 When it s time to bill your custome
72. iCal or Calendar To show this transaction to iCal or Calendar click Show in iCal c3 Print the check with other checks You can add this check to a queue of checks to print together at a later time Click Print Later Then when you re ready to print the check choose File gt Print Forms gt Checks You can add a logo change the fonts or make other changes on the Print window Clear how you ve split the check by items and expenses Click Clear Splits to clear the items on the Expenses and Items panes on the bill Recalculate the amounts If you make changes to the check you can recalculate the amount to reflect the change Apply a discount to a check To apply a discount from your vendor select the amount you want to apply the discount to in the Amt Paid column Click Discount Info p an Set preferences for your checks Click Format to open Checks preferences m Entering a charge or refund to your credit card You probably use your credit cards to pay for things for your business It s important that you enter those charges in QuickBooks so you can track them To enter a credit card charge 1 Choose Banking gt Enter Credit Card Charges 2 To enter a new charge click New on the left panel or click the at the bottom of the list To edit a charge select a charge in the list on the left panel If you don t see this list click the Left View View G 3 Enter the information for the charge and
73. in QuickBooks Setting up for 1099s If you work with vendors or subcontractors to whom you send 1099 MISC forms you can set up QuickBooks to track all 1099 related payments to each vendor To set up for 1099s 1 Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences and click 1099s and set your 1099 preferences 2 Close the Preferences window 3 Choose Vendors gt Vendor Center 4 For each 1099 vendor edit the vendor 5 On the Additional Info pane select the Vendor eligible for 1099 6 Click OK For more information about the Additional Info pane see page 151 For more information about 1099 preferences see page 275 Verifying 1099 Information To verify the accuracy of the amounts you ll be reporting to the IRS you can create two reports the 1099 report and the 1099 detail report Before you begin Display the 1099 MISC Setup window and check the threshold for each amount you report to the IRS If any of the threshold amounts have changed since you last printed 1099 MISC forms enter the new amounts in the 1099 MISC Setup window First verify your 1099 vendors 1 Choose Reports gt Vendors amp Payables gt 1099 Summary The vendors listed are the vendors for whom you selected the Vendor eligible for 1099 checkbox in the New Vendor or Edit Vendor window 2 Check the report for missing 1099 vendors o Press P to print the report in its current form o Inthe report buttonbar click Only 1099 Vendors Choose All Vendo
74. in mind is that you can change an item s type only under these circumstances o Service Non inventory Part or Other Charge A service non inventory part other charge or inventory part item If you are changing the item to an inventory part item the as of date you enter for the total value of the item must be a date that is AFTER the date of the last transaction that uses the item Note You cannot change a Service item to any other type You can change Charge and Non Inventory parts to Service and Inventory types o Anything else Nothing else You must leave the item type as it is 4 Enter the item name as you want it to appear on purchase and sales forms 5 Enter the item description as you want it to appear on purchase and sales forms You can enter multiple lines for your description up to 4095 characters Use Option Return to put in a line break 6 In the Rate field enter the amount you want to charge for the item QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 65 7 Inthe Account field choose the account that is associated with this item In most cases you will assign the item to an income account 8 Click OK or Next if you want to enter another item Creating service non inventory part or other charge items QuickBooks provides three different item types for products or services that you EITHER buy or sell e Service Services that you either charge for or purchase Examples include specialized labor and con
75. information QuickBooks automatically includes your company name title subtitle and today s date in the header You can also specify whether you want the header to print on all pages of the report or only on the first page QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 230 Change the footer information QuickBooks automatically includes the current page number and lets you add an extra line of text You can also specify whether you want the footer to print on all pages of the report or only on the first page If you want to change the alignment select an option from the alignment menu If you want to apply the header footer settings to all your reports click Apply to All QuickBooks uses the title and subtitle of each report but all other header footer settings you set here will apply to all reports Formatting fonts and numbers At the top of the report click Format and make your changes on the Format window To change fonts select the text area from the pop up menu and then the font and color Specify if you want to see simplified numbers by dividing them by 1 000 You can also choose to display cents in your amounts or zero amounts Select the format for negative numbers on your report For example 300 00 or 300 00 or 300 00 If you want to apply the format settings to all your reports click Apply to All Reports FAQs Try these tips and tricks to make using reports even easier How do I create reports and graphs
76. information about the job and click OK QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 89 Tracking items ordered especially for a job 1 2 3 Create a non inventory part item to represent each item you ordered When you set up each item be sure to select the This item is purchased for and sold to a specific customer job checkbox This lets you enter different rates for your cost and the sales price to your customer When you receive a bill for the items enter each non inventory part item in the detail area of the bill o Inthe Enter Bills window click the Items tab o Enter the name of each item in the Item column o For each item be sure to fill in the name of the customer or job in the Customer Jobs column This associates the customer with the cost of the item so you can invoice the customer later eee i When you invoice your customer click Time Costs to enter the cost of the Le items on the invoice o Inthe Create Invoices window click Time Costs o Inthe Choose Billable Time and Costs window click the Items tab o Inthe Use column click next to each item whose cost you want to include on the invoice On the invoice QuickBooks automatically fills in the sales price This may be higher than the cost you entered on the bill Paying subcontractors When you pay a subcontractor you can either write a check directly to the subcontractor or enter a bill and then pay the subcontractor later when you re payi
77. is off QuickBooks does not automatically calculate payments You need to click Auto Apply to see the results of your payment on the amounts for selected invoices o Warn about duplicate invoice numbers Let QuickBooks warn you when you try to record an invoice that has the same number as a previous invoice The warning causes QuickBooks to take more time to record an invoice If you are not concerned about duplicate numbers do not select this preference E Sales Tax preferences Sales Tax Sales Tax preferences define how you charge sales taxes on items you sell 1 Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences 2 On the Preferences pane select Sales Tax 3 Set the preferences described below 4 Close the Preferences pane Sales Tax preferences are applied per company file e Customers are charged sales tax Specify whether you charge your customers sales tax e Monthly Quarterly or Annually Specify how often you pay sales tax to your tax districts When you create a sales tax report QuickBooks uses either the previous month quarter or year as the basis for the report you can change the date range of the report if you need to In the QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 290 Pay Sales Tax window QuickBooks displays the sales tax due through the end of the previous month quarter or year e As of invoice date or Upon receipt of payment Specify when you are liable for sales tax e Most common sales tax Choose the tax item or grou
78. job estimates vs actuals here s what to do To track services performed by an owner or partner 1 Set up the owner or partner on the Other Names list Other Names is the best list to use since an owner or partner is not an employee vendor or customer 2 Create a new service item to represent the work done by the owner or partner o Select the This service is performed by a subcontractor checkbox o Inthe Expense Account field enter the name of the person s equity account on the list equity accounts are above expense accounts 3 To make the work of an owner or partner billable enter their time on either a weekly timesheet or single activity record o Enter the name of the service item you set up to represent the owner s or partner s work o Enter the name of the customer or job if you are tracking individual jobs for the customer o Make sure the time is billable 4 To invoice a customer for the owner s or partner s work click Time Costs when you are writing the invoice In the Choose Billable Time and Costs window click the Time tab Then select the work that you want to appear on the invoice 5 To make owner and partner time part of the job costs on reports but not affect the profit and loss statement write a zero amount check as follows o Write the check either in your regular checking account or in a special checking account that has no money in it You can set up the special checking account specifical
79. loss statement because it is not assigned to an expense account Estimating work you re going to do If a customer asks you for an idea of what you would charge for work the form you need is an estimate You ve probably received estimates yourself from service providers like a plumber or the guy who fixes your computer In other words estimates can be your first step in getting paid and getting paid is good Choose Customers gt Create Estimates Be sure to turn on estimates through QuickBooks gt Preferences gt Sales amp Invoicing gt Watch a video on how to create an estimate http www qblittlesquare com 2011 01 video creating an invoice in quickbooks 2011 for mac Q Watch a video on how Charlie the Web Designer uses estimates invoices and sales receipts http www qblittlesquare com 2011 01 which form do i use estimates invoices and sales receipts QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 92 To create or edit an estimate 1 Choose Customers gt Create Estimate How do use this form 2 To create a new estimate click the Create an Estimate on the left panel or click the at the bottom of the list To edit an estimate select an estimate in the list on the left panel 3 Enter the information for the estimate and click Save Note You can also create sales forms using the Customer Center and Transaction Center What s on an estimate e Customer Job Select the customer or job you want to cre
80. may not need to gather all of this information So if something in this list doesn t apply to you just ignore it One important thing to remember you only need to enter the transactions from the start date you entered when you created your company file until today You don t have to go back to the beginning of your business and enter years of information Whew Whether you ve been keeping paper or electronic records or a mixture here s what to gather up e Any estimates you ve sent to customers or potential customers You don t have to enter ones for jobs or sales you didn t get but you can if you want to e Invoices you sent to customers regardless of whether you ve received payment yet e Any credit memos you ve issued e Records of payments you ve received from customers Records of refunds you ve given e Records of deposits of customer payments you ve made to your bank e Record of sales tax payments you ve made e If you sell things details of what you sold preferably grouped to correspond with deposits of your sales income and records of deposits from sales receipts you gave Entering transactions Now you re ready to go As with vendors if you haven t set up your Items or Customers lists yet you ll be asked to add these as you go along Go ahead and do that You can go back to these lists later to enter more detail You can use the Customer area of the Home page to enter most of the
81. non inventory parts subcontracted services and reimbursable other charge items QuickBooks uses your sales price not your purchase cost If you want you can change the price on the invoice o Time QuickBooks uses the hourly rate for the service item you assigned to the task If you want you can change the rate on the invoice 6 Ifa particular item is an overhead cost that you are not going to pass on to the customer make sure that no check mark appears next to that cost in the Use column Tip If you know that you are NEVER going to invoice a customer for a cost you can remove the cost so that it no longer appears in the list Simply click in the Hide column next to the cost Hiding the cost won t remove its association with the job you ll still see the cost along with other job related expenses on job reports 7 Optional for expenses only Add a markup to the expenses you selected o Click the Expenses tab to bring it to the front o If necessary change the markup shown in the Markup amount or field QuickBooks fills in this field with the markup you set choose QuickBooks gt Preferences and click Sales amp Invoicing If you decide to change the markup here it applies only to this invoice You can enter the markup either as a flat amount for example 10 00 which QuickBooks would interpret as ten dollars or asa percentage for example 10 which QuickBooks would interpret as ten percent If you enter a perc
82. number 1 at the end of the name for example if the original bank account is ABC create a new account named ABC1 Rename the original existing account to the new name for example rename ABC to ABC1 Import the file I m no longer able to download bank transactions after converting from QuickBooks for Windows to QuickBooks for Mac After you convert the file to QuickBooks for Mac you must set up your online banking again within QuickBooks for Mac You can use either Web Connect or Direct Connect e I ve downloaded a qbo file and QuickBooks tells me it can t import the file You re qbo file may be corrupted Return to your financial institution s website and download the qbo file again then choose File gt Import from Web Connect to import the new file into QuickBooks Manually Importing Online Banking Using Web Connect you can manually import transactions from your online banking account First you need to download a transaction file qbo from your financial institution s website Then you import that file into QuickBooks To use Web Connect you must have the customer ID and password you use to sign in to your online account at your financial institution s website The first time you use Web Connect you must go through a setup process but after the first time you can skip the setup process QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 182 To use Web Connect for the first time 1 2 Choose Banking g
83. o Inventory and purchase orders are used Select this option if you want to create inventory part items write purchase orders and create inventory related reports You can change this later with Inventory preferences o Customer and or job estimates are prepared Turn the estimating feature on When estimating is on QuickBooks adds a Create Estimates command to the Customers menu and an Estimate button to the Customer Job list You can change this later with Inventory preferences o Keep track of time Turns on time tracking in your company file Track your time and or your employee s time by entering hours worked on weekly timesheets or single activity entry forms you can use the two forms interchangeably You can change this later with Time Tracking preferences 5 On the final window you ll see the location on your new company file Click OK QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 7 Next steps Congratulations You ve created your company file Now what do you do Well it depends Here are some suggestions e Have you been in business for a while and are just new to QuickBooks Then you probably have historical data for your company that you d like to enter into QuickBooks The good news is that you don t have to go back to the day you first started your business But suggest you do go back as far as the start date you entered when you created your company file Gather up everything from the start date to today and
84. of the places that send you statements may not technically be banks I m just going to use the term bank because it s a nice short word instead of financial institution What to look for So you have a difference in the balance for the account in QuickBooks and your bank statement It s time to go hunt down the mistake What do you look for to find the mistakes Here are some common reconciling errors 1 You mistakenly cleared transactions that weren t on your statement 2 You didn t mark all the transactions shown on your statement 3 You didn t notice an incorrect dollar amount on one or more items 4 You re missing transactions in your QuickBooks records that appear on the statement 5 You have not yet entered service charge or interest transactions that are included on your bank statement Or perhaps you entered these items in the Reconcile window but they re already listed among the transactions in the window Sometimes you may find it easier to find these errors in printouts rather than on your screen You can run a report like the Transaction Detail report and filter the report for the account you re reconciling and for cleared or uncleared transactions whichever you re researching You can also filter for transaction types such as checks deposits or payments This report may be easier to QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 193 look at than your register where transaction types are mixed Y
85. or entry on the list Export files only A unique number that identifies the company file from which you exported the Other Names list Export files only A unique number that identifies an entry in the list The person s address The person s phone number The person s alternate phone number The person s FAX number The name of your primary contact Your notes about this person If you are creating an import file the notes appear in the Notepad window for this person The person s salutation or title Mr Ms Doctor etc The name of the person s company QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 267 FIRSTNAME MIDINIT LASTNAME The person s first name The person s middle initial The person s last name Payment Method list PAYMETH Import and export files can contain the list of payment methods you use in QuickBooks The keyword for the Payment Method list is PAYMETH NAME TIMESTAMP REFNUM Required The name of the payment method Export files only A unique number that identifies the company file from which you exported the Payment Method list Export files only A unique number that identifies an entry in the list Ship Via list GHIPMETH Import and export files can contain the list of shipping methods you use in QuickBooks The keyword for the Ship Via list is SHIPMETH NAME TIMESTAMP REFNUM Required The name of the shipping method Export files only A unique number that i
86. payments e Current liability Liabilities that are scheduled to be paid within one year such as sales tax accrued or deferred salaries and short term loans e Long term liability Liabilities such as loans or mortgages scheduled to be paid over periods longer than one year e Equity Owner s equity including capital investment drawings and retained earnings Income and expense accounts Income and expense accounts track the sources of your income and the purpose of each expense When you record transactions in one of your balance sheet accounts you usually assign the amount of the transaction to one or more income or expense accounts For example not only do you record that you took money out of your checking account but you keep track of what you spent the money on utilities office supplies etc To display a balance for income and expense accounts choose Reports gt Company amp Financial gt Profit amp Loss or select the income or expense account in the chart of accounts and then choose QuickReport from the Action pop up menu 3 QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 48 Your Chart of Accounts Remember in the previous section talked about accounts being like 6 8090 RockCastle Construction Chart of Accounts shoeboxes where you kept the Q Filter Accounts records of all your transactions Well you ll need someplace to E aa 10300 Savings 17 910 19 store and manage those 10400
87. prompt you to set it up Tip If you need to insert an item between two others select the item line where you want the new one and choose Edit gt Insert Line Likewise if you want to delete an item select the item then choose Edit gt Delete Line e Description The description of the item you entered when you created the item You can change this if you need to Tip You can enter multiple lines for your description up to 4095 characters Use Option Return to put in a line break e Quantity How many of the items does your customer need to pay you for This could be 400 antennae or 10 hours of web design If you leave this blank QuickBooks assumes the quantity is 1 Rate How much you charge for the item If you entered this when you created the item QuickBooks enters it for you If you didn t or you need to change it just edit this box e Amount This is the total amount Quantity x Rate for this item that QuickBooks calculates for you e Taxable If the item is taxable click this box e Customer Message A message for our customer either on from your Customer Messages list or enter a new one e Tax The tax item you assigned to the customer or the default tax if you have not assigned a tax item to the customer QuickBooks uses the tax item to calculate the tax You can also select a different rate from the list of tax items if you need to Other things to know about invoices Q Add time and costs to your invoice
88. rounds the individual tax amounts to the nearest cent the total for tax group may be slightly different than the total you would get if you combined the rates of the individual taxes and applied the single rate to the sale Don t worry about this discrepancy QuickBooks calculates and reports each individual tax amount correctly QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 218 Keeping track of how much tax you owe QuickBooks provides three ways to find out how much tax liability you are accruing the sales tax liability report the Sales Tax Payable register and the Pay Sales Tax window Sales tax liability report See a summary of how much you have billed or collected on behalf of each sales tax agency e Sales Tax Payable register Scan the tax related transactions QuickBooks has recorded in your Sales Tax Payable register e Pay Sales Tax window See how much you owe each tax agency Pay the sales tax your business owes Creating a sales tax liability report The sales tax liability report provides complete information about the sales tax your company owes for a particular period QuickBooks displays your sales tax liability in reports on an accrual basis unless you changed the setting see below To display the report 1 Choose Reports gt Vendors amp Payables gt Sales Tax Liability 2 Check the dates shown in the From and To fields If you want the report to cover a different period of time do one of the follow
89. see the next section or items skip the next section and to the one on page 161 such an inventory part non inventory part service or other charge Other things to know about bills View payment history for the bill Click history to see the payments for this bill a2 ry Clear how you ve split the bill by items and expenses Click Clear Splits to clear the items on the Expenses and Items panes on the bill E Recalculate the amounts on your bill If you make changes to the bill you can recalculate the amount due to reflect the change Add payment reminder to iCal or Calendar Click the iCal button to remind yourself to pay this bill QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 159 Tracking expenses related to a bill On the Enter Bills window use the Expenses pane at the bottom of the window to enter non item expenses like electricity expenses for a bill from the utility company or postage expenses that are part of inventory items you ve received eee Enter Bills 7 Litt lB Le Le Prev Next History Clear Splits Recalc Filter GE cei A Bili Received Patton Hardware Supplies Sort by Date Summary a sib New Bill Phone 415 555 1370 Patton Hardware Sup 5 064 00 Email ES CESE Open balance 4 479 20 Vu Contracting 1 250 00 Vendor Patton Hardware Supplies Date 12 15 13 POs to be received o 12 15 13 Ref No 5 099 00 Recent Transactions a Thomas Kitchen amp Bath 585 00 t oae seee pa
90. see which inventory items you need to reorder look at the Order column A check mark in that column means that your stock of the item has fallen below your reorder point To determine whether you need to reorder QuickBooks takes into account the quantity you currently have on order If the quantity on hand plus the quantity on order is less than the reorder point QuickBooks puts a check mark in the Order column 4 To print the report press Command P QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 211 5 To create a report that shows how QuickBooks calculated the average cost fora particular item double click that item s entry in the report Creating a price list QuickBooks automatically keeps track of the prices you charge for the items you sell You can draw upon this information to create a price list To create a price list 1 Choose Reports gt Inventory gt Price List 2 To print the report press Command P Breaking down the value of your inventory QuickBooks provides several statistical measures of the value of your inventory To break down the value of your inventory 1 Choose Reports gt Inventory 2 Choose one of the following o Valuation summary To see for each inventory item the quantity on hand average cost asset value of total asset value retail value and of total retail value o Valuation detail To see for each inventory item the opening balance ending balance and every transaction purchase or s
91. settings 6 Click Print Print a list including Centers You can print any list in QuickBooks like your Chart of Accounts or your Customer list 1 Open the list you want to print 2 Press Command P to print the list A Print window appears with options that will be familiar to you if you ve printed from other Mac software Make any adjustments you want 3 Click Print Print a report 1 In Report Center select the report and click Print at the bottom of the center 2 Display the report and choose File gt Print Report or Command P To fit the entire report on one page choose QuickBooks from the print options pop up menu and select the Shrink to Fit checkbox Print a register 1 From your Chart of Accounts open the register you want to print 2 Choose File gt Print Register or press 4 P QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 251 3 At the bottom of the Print window enter the date range of the transactions you d like to print and then click OK 4 To print the detail lines for each transaction select the Show transaction detail checkbox The register itself does not show the detail lines 5 Click Print Troubleshooting printing If you re having trouble with printing check out these troubleshooting tips e When I print lines on invoices on blank paper or letterhead with my laser printer the vertical line is missing on one side How can correct this Customize the alignment on your invoic
92. sure they match Hey upgraders we ve made a bunch of changes we like to call them improvements to Reconcile in QuickBooks for Mac 2014 Before you begin Before you reconcile your accounts check these things Be sure you re up to date on entering your transactions in QuickBooks You know that check you wrote last week for your rent but didn t enter in QuickBooks Or the bills you paid but haven t marked them as paid in QuickBooks Do that now Enter all transactions that haven t cleared or shown up on previous bank statements e The very first time you reconcile check the Opening Balance transaction on your bank accounts in your Chart of Accounts They should reflect the amount that was actually in your account when you began using QuickBooks If it doesn t you can fix this by o In your Chart of Accounts open the register for the account double click the account name and change the Opening Balance transaction to match the ending balance from the last bank statement you received before you started using QuickBooks o Or you can create an opening balance adjustment at the end of your first reconciliation We ll get to this later o After your first reconciliation the Opening Balance should match the Ending Balance from your previous Reconciliation report Step 1 Choose the account you want to reconcile 1 If you use online banking in QuickBooks download your account statement If you don t use online banking
93. that 3 of the top hats in a recent shipment are crushed and she returns these to Wright s Top Hats She chooses Vendors gt Enter Bills again but this time selects Credit at the top and selects Wright s as the vendor and top hats as the items QuickBooks decreases the quantity of Top Hats on hand and creates a credit that she can apply to her next bill from Wright s Keep track of inventory Hannah keeps tabs on her inventory through the Inventory reports such as Inventory Stock Status by Item She can also print a Physical Inventory worksheet that she can use to take inventory manually QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 203 Setting up inventory Now that you ve got an overview of how inventory works thanks to Hannah and her shop let s take a look at the details of each part of managing your inventory Here s what you need to know to set up inventory in QuickBooks Turn on inventory tracking Before you can start tracking inventory you need to turn on inventory tracking To turn inventory tracking on 1 Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences and then click Inventory 2 Select the Inventory and purchase orders are active checkbox Before you can start tracking inventory you need to turn on inventory tracking To turn inventory tracking on e Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences and then click Inventory Select the Inventory and purchase orders are active checkbox Set up accounts for inventory
94. the Preferences pane Data Entry preferences Data Entry Data Entry preferences set how you want to enter data in QuickBooks such as whether QuickBooks should automatically enter decimal points or if you want to use QuickFill 1 Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences 2 On the Preferences pane select Data Entry 3 Set the preferences described below 4 Close the Preferences pane Pressing Return moves between fields o On When you press Return the cursor moves to the next field on the form o Off When you press Return QuickBooks records the current transaction QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 279 Automatically place decimal point When you enter a number with no decimal point o On QuickBooks automatically inserts a decimal point between the second and third digit from the right For example if you type 4995 the number becomes 49 95 o Off QuickBooks places a decimal point at the end when you enter a number with no decimal point For example if you type 4995 the number becomes 4995 00 QuickFill transactions Only for bills checks and credit card charges o On When you enter a name QuickBooks automatically completes the transaction by filling in what you entered in the last transaction of that type for that person o Off QuickBooks does not complete transactions automatically You still have the ability to use a transaction from the Memorized Transaction list however Warn when deleting a tr
95. the export file was created Item list INVITEM Import and export files can contain all the information on your Item list The keyword for an entry in the list is INVITEM NAME Required The name of the invoice item TIMESTAMP Export files only A unique number that identifies the company file from which you exported the Item list REFNUM Export files only A unique number that identifies an entry in the list INVITEMTYPE Required Indicates the type of invoice item If you are creating an import file use one of these keywords to indicate the item type COMPTAX Sales tax item DISC Discount item GRP Group item groups several invoice items into a single item INVENTORY Inventory part item OTHC Other charge item PART Non inventory part item QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 265 DESC PURCHASEDESC ACCNT ASSETACCNT COGSACCNT PRICE COST TAXABLE PAYMETH TAXVEND TAXDIST TOPRINT PREFVEND REORDERPOINT EXTRA PMT Payment item SERV Service item STAX Sales tax group item SUBT Subtotal item A description of the item as you want it to appear in the Description column on invoices credit memos and sales receipts Inventory part items only A description of the item as you want it to appear on purchase orders Required The name of the income account you use to track sales of the item The type of this account should be INC Inventory part items only The name of the
96. the invoice number etc The memo text associated with the distribution line Indicates whether the distribution amount has cleared These keywords can appear in the CLEARED field Y Yes The amount has cleared N No The amount HASN T cleared P Pending The unit cost of the item The number of items sold This value is part of a line item on an invoice credit memo or sales receipt Type of items sold This value is part of a line item on an invoice credit memo or sales receipt On asales receipt indicates the method of payment check Visa etc that the customer used Indicates that a line item on an invoice credit memo or sales receipt is taxable Indicates the status of the distribution amount as a reimbursable expense These keywords can appear under REIMBEXP QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 271 NONEED Indicates that the distribution amount does not qualify as a reimbursable expense NOTHING Indicates that the distribution amount can be billed toa customer as a reimbursable expense THISWAS Indicates that the distribution amount is a reimbursable expense that appears on an invoice or sales receipt HASBEEN Identifies a distribution amount on a check that has been billed to a customer as a reimbursable expense EXTRA Adds additional information about the distribution line These keywords can appear in the EXTRA field ENDGRP Invoices credit memos and sales receipts only Indicates that
97. the item QuickBooks enters it for you If you didn t or you need to change it just edit this box e Amount This is the total amount Quantity x Rate for this item that QuickBooks calculates for you e Taxable If the item is taxable click this box e Customer Message A message for our customer either on from your Customer Messages list or enter a new one e Tax The tax item you assigned to the customer or the default tax if you have not assigned a tax item to the customer QuickBooks uses the tax item to calculate the tax You can also select a different rate from the list of tax items if you need to To write a refund check When you need to refund a customer some money create a credit memo first Then you can write a refund check 1 Open the credit memo you want to use for the refund 2 Click Refund at the top of the window K Refund 3 Make sure all the information on the check is correct Caution Leave Accounts Receivable as the account in the detail area of the refund check This ensures that QuickBooks will account for the credit and refund correctly 4 Click OK QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 127 Although you have recorded both the credit memo and the check you still need to connect the check to the credit memo so that QuickBooks can track the transaction correctly You use the Receive Payments window to connect the two To connect the refund check to the credit memo 1 Choose Customers gt Rec
98. the list 3 From the Type list select Sales Tax Item 4 Enter a tax name This name becomes one of the available sales tax choices when you fill in a sales form 5 Enter a description to describe this sales tax on your sales forms The description prints on your sales forms after the final line item You cannot edit it on the forms themselves 6 Enter the tax rate QuickBooks assumes the rate is a percentage For example enter 7 25 if the rate is 7 25 7 Enter the tax agency to which you pay the tax If the tax agency is not already on your Vendor list QuickBooks adds it to your list now QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 73 Importing items in batches Got spreadsheets full of inventory items service items or non inventory part items You can import them directly into QuickBooks along with all the info you ve got about them You can watch a video to see how to import items from a spreadsheet http www qpblittlesquare com 2012 09 importing items Before you import your items Hang on a sec Importing your item spreadsheets into QuickBooks isn t quite as simple as just copying the contents of your current spreadsheet going into QuickBooks and hitting Paste You ll be much much happier if you take a few minutes to prep both your spreadsheet and your QuickBooks company file 1 Follow Steps 1 3 in the To import items procedure down below this section 2 Take a look at the columns on the QuickBooks spread
99. the vendor list and click Import Multiple e Create a transaction Click the menu at the bottom of the transactions area and choose the type of transaction you want to create e Search for a vendor Use the search field above the vendor list to find the vendor name you need e Edit a vendor Select the name of the vendor and then click Edit Vendor in the top right corner of the center QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 147 Keep notes about a vendor Select a vendor and click Add Note or Edit Note in the top right corner of the center e Get a map or driving directions Select the name of a vendor and click Map or Directions Intuit Maps displays the map of or directions to the vendor s address You must be online to get maps and directions I m getting an error with Maps and Directions e Add vendor contact information to Address Book Turn on Contact Sync Company gt Contact Sync Settings Select names of vendors you want to sync with Address Book and then Control click and select Sync Vendor s with Address Book A symbol amp displays to remind you which names are synced How does Contact Sync work e Filter the information you see You can filter the vendor list as well as the transactions by using the filters located under each list For example you can select Vendors with Open Balances from the View pulldown menu under the customer list then select a customer name Then you can use the filters u
100. to see e You can set QuickBooks to back up your attachments as long as you re in single user mode Go to QuickBooks gt Preferences and check Back up attached documents library e After you ve scanned an attachment in you can change its name by selecting it in the Attachments window double clicking the name and changing it But there s a trick you need to know You re only changing the name of the attachment you see in QuickBooks not the name of the file saved on your disk QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 239 Attachments Center If you ve attached receipts photos contracts drawings or any other document to your QuickBooks records and transactions you can find all those attachments in the Attachments Center To open the Attachment Centers go to Company gt Attachments Center What can I do in the Attachments Center Lots of things Here they are Search for attachments To search for attachments enter a search term into the field at the top left of the Attachments Center window You can search for file names dates keywords in titles and any word in a PDF or text document If you ve got the OCR option turned on in your preferences you can also search for any words in image files e Preview attachments Select the attachment you want to preview Click to preview the attachment A bigger but not full sized version of the thumbnail of the attachment appears e Open attachments Double click the attachment you
101. to see more info about that area Editing a check To edit a check 1 Display the check in the Write Checks window or in your bank account register Tip You can use the Find command to find the check 2 Change as needed the content of the check Tip The register does not show all the fields on a check If you are working in the register and you need to see all the fields either double click the check or select the check and then click Splits Managing deposits Making a deposit QuickBooks lets you deposit multiple payments at one time as well as choose between printing both a deposit summary and slip or a deposit summary only To make a deposit 1 Choose Banking gt Make Deposits Note You can also make deposits using the Transaction Center QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 173 2 Inthe Payments to Deposit window click the payments you d like to deposit and then click OK You can also click the Select All or the Select None button If you are planning to print a deposit slip note that the slip can hold only up to 18 deposit transactions When you receive a payment from a customer and choose to Group with other undeposited funds the payment is listed here 3 On the Make Deposits window select the account you want to deposit into enter the date and enter any memo for the deposits 4 Inthe list of deposits enter any amounts to deposit that are not payments you received through sales to customers Click the
102. to void on the Payment Info pane Double click the transaction to go to your online Merchant Service account You can manage all your credit card transactions there Tracking GoPayment and other credit card transactions in Quick Books You don t have to process your customer s credit and debit cards in QuickBooks to track those transactions with QuickBooks You can process a customer s card using Intuit GoPayment or your QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 120 Merchant Services Portal and then download those records into QuickBooks and create transactions for QuickBooks to track To download card transactions made outside of QuickBooks 1 Choose Customer gt Credit Card Activities gt Downloaded Transactions et 2 At the top of the Intuit Payment Solutions J The customer has already Downloaded Transactions window set the date paid me Why do I need to create a sales receipt or an range for the card transactions you want to eee p download QuickBooks can only track 3 Click Download in the top left corner All the downloaded credit and debit card transactions were made with either Intuit GoPayment or using your Merchant Services Portal Now you need to create a transaction in QuickBooks to associate the charge to 4 On the Intuit Payment Solutions Downloaded Transactions window select the card payment you want to create a transaction for 5 Click Create Sales Receipt or Create Invoice 6 On the Enter Sales
103. vendor 3 Optional Enter the first digits of a zip code to limit the labels printed to addresses that match For example enter 94 to include addresses with zip codes 94041 94040 and 94043 4 Click Print 5 Optional On the Print window choose QuickBooks from the print options pop up menu and set the Placement Options and Alignment settings 6 Click Print Print 1099s 1096s 1 Choose File gt Print Forms gt 1099s 1096 2 Select the date range for your forms 3 Select the vendors you need to print forms for If the vendor isn t in the list add the vendor QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 250 4 Click Print 1096 or Print 1099 5 A Print window appears with options that will be familiar to you if you ve printed from other Mac software Make any adjustments you want 6 Click Print Print a deposit summary slip 1 When you make a deposit with the Make Deposit window still open click Print or choose File gt Print Deposit 2 Choose whether you d like to print a deposit summary only or a deposit slip and summary 3 Ifyou choose slip and summary choose whether to include cash in the deposit and whether to print check numbers on the deposit slip 4 Click OK A Print window appears with options that will be familiar to you if you ve printed from other Mac software Make any adjustments you want 5 Optional On the Print window choose QuickBooks from the print options pop up menu and set the Alignment
104. want to open or select an attachment then click Open for Preview The attachment opens in its native application Images and PDFs open in Preview This opened file is read only If you want to make changes to it you need to save it as a copy then go back to QuickBooks and attach it to a record or transaction e Open the QuickBooks record or transaction the attachments are attached to In the attachment s row click the link to the transaction or record you want to open It opens Export attachments 1 Select the attachment you want to export 2 Click and choose Export Document 3 Choose a folder to export the attachment to You can rename the exported attachment if you want to The attachment is saved to the folder you chose It stays put in the Attachment Center too and stays attached to its QuickBooks record or transaction e Delete attachments from the Attachments Center and the Attached Documents Library 1 Select the attachment you want to delete 2 Press Delete OR Click and choose Delete Document 3 QuickBooks asks you if you really want to delete this attachment Click OK QuickBooks deletes this attachment both from the Attachment Center and from the Attached Document Library If you ve got a copy of this attachment saved someplace else on your computer that copy isn t deleted But if the only copy of this file exists in the Attached Document Library be sure you want to delete it before you click OK QuickB
105. want to rename QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 187 o In the Downloaded Transactions window select a downloaded payee that has the rule applied that you want to change Then click the arrow next to the name and click Edit Rule EA Renaming Rules o Click Renaming Rules On the Renaming Rules windows double click the rule you want to edit or select it and click Edit ra 2 Change the rule and click OK For details see the previous section on creating a new rule Unlinking a QuickBooks account from an online banking account To link a different QuickBooks account to imported transactions you must disassociate the currently associated account first Note You must accept or delete any transactions still displayed in the Downloaded Transactions window before disassociating an account 1 Choose Lists gt Chart of Accounts 2 Select the account name and click Edit at the bottom of the Chart of Accounts LZ 3 Click Online Settings 4 On the Online Account Information window choose Not enabled from the Download Transaction list and then click Save 5 Inthe Edit Account window click OK You can now associate a different QuickBooks account with the imported transactions QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 188 Reconciling your accounts Reconciling may sound mysterious and scary but it s really not All it means is you check your QuickBooks records with your bank or credit card statements to make
106. with the highest level account If you are creating an import file use a colon to separate subaccount names TIMESTAMP Export files only A unique number that identifies the company file from which you exported the chart of accounts REFNUM Export files only A unique number that identifies the account in the list ACCNTTYPE Required The type of account If you are creating an import file use one of the keywords below to indicate the account type AP Accounts payable AR Accounts receivable BANK Checking or savings CCARD Credit card account COGS Cost of goods sold EQUITY Capital Equity EXEXP Other expense EXINC Other income EXP Expense FIXASSET Fixed asset INC Income LTLIAB Long term liability NONPOSTING Non posting account OASSET Other asset OCASSET Other current asset OCLIAB Other current liability OBAMOUNT The opening balance of the account If you are creating an import file enter the dollar amount WITHOUT a dollar sign DESC A brief description of the account ScD The tax line assigned to the account To specify the tax line enter its number tax line numbers come from the file BUSTAX SCD If you don t know the correct number leave this field blank You can always assign the tax line later after you import the chart of accounts into QuickBooks ACCNUM The account number of the account QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 261 EXTRA Budgets BUD Identifies an ac
107. with videos articles and Boat Little Sq UATE advice on how to get the most out of QuickBooks http www quickbooks com littlesquare Intuit Community sg Intuit hosts a community forum just for QuickBooks for Mac users This forum is monitored by both the team here at Intuit and advanced users It s a great place to ask questions and get assistance if you get stuck http community intuit com category quickbooks for mac In writing this guide I ve made certain assumptions that you should be aware of QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide First m assuming that you re at least somewhat familiar with your Mac and Mac OS It s OK if you ve just bought your first Mac and getting familiar with it As long as you know how to turn on your computer and open an app think we ll be fine As far as accounting principles I m going to assume you know nothing And that s OK If you ve been running your business for a while you probably have some basic bookkeeping principles down That s great and it will help you get up to speed But if you don t you re OK FII point you to some videos and other information that will show you some basic concepts that will be enough The screenshots I ve used in this guide were taking using Mac OS 10 7 Lion but everything works the same way on Mac OS 10 6 7 Snow Leopard and Mac OS 10 8 Mountain Lion Running QuickBooks Now let s talk about what you need to ru
108. you make the changes To get a copy create and print one of these budget overview reports Budget Overview Profit amp Loss Budget by Job Overview or Balance Sheet Budget Overview 2 For the budget amount you want to change choose the correct fiscal year account customer job if there is one and class if there is one 3 When QuickBooks displays the monthly budget amounts change the amounts as desired Graphing a budget After you set up your budget amounts you can view a graph that shows your budgeted vs actual amounts This lets you see the variance between your budgeted amounts and the actual amount you earned or spent To graph a budget 1 Choose Reports gt Budgets gt Budgets vs Actual Graph 2 Optional When QuickBooks displays the graph click the Dates button to change the date range for the graph 3 Optional Click any button on the graph buttonbar that allows you to group the data in a different way Creating reports about your budget QuickBooks offers six types of budget reports You can create these after you set up a budget To create reports about your budget 1 Choose Reports gt Budgets 2 Choose one of the following reports o Budget Overview Shows monthly budgeted amounts for each income and expense account for which you have entered a budget amount o Budget vs Actual Shows monthly budgeted amounts for each income and expense account for which you have entered a budget amount includi
109. you need a record of that payment for both you and the customer Giving your customers sales receipts When a customer pays you on the spot give them a sales receipt It s the same as when you go to a store and buy something They give you a receipt with your purchase That s exactly what you re doing You can also use sales receipts to summarize a day s sales if you don t want to record each sale one by one Create a customer named Daily Sales Summary if you want to do this You can print or email a sales receipt Choose Customers gt Enter Sales Receipts To create a sales receipt 1 Choose Customers gt Enter Sales Receipts 2 To create a sales receipt click the Create a Sales Receipt on the left panel or click the at the bottom of the list To edit a sales receipt select a sales receipt in the list on the left panel 3 Enter the information for the sales receipt and click Save Note You can also create sales forms using the Customer Center and Transaction Center What s on a sales receipt e Customer Job Select the customer or job you want to create the sales receipt for You can also enter a new customer job name and QuickBooks will prompt you to set it up QuickBooks will automatically alert you if you choose a customer job that has outstanding billable time or costs Tip for cash sales You can leave the Customer Job field blank unless you specifically want to add the customer to the Customer Jobs list
110. you want to invoice for the job in four equal phases enter 25 in the percentage field o Only certain items or different percentage for each item Choose this option to highly customize the amounts that you want to include on the invoice You ll find out how to do this in the next step For example you ve created an estimate for 1 000 You finished the first phase of the job and you want to invoice for 100 of items related to the first phase but don t want to invoice for anything else at this time When you select this option a window appears in which you can select the items you want include on the invoice and indicate the amounts or percentages for each item 3 Specify the amounts you want to include on the invoice and click OK The amounts shown are based on what you told QuickBooks you wanted to do in the previous step You can change any of the amounts on the invoice here but not any of the amounts on the original estimate Use the checkboxes at the bottom of the window to show more detail such as the quantity rate and percentages This completes one invoice in the series of invoices you are sending your customer To create the next progress invoice for this job start with Step 1 The next invoice picks up where you left off with the remaining amount on the estimate Tips for progress invoicing e If you usually invoice for phases of a job and you plan to turn your estimate into a series of progress invoices divide the estimate i
111. your favorite items onto the toolbar a amp B Accept Credit Cards Accounts Backup Budget Checks Q Search Your Data Customers Vendors Employees B a Credit Cards Credit Memos Customers Deposits Email PDF items Transactions ra a a 4 Employees Enter Bilis Enter Mileage Estimates Export Addresses Reports QuickBooks Invoices Drag any currently open window below onto the toolbar Enter Bills Checks Register Accounts Online Banking RockCastle Construction Home Page Turn on Payroll Accept Credit Cards Customize To customize your toolbar e Click Customize at the bottom of the toolbar On the sheet of icons you can e Change the icons on the toolbar Drag any icon you want to add to the toolbar Drag an icon off the toolbar to remove it You can also drag icons around on the toolbar to rearrange them QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 236 e Add a link to a window on the toolbar You can add a link to a window such as a report to the toolbar Open the window you d like to link to and then click Customize on the Toolbar Drag the window you want to add from the bottom of the customize window onto the Toolbar Type a description and pick an icon to use for the link e Resize the toolbar Drag the lower right corner of the toolbar down to lengthen it or up to shorten it e Move the toolbar Drag the toolbar s title bar to its new position e Hide the tool
112. 0 Acco 5 019 08 gt Carr s Pie Shop 0 00 Abercrombie Kris Payment 129342 8 15 13 12000 Unde 1 292 78 gt Castillo Eloisa 0 00 Abercrombie Kris Payment 8438 2 20 13 12000 Unde 5 019 08 gt Cook Brian 9 397 33 Abercrombie Kris Invoice 1044 6 7 13 11000 Acco 0 00 gt Craven Pam 0 00 Abercrombie siaa eee 1043 6 7 13 11000 Acco 1 292 78 ST E 0 00 Abercrombie Kris Unspecified 7000 6 7 13 90300 Sales 1 293 00 Abercrombie Kris Payment 12 15 13 10100 Chec 7 633 28 gt Duncan Dave 0 00 Abercrombie Kris Invoice 1091 12 10 13 11000 Acco 4 522 00 Dunn Eric C W 0 00 n n i Abercrombie Kris Invoice 1084 11 25 13 11000 Acco 3 111 28 aan aa 0 00 Abercrombie Kris Estimate 606 10 30 13 90200 Estim 3 114 00 Boeson 1 468 30 Abercrombie Kris Estimate 289 12 1 12 90200 Estim 5 019 08 p Fihan Jennies 0 00 Abercrombie Kris Estimate 613 12 12 13 90200 Estim 7 676 13 ei 0 00 Abercrombie Kris Credit Memo 4002 12 1 13 11000 Acco 711 15 gt Freeman Kirby 0 00 Ahercrombie Kris Check 476 12 1113 10100 Cher 711 15 View All Customers gt Ill View All Transactions Filter by Show All Date All Dates ol ae eel Note You can click Expand to expand the Customer Jobs list to the full Customer Center Tip Control click a customer or job name to choose common tasks from a shortcut menu To open the
113. 0 13 1092 Abercrombie Kr 4 522 00 12 10 13 1091 Pretell Real Esta 1 715 00 12 10 13 T San Domingo osma 247 50 T 350 00 450 00 475 00 1 522 50 0 00 0 00 0 00 114 19 1 636 69 Balance Due 1 636 69 cancel _ Save Cook Brian Kitchen Summary Phone 415 555 2248 bcook samplename com 3 979 33 Active estimates 2 Unbilled time expenses 3 030 00 Recent Transactions a 12 15 13 Invoice 12 11 13 Invoice x 11 25 13 Payment 4 225 41 11 25 13 Payment 2 580 00 11 25 13 Invoice 1 636 69 Notes A A cool thing you may not know about is that you can customize forms using Layout Designer and add Class to the columns on the invoice That way you can assign a class to each item on the form as I ve done below Item Description Quantity Rate Class Amount Installation Installation of 32 35 00 Landscaping 1 120 00 Rock Fountain ied Fountain Rock Fountain 1 375 00 Overhead 4 375 00 T Using classes in reports OK so I ve assigned classes in my transactions What does that get me Well now when I run reports can filter the report by Class So for example can use my Expenses by Vendors Summary report and filter it by the class Overhead Now I have a report that shows me expenses by vendor for all my Overhead transactions QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 144 Dates This Fiscal Year to date 01 01 13 12 15 1
114. 14 User s Guide 210 2 Select the sales summary template you want and then choose Use from the Action pop up menu amp 3 Complete the sales summary as follows o Inthe Quantity column enter the number you sold of each item o For items you didn t sell click the line item s entry and choose Edit gt Delete Line o Inthe Memo field enter the dates for the period you are summarizing When the price of an item changes You must create a new sales summary template that reflects the new price When you memorize the new template save it under the name you chose for the original template QuickBooks will then replace the original template with the new template Analyzing and adjusting your inventory You can use inventory reports the Items list and the Purchase Order list to get information about your inventory Checking your inventory status For any item in your inventory stock you can get view the reorder point current quantity on hand average cost to date and quantity on order To check the status of a single item 1 Choose Lists gt Items 2 Inthe list double click the inventory item whose status you want to check To check the status of your entire inventory 1 Choose Reports gt Inventory 2 Choose one of the following o Stock Status by Item Lists your inventory items alphabetically by item code o Stock Status by Vendor Groups your inventory items by preferred vendor This helps you reorder easily 3 To
115. 2011 03 vide o inventory part 2 hannah gets her stock There s no need to print the check as she s just recording the cash transaction Order stock with a PO receive items and bill Next Hannah creates a PO to order top hats from her preferred vendor Wright Top Hats When the items arrive several days later the bill is included with the top hats Hannah knows that back in QuickBooks she ll need to record that items have been received and that a bill was included Later that afternoon she chooses Vendors gt Receive Items and Enter a Bill Now QuickBooks knows she s received the items and that she has a bill to pay When she selects Wright Top Hats on the Enter Bills window QuickBooks tells her she has an open PO for this vendor She selects the open Purchase Order and QuickBooks fills in all the information from the PO on the bill Order stock with a PO receive the items without a bill After checking her cash flow Hannah creates another PO for an order of rabbits from Carol s Rabbit Hutch Before the rabbits are delivered Hannah receives an email from Carol that she ll be sending the bill later in the month When the rabbits arrive Hannah knows she ll need to create an Item Receipt as she doesn t have the bill In QuickBooks Hannah selects Carol s Rabbit Hutch and uses the open PO to create the item receipt When Carol sends the bill Hannah uses Vendors gt Bill for Received Items to record it At the
116. 279 280 281 282 282 283 283 Online Invoice Payments preferences Payroll preferences Reminders preferences Reporting preferences General Classify Cash Sales amp Invoicing preferences Sales Tax preferences Sounds preferences Time Tracking preferences Toolbar preferences Transactions preferences Users amp Passwords preferences 284 286 286 287 287 288 289 290 291 292 292 293 295 CHAPTER 1 Welcome to QuickBooks for Mac 2014 Welcome to Intuit QuickBooks for Mac 2014 We re glad you re here My name is Lisette and I ve been using QuickBooks for Mac for five years Yep that s me in the picture I ll be walking you through QuickBooks to show you how to get the most out of it Whether you re a new business owner or just new to QuickBooks hope you ll find this guide to be a helpful resource for getting to know QuickBooks For those of you who have used QuickBooks in the past welcome back You ll find information here on new features and maybe even something you didn t know about in addition to those features you used regularly In addition to this eBook we have other resources for you Q The QuickBooks for Mac Help is always there for you Anywhere you see a button just click it for answers Or choose Help gt QuickBooks Help And you can always go to the Help menu and search for a menu item or Help article mS Init QuickBooks for Mac Little Square is an online magazine
117. 3 Columns Total only RockCastle Construction Bare Expenses by Vendor Summary January 1 through December 15 2013 Jan 1 Dec 15 13 Bank of Anycity gt 1 389 06 Bayshore CalOil Service 1 588 70 Bayshore Water 264 00 Bruce s Office Machines 1 350 00 Cal Gas amp Electric 1 164 16 a Cal Telephone 841 15 Date This Fiscal Year to 1 1 2013 to 12 15 2013 Diane s Auto Shop 2 406 00 y Siaina seana Dd n East Bayshore Auto Mall 606 59 j East Bayshore Tool amp Supply 445 79 Express Delivery Service 104 20 Fay Maureen Lynn CPA 250 00 Kershaw Computer Services 714 00 Lew Plumbing 175 00 Mendoza Mechanical 25 00 Patton Hardware Supplies 2 349 89 Reyes Properties 1 200 00 Sergeant Insurance TOTAL QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 145 CHAPTER 6 Paying others Part of doing business is paying others for services or goods that other businesses have provided This probably isn t a mystery for you You do this in your non business life too You go to the store to buy things you need You pay bills for your utilities and your Internet service It works the same way with your business Vendor Center If you pay them they re a vendor Vendors are people or companies you pay because you ve bought things from them or they ve provided a service for you A vendor can be the electric company a supplier you buy inventory from or the contractor you hired t
118. 3 Choose the type of report you want to see o Summary Displays the account balances and reconciliation summary amounts only o Detail Displays each transaction cleared during the reconciliation period o Both Displays both the account balances and the transactions you cleared 4 Choose the Statement End Date for the reconciliation you want to see 5 Decide what kind of transactions you want this report to include o Transactions cleared at time of reconciliation A PDF file that s a snapshot of your account the moment after you reconciled it o Transactions cleared plus any changes made to those transactions since the reconciliation A live report that shows you the status of your account now QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 196 6 Click OK The report appears Click the Print button if you want a paper copy of the report you re looking at Use previous reconciliation reports to spot discrepancies So what s the use of previous reconciliation reports If you ve started a new reconciliation of an account and find that your Beginning Balance doesn t match the Ending Balance of your last reconciliation something s happened A transaction might have accidentally been un cleared after you last reconciled your account No big deal this happens all the time The previous reconciliation reports can help you quickly spot what s changed Here s how 1 Run both the Transactions cleared at time of reconciliation report and the Transac
119. 30 days if the terms are standard or 2 discount if paid by the 10th of the month net due by the 30th of the month if the terms are date driven e Credit limit Enter the credit limit that your company has with this vendor QuickBooks remembers the limit and warns you when you are about to exceed the limit e Opening balance as of These two fields apply only if you are setting up records for a new QuickBooks company To keep your records up to date enter all historical transactions from the day after your start date through today For example if you paid bills to this vendor between your start date and today you must enter those bills and record your payments in QuickBooks This allows QuickBooks to provide full financial reports for your company for any period of time after your start date e Tax ID If the vendor is a sole proprietor enter the vendor s social security number If the vendor is not a sole proprietor enter the vendor s nine digit tax identification number e Vendor eligible for 1099 Check if you plan to send a 1099 for this vendor If the checkbox doesn t appear on the Additional Info tab you need to set up QuickBooks for 1099 tracking For details see setting up 1099 tracking Other things to know e Add notes If you want to add any notes about the vendor go to the Notes pane QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 151 e Create custom fields Capture information that is important to your business
120. 40 you could associate an automobile expense account with the Schedule C Car and truck expenses tax line a If you don t Choose lt Not tax related gt from the Tax Line list Check with your accountant if you need more information about which tax forms to use and which tax lines to map to each account o Account is inactive Makes the account inactive You can then hide inactive accounts by selecting Active Accounts in the View menu at the bottom of the Chart of Accounts list o Online Settings If you use online banking with this account click Online Setup to see the settings for your online banking If you do not have online banking set up for this account and want to do so choose Banking gt Online Banking Setup and follow the screen instructions If you do have online banking setup for this account and want to disable it select Not Enabled from the Download Transactions list o Opening Balance Enter an opening balance for a balance sheet account a f you acquired the account before your QuickBooks start date See the QuickBooks User s Guide for details on how to calculate the opening balance a f you acquired the account after your QuickBooks start date Leave the opening balance at 0 00 and enter the opening balance as a transaction in QuickBooks For example if you open a new savings account using 500 from your checking account enter a check for 500 and assign the transaction to the new savings account in the d
121. 60 3 Select the correct account from the Account pop up menu eea0 Transfer Funds Between Accounts Date 12 05 13 Transfer Amount 25 000 00 Transfer Funds Kccount 10300 Savings i Account Balance 17 910 19 To Account 10100 Checking Account Balance 46 969 10 Memo Funds Transfer Previous Next Cancel Using a general journal If you re familiar with adjusting entries in a general journal you can use the General Journal Entry window to enter debits and credits Important QuickBooks provides the general journal for bookkeepers who know debits from credits and who prefer to enter certain transactions in a general journal If you are unfamiliar with how a general journal works you do not need to make journal entries To make a journal entry 1 Choose Banking gt Make General Journal Entries Note You can also make journal entries using the Transaction Center 2 To enter a new entry click the New Entry on the left panel or click the at the bottom of the list To edit a check select a check in the list on the left panel If you don t see this list click the Left View View ENJ E 3 Ifyou want the date of the transaction to be different than today s date change the date that QuickBooks filled in 4 Fill in the entry number of the transaction 5 Inthe Account column of the detail area enter the first account in your transaction Then enter the debit or cre
122. 94 Transferring funds between accounts 194 Let QuickBooks make a an adjustment transaction 195 Handling bank errors 196 Viewing and printing previous reconciliation reports 196 Use previous reconciliation reports to spot discrepancies 197 CHAPTER 8 Selling things 198 Inventory 198 Hannah sets up her inventory 200 Turn on inventory tracking 200 Create inventory items 200 Set up accounts 200 Hannah purchases her inventory 201 Buy stock with cash 201 Order stock with a PO receive items and bill 201 Order stock with a PO receive the items without a bill 201 Hannah manages her inventory 203 Send invoices to customers 203 Adjust inventory 203 Return inventory 203 Keep track of inventory 203 Setting up inventory 204 Turn on inventory tracking 204 Set up accounts for inventory 204 Add inventory items 205 Buying inventory 206 Buying goods on the spot 206 Receiving items and getting a bill later 206 Receiving items with a bill included 209 Selling your inventory 210 Creating a sales summary 210 Analyzing and adjusting your inventory 211 Checking your inventory status 211 Creating a price list 212 Breaking down the value of your inventory 212 Listing your open purchase orders 212 Adjusting your inventory 213 Taking a physical inventory 213 Sales tax 214 Setting up tax rates and agencies 215 Identifying your most common tax rate 216 QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide Indicate who and what gets taxed 216 Marking items
123. Be sure you have the most recent version of QuickBooks Choose QuickBooks gt Check for QuickBooks Updates o QuickBooks updates the list of financial institutions once a day To get to most recent list quit QuickBooks and open it again You must be online for the list to be updated e What if don t know where my account is held A financial institution may offer online services in different ways or at different costs in different areas Usually the options represent geographical areas Select the option that best represents your location If you are not sure contact your financial institution e Customer service at my financial institution is telling me to enter information that isn t in QuickBooks The customer service representative at your financial institution may be giving you instruction on using Direct Connect when you using Web Connect or the other way around With Direct Connect QuickBooks needs more information to access your online banking account automatically With Web Connect you download a file manually from the financial institution s website Be sure the representative is clear about which service you want to use Not all financial institutions support both services Using Direct Connect can t get Direct Connect to work If you re having trouble setting up Direct Connect use this checklist o Check your Internet connection You must be connected to the Internet for Direct Connect to work o Be sure your finan
124. Books Before you process a credit card payment through the Merchant Service for QuickBooks it s important to understand the following information Ship within 24 hours Visa and MasterCard association rules require that you do not charge the cardholder for the purchase until the product has been shipped as opposed to charging the customer on the date the product was ordered or authorized Card swiped transactions Available only for merchant accounts supported by Merchant Service for QuickBooks For a card swiped transaction the merchant swipes the credit card through a terminal or other device that reads the card s magnetic stripe Card swiped transactions qualify for a lower discount rate because they carry a lower risk of credit card fraud If you do repeat business with a customer you must swipe the credit card every time you process it to receive this lower rate for each transaction QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 118 Whenever you are unable to swipe the card for example if the card s magnetic stripe is damaged it s a good idea to imprint of the card and complete a sales slip Imprinting the card proves that the card was physically present if a customer later disputes a charge Key entered transactions For a key entered transaction the credit card does not need to be physically present to authorize the transaction as it does if you use a card reader Instead the information is processed over the Internet as
125. Choose Edit gt Delete Account Notes e Subaccounts If the account has subaccounts either move the subaccounts to another parent account or delete the subaccounts before you delete the parent account e Merging accounts Consider merging the account with another account instead of deleting it before deleting the account you would have to reassign all the transactions that post to the account QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 54 Numbering your accounts You can set up your Chart of Accounts to show an account number next to each account name To set up account numbering 1 Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences and then click Transactions 2 Select the Use account numbers checkbox 3 Optional Select the Show lowest subaccount only checkbox This option shows you only the account you are working with when entering transactions For example the expense account on a check would be shortened to 5411 Main rather than the full account path 5400 Rent 5410 Office 5411 Main To number your accounts 1 Choose Lists gt Chart of Accounts 2 Select the account name and click Edit at the bottom of the Chart of Accounts ra 3 In the Number field enter the number of the account You do not have to assign account numbers to your Sales Tax Payable or Undeposited Funds accounts QuickBooks assigns numbers to these accounts automatically Notes e QuickBooks inserts the account number before the account name i
126. Everyone using the company file must have a user name and password Here s an overview but to learn more about user accounts see page 295 To create user accounts 1 Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences and then Users and Passwords or choose Company gt Users and Passwords 2 Create an administrative user 3 Create a user account for each user who will be working with the company file in multiuser mode QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 29 Note Creating user accounts is not the same as adding users to your license A user account creates a username and password so a user can log into a company file Adding a user allows another user to run another copy QuickBooks with your license in multiuser mode Find out more about the difference between user accounts and user seats Step Four Start multiuser mode On the computer with QuickBooks Server 1 Open your company file in QuickBooks like you would normally 2 Login as the administrator You must be an administrator to start multiuser mode 3 Choose File gt Enable Multiuser Mode QuickBooks Server will start automatically When other users open QuickBooks on their computers they can open the company file It will be listed under Shared Files on the No Company Open window QuickBooks server QuickBooks Server is an application used when you re running QuickBooks in multiuser mode It shares your company file with other QuickBooks users on the same network When a file is shared
127. Got business bank accounts Start bookkeeping with your biz s real money add your business bank and credit card accounts Make money gt Spend money gt Other cool stuff you can do in QuickBooks Using the checklist is probably the fastest way to go from no company file to using QuickBooks daily to manage your business efficiently If you re upgrading you too can use Set Up and Go Your tasks are mainly about confirming your data and taking a look at QuickBooks features that may be new to you This is what the Set Up and QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 11 Go checklist includes when you already have a Company file Set Up and Go Y Confirm Data Run Reports Reports are the best way to check your data QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide Importing customers vendors and employees You probably have contact information for the people you work with customers vendors employees in places like Gmail or LinkedIn You can import those contacts into QuickBooks Note If you use Contacts or Address Book you can sync your contacts with QuickBooks so that updates are available in QuickBooks Contacts Address Book and other devices you sync with Address Book For more on Contact Sync go to page 86 Before you start You ll need a spreadsheet of the contacts you want to import into QuickBooks If you have one great Go to the next section If you don t have a spreadsheet
128. INTUIT QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide by Shelly King Liz Hamill E Lisette Gerald Yamasaki and the QuickBooks for Mac team Version 1 0 September 23 2013 Acknowledgements No guide of this size and scope is written by a single person I d like to thank the other members of the QuickBooks for Mac team including Kimberly Gehant and Liz Hamill and especially Brooks Bell and Devon Hubbard Also this book is another generation of other guides that came before it I m very grateful for those guides A super special thank you to Shelly King without whom this guide would not exist Copyright and trademarks Copyright 2013 Intuit Inc All rights reserved Unauthorized reproduction is a violation of applicable laws Intuit the Intuit logo QuickBooks Quicken and TurboTax among others are registered trademarks and or registered service marks of Intuit Inc Other parties marks are the property of their respective owners Various QuickBooks products and services are protected by pending patents and by one or more of the following U S Patents 5134564 5423033 5649115 5842185 5903881 and 6446048 Trademarks Intuit the Intuit logo QuickBooks Quicken QuickBase TurboTax EasyStep and QuickZoom among others are registered trademarks and or registered service marks of Intuit Inc in the United States and other countries Mac the Mac logo and the Built for Mac OS X logo are registered trademarks of Apple
129. Invoice add icon To learn lots more about how this works read up on Progress Invoicing e Create a purchase order using an estimate Need to buy the stuff you ve got recorded on an estimate 1 Click Create Purchase Order 2 Choose whether you want to create the PO for All allowable items on the estimate good if you ve only got items from one vendor on the estimate or Selected items good if you ve got items from multiple vendors on the estimate 3 Select the items you want on your PO if you chose that option 4 Finish up any additional info on your PO click Save and send the PO off to your vendor e Make an estimate inactive If you have multiple estimates for a job and your customer has accepted one of the estimates you might want to make the unaccepted estimates inactive When you make an estimate inactive QuickBooks keeps a record of it but does not use the estimate numbers in reports QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 94 Getting paid for work you ve done You ve done the work or delivered the goods and now you want to be paid You have two approaches you can use to get the money ball rolling With both options you can either print a paper version to drop in snail mail to your customer or you can email a PDF e Invoice An invoice is a request to be paid When you create an invoice QuickBooks then sees that the customer now officially owes you money So you might send an invoice for each job you complete
130. Jobs amp Time submenu of the Reports menu e First day of work week Sets the first day of your company s work week For example if you choose Wednesday your timesheets will show all workweeks as beginning on Wednesday and ending on Tuesday e Record Time button opens Sets what happens when you click Record Time o Single activity As you enter single activity entries for a person QuickBooks also records the entries on that person s weekly timesheet To view an employee s weekly timesheet click Timesheet in the Single Activity window o Weekly timesheet To display a single activity entry form when you are viewing a weekly timesheet follow these steps 1 Inthe timesheet find the column for the day for which you want to display a single activity record 2 In that column find the row where the customer job and service item are correct for the activity Click that row in the column 3 Click Edit Activity RE A Toolbar preferences Toolbar preferences is where you specify whether or not you want to see the Toolbar the strip of icons on the left QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 292 1 Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences 2 On the Preferences pane select Toolbar 3 Click the checkbox for Display Toolbar and or Hide Toolbar When QuickBooks is Deactivated This second checkbox refers to whether you can see the Toolbar even when QuickBooks is a background application 4 Close the Preferences window 8 Tr
131. K QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 287 Classify Cash You can add accounts remove accounts or change the section in which an account appears in the Statement of Cash Flows report Which accounts appear in the report By default each balance sheet account appears in a section of the report Income and expense accounts are not automatically assigned to a section because they are included in the Net Income section at the top of the report What changes can you make In some cases your accountant may request that you change the report to show your cash inflows and outflows in a different way e Moving an account You can move a balance sheet account to a different section Operating Investing Financing of the report to change its classification e Adding an account If you have an income or expense account that tracks only non cash transactions such as depreciation expense you can add it to the report by selecting its checkbox To preserve the accuracy of the report you cannot remove balance sheet accounts Do not add accounts that track cash income or expense In some cases your accountant may request that you add an income or expense account to the report to show non cash income or expense in a different way Before adding the account make sure that you have not used it to track cash income or expense e Correct You have an expense account called Depreciation that you use only for depreciation of fixed
132. Lighting 1 591 00 Name Date Account Amount Memo sits Husinaci ASU 0 00 Bruce s Office Mac 9 30 13 10100 Check 450 00 Payme Dianne s Auto Shop 0 00 Bruce s Office Mac 12 30 12 10100 Check 450 00 Payme ast Gayshore Auto 0 00 Bruce s Office Mac 6 30 12 10100 Check 450 00 Payme E E 0 00 Bruce s Office Mac 6 30 13 10100 Check 450 00 Payme Employment Develo 0 00 Bruce s Office Mac 9 30 12 10100 Check 450 00 Payme AE E 0 00 Bruce s Office Mac 3 30 13 10100 Check 450 00 Payme Fay Maureen Lynn 0 00 Bruce s Office Mac 3 31 12 10100 Check 450 00 Payme Federal Treasury 0 00 Funds Transfer 0 00 Gallion Masonry 0 00 Great Statewide Bank 0 00 Hamlin Metal 670 00 Holly Heating and El 0 00 Hopkins Constructi 700 00 Kershaw Computer 0 00 View All Vendors 5 Ill View All Transactions Filter by Show All n All Dates Jl sl 7 8 How do use it To open the Vendor Center 1 Choose Vendor gt Vendor Center 2 Select a vendor name on the left side of the Center to view information about the vendor As you click a vendor name the right side of the Vendor Center displays information about your selection You can perform many tasks within the Vendor Center e Add a vendor Click the menu at the bottom of the vendor list and click Add Vendor e Import your existing contacts Click the menu at the bottom of
133. One Buy and install additional user seats To use your company file in multiuser mode you must add users to your license So if you want to have three people working in your company file you need a 3 user license If you ve already purchased a copy of QuickBooks with more than one user license go to Step Two Install QuickBooks Server Note If you already have more than one registered copy of QuickBooks you don t have to buy more additional user seats You can use any registered copy of QuickBooks to access the company file in multiuser mode To buy additional licenses 1 Choose QuickBooks gt Manage License gt Buy Additional Licenses 2 Follow the directions on the screen to buy your additional licenses 3 Choose QuickBooks gt Manage Licenses gt Sync License You must be connected to the Internet 4 Install QuickBooks on each computer you want to use to work on your company file Step Two Install QuickBooks Server QuickBooks Server shares your company file on your network with other computers you set up to run QuickBooks on your network in Step One You should install QuickBooks Server on the same computer where you want to store your company file When QuickBooks Server is running other QuickBooks users on your network will be able to open the shared company file Note Be sure to check out the Multiuser Checklist article for tips on picking a computer to use for QuickBooks Server Step Three Create user accounts
134. QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 220 Adjusting sales tax To adjust your sales tax before you pay it 1 Choose Vendors gt Pay Sales Tax Take a look at the amount of sales tax you owe Do you need to adjust it say if your tax authority has given you a discount for on time payments 2 Click Adjust 3 Fill out the Sales Tax Adjustment info Here s what s required Seta date for this adjustment Choose the Sales Tax Vendor you re paying Probably your local or state sales tax authority Choose the Adjustment Account QuickBooks will record this adjustment here Choose whether this is an Increase or a Decrease and enter the amount of the adjustment you re making 4 Click OK QuickBooks records this adjustment and closes the Sales Tax Adjustment window Now you re ready to pay your sales tax QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 221 CHAPTER 9 Finding out how you re doing In QuickBooks you can use the Company Snapshot and reports to see how your business is doing Reports are a thorough way to dig deep into your data And Company Snapshot is for the at your finger tips data And it s a lot of fun And QuickBooks offers a budget feature Income Tracker The Income Tracker at the top of the Transaction Center shows you some basic info about how your business is doing right now today But that s not all You can click on the Income Tracker s regions to see those kinds of transactions For example clic
135. Receipt or Create Invoice window enter the information for the transaction Things you should know e The customer name in the downloaded transaction may not be the same as the name you have in your QuickBooks Customer list Be sure you select the customer s name from the drop down Customer list e The amount of the credit card charge is in the Memo field When you enter your item information refer to this amount and make sure the item amount matches e For Sales Receipts Intuit Payment Method is always the payment method used for downloaded credit card transactions and can t be changed Handling down payments and overpayments If a customer sends you more money than he or she owes there will be an amount left over at the Receive Payments window after you have applied the payment to invoices QuickBooks keeps track of the credit amount so you can apply it the next time the customer owes you money To handle down payments and overpayments 1 Enter the payment in the Receive payments window Caution If you re recording a down payment and you are doing more than one job for the customer be sure to QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 121 specify both the customer name and the job name in the Customer Job field This ensures that QuickBooks will apply the down payment to invoices for the correct job 2 Foran overpayment apply as much of the payment as you can to outstanding invoices 3 Note the leftover amount in the Un
136. SALENUM REP TAXITEM NOTEPAD SALUTATION COMPANYNAME FIRSTNAME MIDINIT LASTNAME CUSTFLD1 CUSTFLD2 CUSTFLD15 Indicates whether you can charge sales tax to the customer If you are creating an import file enter one of these keywords in the TAXABLE field Y Yes You can charge sales tax to this customer N No You cannot charge sales tax to this customer The customer s credit limit with your company If you are creating an import file enter the dollar amount The customer s resale number The initials of the sales representative who deals with the customer The name of the tax item you have assigned to this customer The name you enter must correspond to one of the sales tax items on your Item list Your notes about the customer If you are creating an import file the notes appear in the Notepad window for the customer The customer s salutation or title Mr Ms Doctor etc The name of the customer s company The customer s first name The customer s middle initial The customer s last name The custom field entries for the customer Custom fields let you track special information about the customer such as the customer s birthday or email address Employee list EMP Import and export files can contain all the information in your Employee list The keyword for the Employee list is EMP NAME TIMESTAMP REFNUM INIT ADDR1 5 SSNO PHONE1 PHONE2 NOTEPAD Required The name of the employee
137. Select the first name you want hold down the Shift key and then select the last name in the range o Command click to select a group of nonadjacent names Select a name hold down the Command key 4 and then select each additional name o Command A to select all names No need to click just press Command A to select the entire list QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 34 Name Description Blueprint changes Blueprints Blueprints Concrete Slab Foundation slab prep Framing Help e Control click anywhere in the list to access Installation New item n a shortcut menu to common tasks Labor Edit Item Mileage QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 35 Classes list Classes are simply categories You can then apply a class to transactions to get more insight into your business data A class can be a department name a location or anything that means something to you Say you re a magician You might create the classes corporate event and children s party That way when you need to buy a custom costume for your rabbit Hopscotch that spells out Happy Birthday Princess in pink glitter you can classify that expense as being related to a corporate event Hey it could happen Really it could Then you can create a class report to show all your income and expenses related to a class To manage classes 1 2 Choose Lists gt Classes Add a new class or edit an existing class Add New Class Click the menu at t
138. User s Guide 259 APPENDIX B Intuit Interchange Format QuickBooks can import and export IIF Intuit Interchange Format text files The best way to view an export or import file is to open it from a spreadsheet program that way you ll see the data laid out into rows and columns If you don t have a spreadsheet program you can also view an export file in a word processor When you view the file you ll see keywords in capital letters that serve as row and column headings The keywords that appear at the beginning of each row identify the type of information in that row For example the keyword CUST indicates that the row contains data about a customer on your Customer Job list Rows that begin with the same keyword are grouped together For example all of the CUST entries from your Customer Job list appear as a single block of rows in the file Each block in turn has its own column headings that appear in capital letters in the cells of the first row in the block The column headings identify the type of information that each column in the block contains QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 260 Chart of accounts ACCNT Import and export files IIF can contain complete information about your chart of accounts The keyword for the chart of accounts is ACCNT NAME Required The name of an account in your chart of accounts If the account is a subaccount the account s name includes the names of the parent accounts beginning
139. You match the transactions from your financial institution with transactions in QuickBooks Your goal is to make sure that all downloaded transactions are correctly entered into your account register Example of updating your register Here s an example of what updating your register means Say over the course of a month you ve bought office supplies and paid for the printing of your client s brochure with the credit card you use for your business You entered payment to the printer into QuickBooks but not the office supplies purchase Now when you download your credit card transactions into QuickBooks you can match the payment to the printer that in your downloaded transactions to the one that s already in your register It s in your register because you entered the payment in QuickBooks And as for the office supplies purchase that s in your downloaded transaction but not in QuickBooks you can add that transaction to the register Downloading or importing your transactions Before you can download or import transactions you must set up online banking in QuickBooks To download or import your transactions 1 Choose Banking gt Downloaded Transactions 2 On the Downloaded Transactions window select the account you want to import or download transactions for For example select Checking to download your checking account transactions from your financial institution 3 Click Download QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 184
140. account o available QuickBooks Other Current Liability accounts if you are importing transactions from a line of credit account The account pop up menu will not show a QuickBooks account that is already associated with a Web Connect file If nothing appears in the account pop up menu create a bank credit card or Other Current Liability account first When QuickBooks finishes importing transactions click OK QuickBooks displays the transactions in the Downloaded Transactions window Optional Click Align Windows to display the Downloaded Transactions window and its corresponding account register You can also display the windows side by side by customizing the Downloaded Transactions window toolbar 10 Proceed to updating your register QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 183 To use Web Connect to import transactions after the first time 1 Choose Banking gt Downloaded Transactions 2 Choose an account from the pop up menu 3 Click Download to log in to your financial institution s website and download a Web Connect file 4 Click Import File to import the Web Connect file into QuickBooks Updating your register When you use online banking you either import or download transactions from your financial institution Some of those transactions may already be in QuickBooks but some may not be Updating your register means e You add any transaction from your financial institution that isn t already in QuickBooks e
141. alance sheet accounts and income expense accounts Balance sheet accounts A balance sheet account is an account that appears on a balance sheet report This report summarizes the financial position of a business A balance sheet shows the value of your company s assets liabilities and equity as of a particular day It is called a balance sheet because the value of the assets is always exactly equal to the combined value of the liabilities and equity Bank account Checking savings and money market accounts Add one bank account for every account your company has at a bank or other financial institution You can also use this type for petty cash e Accounts receivable A R Transactions related to the customers that owe you money including invoices payments deposits of payments refunds credit memos and statements Most companies have only one A R account QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 47 Other current asset Assets that are likely to be converted to cash or used up within one year such as petty cash notes receivable due within a year prepaid expenses and security deposits e Fixed asset Long term notes receivable and depreciable assets your company owns that aren t likely to be converted into cash within a year such as equipment or furniture e Accounts payable A P Your company s outstanding bills bill payments and any credit you have with vendors e Credit card Credit card purchases bills and
142. ale that has affected the inventory value during the period of time covered by the report 3 To print the report press Command P Listing your open purchase orders You can quickly get information about your open purchase orders To list the open POs where a particular item appears 1 Choose Lists gt Items 2 Select the item and then choose QuickReport from the Action menu B 3 To view a particular purchase order double click the purchase order s entry in the report To list all your open POs e Choose Vendors gt Purchase Order List For View at the bottom of the window choose Open Purchase Orders e Choose Company gt Transaction Center Select Purchase Orders in the left column and then Open for Filter By at the bottom of the window QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 212 Adjusting your inventory Although QuickBooks automatically adjusts your inventory quantities after every purchase and sale you may need to adjust them yourself from time to time If the quantities change because of say fire theft or breakage you need to adjust the quantity on hand for each inventory item affected To adjust your inventory 1 Choose Vendors gt Adjust Qty Value on Hand Note You can also adjust inventory using the Transaction Center 2 Enter the name of the expense account where you track inventory loss and shortages If you need to assign the expense to more than one account enter a separate adjustment for each a
143. ally means all kinds of files not just Word or other documents 4 Choose Create New to create a new folder to use as the Attached Documents Library 5 Choose Select Existing to select a folder that s already on your Mac to use as your Attached Documents Library 6 Check the OCR box if you want QuickBooks to read your photos and graphics and make them available for searches later on 7 Click the red X at the top of the pane to close Preferences QuickBooks saves your choices automatically QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 276 Backup preferences Backup Backup preferences set up how you want automatic backups to work for your company file 1 Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences 2 On the Preferences pane select Backup 3 Set the preferences described below 4 Close the Preferences window e Automatically back up company files every n hours Choose how often QuickBooks automatically backs up your company file e Automatically back up when each company file is closed Choose whether QuickBooks backs up your company file every time you close QuickBooks e Save backup files in Choose where you want QuickBooks to save your company file backups e Overwrite last backup Set if you want QuickBooks to overwrite the last backup file every time QuickBooks creates a new backup Encrypt file with password Set QuickBooks to secure your backups with a password you set by clicking Change Back up attached documents libra
144. already paid it Choose Reports gt Vendors amp Payables then click Transaction List by Vendor to see if the bill is listed as paid e How should I record a finance charge from a vendor Enter a new bill for the finance charge alone e How should I record a discount from a vendor If you are paying less than the full amount of the bill you can apply the discount when you pay the bill If you have paid the bill in full and now have a credit from the vendor enter a credit for overpayment e When I look at Accounts Payable it doesn t show any amounts for bills I ve already paid or their payments Why are the amounts missing At the bottom of the Accounts Payable window be sure Show Open Balance is not checked When it s checked only unpaid bills and unapplied credits show up Last month paid several bills from one vendor with a single check e Can I print the details of which bills paid with that check Print a voucher check on plain paper The voucher area lists the amount you paid on each bill QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 162 Paying bills and using credits After entering your bills you can then pay the bills when you want Note If you haven t entered your bills you can pay your vendor by writing checks paying by credit card and using cash expenditures directly from the account register However if you enter bills using either the Enter Bills window or the Accounts Payable register you must use t
145. ansaction or unused list item o On QuickBooks displays a warning message when you try to delete a transaction or a list item not currently in use o Off QuickBooks deletes the transaction or list item without a warning Warn when editing a transaction When you edit a transaction o On QuickBooks asks you if you want to record the changes o Off If the transaction isn t linked to another transaction QuickBooks automatically records your changes If the transaction is linked to other transactions QuickBooks asks you if you want to record the changes Play a sound when recording a transaction When on a sound plays when you record a transaction Sort employee list by first or last name Sorts the employee list by either first or last name Time format Set the format for time you enter o Show decimal hours Enter time using fractions of an hour For example 11 hours and 15 minutes would be entered as 11 25 o Show hours and minutes Enter time using the hours minutes format For example 11 hours and 15 minutes would be 11 5 Feedback preferences Feedback preferences determine whether you share QuickBooks usage data with Intuit 1 Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences 2 On the Preferences pane select Feedback 3 Click the Enable sending usage data to Intuit checkbox The preference is enabled by default QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 280 4 Close the Preferences window From this pane you can also follo
146. ansaction where you entered Far West as the sales region now shows Far West as the state This kind of mismatch also affects reports that show transactions you entered before you changed the field name 1 Edit a customer vendor employee or item you want rename 2 For customers vendors and employees go to the Additional Info pane For items click Custom Fields 3 Click Define Fields 4 Inthe Define Fields window change the name of the field Or to the custom field just clear the field name 5 Click OK To rename or remove a custom field on forms only When you change the field name on forms ONLY QuickBooks retains the old name in the Report Filters window this is the window where you restrict the content of a report to those transactions that match specific information in one or more of your custom fields For example if you change QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 45 the field name from Lease ending date to Lease ends on your forms the Report Filters window still shows Lease ending date as the name of the field You can still filter for information you entered in the field even though the name of the field is now different on your forms 1 Display the invoice sales receipt estimate credit memo statement or purchase order you want to customize For example to display an invoice choose Customers gt Create Invoices 2 Click Customize to open Layout Designer 3 Inthe Layout De
147. ansactions preferences Transactions Transactions preferences set up how transactions are used in the current company file These preferences affect account numbering reimbursable expenses your QuickBooks Class list the audit trail report and bills from vendors 1 Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences 2 On the Preferences pane select Transactions 3 Set the preferences described below 4 Close the Preferences window Require accounts Record transactions that have no assigned accounts QuickBooks automatically assigns these transactions to Uncategorized Income or Uncategorized Expense e Use account numbers Assign numbers to your accounts A Number field appears in the New Account and Edit Account windows QuickBooks includes your account numbers in the chart of accounts in all Account fields and on reports and graphs Click Show lowest subaccount only to display only the lowest subaccount For example if the account you select is 5400 Rent 5410 Office 5411 Main QuickBooks displays 5411 Main When Show lowest subaccount only is off QuickBooks displays the parent accounts along with the subaccount e Use class tracking Categorize transactions by assigning them to the classes on your Class list QuickBooks includes a Class field for all transactions e Use audit trail Automatically log all transaction changes in the audit trail report This gives you a running account of how each transaction has changed When this setting is o
148. applied Amount field If the payment is a down payment and there is no invoice yet the entire payment amount is displayed in the Unapplied Amount field QuickBooks holds the unapplied amount with this customer s name so that when you do have an invoice for this customer you can apply the down payment amount 4 Optional Click Print Credit Memo to give the customer a receipt for the down payment or overpayment The credit memo is for your customer only It does not become part of your financial records in QuickBooks Applying a discount for early payment When you enter a customer payment for an invoice the Receive Payments window has a Discount Info button You can use this button to give the customer a discount if your payment terms include a discount for payment before the due date Even if the customer has sent you a payment for the full amount of the invoice you can apply a discount Note To apply discounts to statement charges go to the Accounts Receivable register for the customer and use a Discount item To apply a discount for early payment 1 Enter the customer s payment in the Receive Payments window 2 Click the line of the invoice to which you want to apply the discount 3 Click Discount Info 4 Optional Change the amount of the discount QuickBooks calculates a suggested discount amount based on your payment terms with the customer and the payment date 5 Enter the name of the account you use to track the discou
149. ard type for a customer payment If you process your customers credit or debit cards using Intuit GoPayments or your Merchant Services Portal the payment method Intuit Payment Method will be on the list and cannot be changed To add or edit a payment method 1 Choose Lists gt Customer amp Vendor Profile gt Payment Method 2 Add anew payment method or open an existing one Add New Payment Method Edit Existing Payment Method e Click the menu at the bottom Double click the payment method of the list Or select the name of the payment method and Lt click the Edit button at the bottom of the list Or control click anywhere in the a list and choose New Payment Method from the shortcut menu Orin the Payment Method list control click the name of the other name you want to edit and choose Edit Payment Method from the shortcut menu 3 Enter the text for the payment method 4 Optional If you have Merchant Services activated to process credit and debit cards you can turn this feature on or off by checking or unchecking Merchant Service enabled 5 Optional To mark a payment method inactive select the Inactive checkbox 6 Add only If you re adding a new payment method and want to add more click Next 7 Click OK QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 41 Other things you can do with lists Once you get your lists set up you can do different things like manage your lists Merging list entr
150. as To be printed These keywords can appear in the TOPRINT field Y Yes N No The customer s vendor s payee s or employee s address Bills and invoices only The due date of the bill payment or invoice payment The date is always in MM DD YY format For example 01 30 04 Invoices only The terms of the invoice Invoices only Indicates whether an invoice has been paid in full These keywords can appear in the PAID field Y Yes The invoice has been paid in full N No The invoice is either partially paid or unpaid Sales receipts only The method your customer used to pay for the merchandise Invoices and sales receipts only The method you used to ship the merchandise Invoices and sales receipts only The shipping date If you are creating an import file enter the date in MM DD YY format For example 01 30 04 Invoices and sales receipts only The initials of the sales representative or employee who made the sale Invoices credit memos and cash sales only The location where you delivered the merchandise free of charge to a carrier for shipment Invoices and credit memos only The customer s purchase order number Invoices credit memos and sales receipts only The title that appears on the invoice credit memo or sales receipt Invoices credit memos and sales receipts only Your message to the customer as it appears on the invoice credit memo or sales receipt
151. asset account you use to track the value of your inventory The type of this account should be OASSET Inventory part items only The name of the account you use to track the cost of your sales The type of this account should be COGS All item types except group payment and subtotal The rate or price you charge for the item If you are creating an import file add a percent sign if the amount is a percentage Inventory part items only The unit cost of the item Discount other charges part and service items only Indicates whether the item is taxable If you are creating an import file enter one of these keywords in the TAXABLE field Y Yes The item is taxable N No The item is not taxable Payment items only The payment method customers use check Visa etc Sales tax items only The name of the agency to which you pay sales tax Sales tax items only The name of your tax district Group items only Indicates whether QuickBooks includes a list of the items in the group when you print an invoice credit memo or sales receipt If you are creating an import file enter one of these keywords in the TOPRINT field Y Yes QuickBooks lists each item N No QuickBooks adds a one line summary instead of listing the individual items Inventory part items only The name of the vendor from whom you normally purchase the item Inventory part items only The minimum quantity you want to keep in stock at any g
152. at s important to you with Set Up and Go 9 A Importing customers vendors and GASNI PIEAS js EES 13 Adding custom fields 44 Bee Jonan 13 Tips and tricks Quick Add and Setup 46 To import your contacts 13 CHAPTER 3_ Accounts 47 Troubleshooting 14 Types of accounts 47 Entering historical transactions 14 Balance sheet accounts 47 Why enter my historical transactions 15 Income and expense accounts 48 Do i Nias i a Se et rs Your Chart of Accounts 49 pui et nes stOncaldate Adding or editing accounts 50 Order matters 15 Addi b t 52 Entering vendor transactions 16 ing SUDACEOUNIS Entering customer transactions 18 Deleting an account 54 Entering bank and credit card Numbering your accounts 55 transactions 20 Combining two accounts 55 Switching from Windows 23 Working with registers 56 QuickBooks Windows vs Mac What s Opening a register 56 the difference 23 Editing a transaction in a register 57 Converting your file from Windows 24 Entering split transactions 58 What is and isn t converted when you Changing an opening balance 59 switch to QuickBooks for Mac 24 Changing an account s color 60 Exchanging your file with your accountant Moving a transaction to a different 26 account 60 Using QuickBooks in multiuser mode 28 Using a general journal 61 Setting up multiuser 29 Step One Buy and install additional user CHAPTER 4 Items 63 wants 29 Types of items 64 Step Two Install QuickBooks Server 29 Adding or editing items 65 Step Three Create u
153. ate the invoice for You can also enter a new customer job name and QuickBooks will prompt you to set it up QuickBooks will automatically alert you if you choose a customer job that has outstanding billable time or costs e Account If you have more than one Accounts Receivable account choose which on you want to use If you don t have more than one A R account you won t see this e Class If you re using classes choose which on you want to use If you don t see this you need to turn classes on in Preferences Bill to The address you have for the customer displays here This is how the customer contact information will appear here You can make any changes you need to Date Today s date which you can change Tip Press to increase the date by one day press to decrease the date by one day e Invoice Number QuickBooks automatically increments this number by one for each new invoice Tip Press to increase the number by one press to decrease the number by one e PO Number If you re filling a purchase order PO from your customer enter that PO number here Terms When do you want to get paid Select the payment terms for this invoice Item Select what you are invoicing this customer for You can include anything on the Items list here You also enter a new item and QuickBooks will prompt you to set it up Tip If you need to insert an item between two others select the item line where you want the new one
154. ated to buying items and services from your vendors You only need to enter transactions from the start date you used for your company file until today Vendor transactions to enter are e Purchase orders e Item receipts e Bills e Payments you made to your vendors Gather the information you ll need To get started you ll need this information for the timeframe between your company file s start date and today e Details of any POs you ve sent to vendors if you use purchase orders e A list of inventory items you ve received e Any bills you ve received e Records of bill payments you made QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 16 Entering transactions Now you re ready to enter your transactions If Shelly King s Big Market of Stuff is not in the Customer Job list you haven t set up your Items or Vendors lists CustomerJob Not Found yet you ll be asked to add these as you go a along For example if you re entering a bill and enter the name of a vendor not in your Vendors Set Up Cancel Quick Add list QuickBooks asks you if you want to Quick Add it Go ahead and do that You can go back to the Vendors list later and add more details about this vendor ee re zA Purchase Receive Enter Bills Pay You can use the Vendors area sg keson pa acii on the Home page to enter B your transactions Remember Enter Bils Pay Bills you only need to enter the transactions between your compa
155. atement Finance Statements Refunds and Write Check s Charges Charges Credits Checks Register m Z Te E 3 Tum on Enter Time Print Enter Credit Payroll Checks Card Charges QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 8 And with Guide Me turned on you ll get additional help for your first tasks Ore fremece No 12415413 1100 Set Up and Go Do you like checklists do especially when I m working on something new involved and important So of course we ve developed a checklist for folks new to QuickBooks called Set Up and Go Actually it s more of a decision table but would print it and check off tasks as you go along To open Set Up and Go Choose Help gt Set Up and Go QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide Help Search QD QuickBooks Help Enable Guide Me Set Up and Go N Community User s Guide Welcome to QuickBooks What s new in 2014 Product Information Privacy Statement Find a Local Quickbooks Expert Support Training Here you ll see three main tasks each with subtasks as well as some further options QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 10 Set Up and Go Y Get your info into QuickBooks fast amp accurate Who do you work for or sell stuff to Adding customer info helps you do Make money tasks Who do you work with Adding vendor info helps you do Spend money tasks What do you buy and sell Adding items helps you do pretty much everything in QuickBooks
156. ayment Methods list to include any of the methods in the following methods o MasterCard o Visa o Master Card o VisaCard QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 175 o Visa Card o Discover Card o American Express o Diners o AMEX o Diners Club o AmericanExpress o JCB o Discover o Other Credit Card o DiscoverCard When you make a deposit with any of these payment methods selected the credit card fees boxes appear on the Make Deposits window I can only select credit card deposits to use this feature have cash check and other deposits to make Can still make those Absolutely When you make deposits you re prompted to select which deposits you want to make You can select only the credit card payments and make those deposits then click Payments and select the other deposits QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 176 Online Banking If you use online banking for your business you can use QuickBooks to access your banking transactions You can import bank and credit card transactions from your financial institution s website and then add or match the imported transactions to transactions in your QuickBooks bank or credit card account register lt This video gives you an overview of what online banking with QuickBooks can do for you http www qblittlesquare com 2010 10 video introduction to online banking Depending on your financial institution you can access your online banking account either of the fol
157. b i gt Cook s i gt Creel New Transaction p Edit Customer Job gt Davies gt Dun c t u r 5 Quick Report pounn Make Customer Job s Inactive p gt Easley i e Change the order of names in the Customer Jobs list by dragging and dropping a name to where you want it to appear You can turn this feature on and off on the shortcut menu by selecting Enable Custom Order ing QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 81 Adding or editing a customer Throughout QuickBooks you select a customer from a list If you create an invoice you select the customer you re sending the invoice to Then QuickBooks inserts the billing address for that customer and tracks the invoice So you need to add customers for them to appear in those lists You ll enter your customer s contact information and maybe a few more details You can then edit that customer over time including adding notes and To Do list items To add or edit a customer 1 Choose Lists gt Customer Jobs or choose Customers gt Customer Center o Add new customer a Click the menu at the bottom of the customer list and click New Customer Or Control click anywhere in the Customer Jobs list and choose New Customer from the shortcut menu o Edit existing customer a Double click the customer name a Or select the name of the customer and click the Edit button at the bottom of the list a Orin the CustomerJobs list Control click the name of the customer yo
158. bar Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences gt Toolbar and deselect Display Toolbar To redisplay the hidden toolbar reselect this checkbox Attaching documents and other files to QuickBooks Got photos contracts work products or samples that you want to attach to QuickBooks records Now you can We ve made it easy to keep track of any kind of files and documents you generate for specific customers jobs and business transactions like estimates and invoices In QuickBooks for Mac we call all of these kinds of files attachments or documents For example Liz the Freelance Writer attaches the articles she writes to the invoices she generates that way she s got an instant filing system that keeps everything together Places where you can attach documents Here s a list of records you can add attachments to e Customers e Vendors And here are the transactions you can add attachments to e Estimates e Invoices e Sales Receipts e Receive Payments Enter Bills e Write Checks Enter Credit Card Charges e Credit Memos Refunds e Purchase Orders QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 237 To create an attachment 1 Open the transaction window Invoices Enter Bills whatever you need or record center Customer Center or Vendor Center that is Click v at the top right corner of the window The Attachments window appears Click like at the bottom left corner of the Attachments window Your Mac s folders and fi
159. based on your fiscal year Just tell QuickBooks which month your fiscal year starts in Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences and then choose My Company Select a month from the First Month in Your Fiscal Year list If you choose July for example a year to date report would report on transactions between July 1 and today How do see the exact dollar amount in graphs Whenever the arrow cursor turns into a magnifying glass J2 in a graph window you can see the exact value of the item below the magnifying glass by holding down the mouse button How do I fit a report on one page when print it When you are ready to print a report you ve created click Print at the top of the form If your report is too wide to print on one page choose Options on the Print window and select Shrink report to fit page width How do I see the detail behind items in a graph Move the cursor over an item in a graph until the cursor changes into a magnifying glass g9 Then double click to QuickZoom to more detailed information about that item You can continue double clicking in each subsequent window to drill down to more detail How do I change a report basis accrual vs cash for all reports QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 231 To change the report basis for all reports choose QuickBooks gt Preferences and choose Reporting Select either Accrual or Cash Exception reports that list transactions individually always app
160. ccount You can enter additional adjustments by clicking Next instead of OK 3 Optional Enter the new quantity of each inventory item whose quantity has changed You can also enter the new quantity by entering the difference in the Qty Difference column To enter a difference that reduces the quantity be sure to type a minus sign before the number for example 25 4 Optional If you need to edit the value of the inventory after adjusting the quantity Most businesses can accept QuickBooks recalculation of the value which is based on average cost When you edit a value you change the average cost of the items in stock To edit the value select the Value Adjustment checkbox In the New Value column enter the value for each inventory item whose value you want to change Taking a physical inventory You can use QuickBooks to create a worksheet for taking a physical count of your inventory stock To take a physical inventory 1 Choose Reports gt Inventory gt Physical Inventory Worksheet 2 Optional Use the report buttonbar to adjust the content and appearance of the worksheet Format Change the fonts for any part of the worksheet Header Footer Change or move the company name and title add a line of text as a footer at the bottom Hide Header Remove the company name title and date from the top QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 213 3 Optional Change the width of the columns More detail 4 Press dP
161. charge originated For example if you are viewing an invoice QuickBooks opens the register for the accounts receivable account where the invoice was recorded What about income and expense accounts These types of accounts do not have registers in QuickBooks If you need to see a list of the year to date transactions for an income or expense account select the name of the account and then choose QuickReport from the Action pop up menu Editing a transaction in a register With some exceptions see Restrictions below you can go to a register to edit a transaction This can save time if the transactions you want to edit have relatively few distribution lines and you do not need to track the costs of specific items To edit a transaction in a register 1 Open the register where the transaction appears 2 Goto the transaction If you re not sure where the transaction is you can either scroll the register to see if you can spot the transaction or you can use the Go To feature Edit gt Go To to jump to the first transaction that contains a particular payee name amount memo or transaction number 3 In the transaction edit the fields you want to change Restrictions You can edit deposits designated by DEP in the Type field without restrictions You can edit split amounts for checks CHK credit card charges CC credit card credits CC CRED bills BILL and vendor credits BILLCRED if all the amounts are assign
162. cial institution supports Direct Connect Check your financial institution s website or call their support line o Be sure you are providing the correct username and password When setting up Direct Connect you must provide the username and password the financial institution provided you o Be sure you have the most recent version of QuickBooks Choose QuickBooks gt Check for QuickBooks Updates If you complete this list and you still can t get Direct Connect to work you can try using Web Connect if your financial institution supports it QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 181 Using Web Connect e When importing the qbo file the Continue tab is grayed out not active and I don t see the account This problem may occur for several reasons To resolve it go through this checklist o Register QuickBooks if you haven t already o If you are importing a qbo Web Connect file for the first time be sure you have set up Web Connect before importing the qbo file o If the bank account is missing when you import the qbo file 1 2 8 Choose Lists gt Chart of Accounts Select the account to unlink from imported online transactions and select Edit from the Action pop up menu Select the Online Settings tab In the Download Transactions window select Not enabled and click Save In the Edit Account window click OK Create a new bank account with the same name as the existing bank account except add the
163. ck on the left panel or click the at the bottom of the list To edit a check select a check in the list on the left panel If you don t see this list click the Left View 3 Enter the information for the check and click Save Note You can also write a check using the Vendor Center and Transaction Center QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 168 What s on a check Pay to the order of Who are you paying Choose a name from the list or type the name in directly If the name is not on any of your lists QuickBooks asks you set up a record for the name If you have a PO open for the vendor you select QuickBooks asks you if you want to receive the items for the open POs Bank Account The account you want to write the check from This is most likely your checking account Date QuickBooks automatically enters today s date but you can change it Enter the amount of the check Address If you have already entered the payee s address on one of your lists of names QuickBooks fills in the address for you If you re adding a new name you ll need to enter the address yourself Memo Enter any note or message you would like to print on the check If the check is for expenses you want to track through expense accounts In the Expenses pane assign the expenses to one or more expense accounts This works the same as it does for bills If you don t see the Expenses Items panes turn on the Inventory and purchase orders a
164. ck Next if you want to use different payment dates for your bills or you want to pay them from different checking accounts Also click Next if you want to create multiple checks for the same vendor To apply a discount to a bill 1 In the Pay Bills window click the bill to which you want to apply a discount 2 Click Discount Info 3 Optional Change the amount of the discount QuickBooks calculates a suggested discount amount based on your payment terms with the vendor and the payment date QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 163 4 Required Enter the name of the account you use to track income from discounts To assign check numbers When paying bills you have a choice for how you want to assign check numbers for tracking purposes You may not even be paying by check so you can choose to assign check numbers yourself and enter ATM or a reference number if you paid the bill online Let QuickBooks assign check number QuickBooks assigns the check number starting with the number after the last check number used e Let me assign the check numbers below Click the box in the Check No column and enter the check number or other information that you are using to track the payment Things to know e To apply a credit from a vendor just select the credit in the list of bills on the Pay Bills window The credit will be applied e If you write checks by hand select Assign check numbers You ll be prompted to enter the ch
165. click Save Note You can also enter a charge using the Vendor Center and Transaction Center What s on a credit card charge Here s what you ll see on the form to record a credit card charge Charge Credit Choose what type of transaction you are entering charge or credit e Credit Card Choose the account associated with the credit card you used Purchased From Who did you buy stuff from Choose a name from the list or type the name in directly If the name is not on any of your lists QuickBooks asks you set up a record for the QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 170 name If you have a PO open for the vendor you select QuickBooks asks you if you want to receive the items for the open POs Date QuickBooks automatically enters today s date but you can change it e Ref No Enter the number from your credit card charge slip here e Amount Enter the amount of the charge or credit If the charge is for expenses you want to track through expense accounts In the Expenses pane assign the expenses to one or more expense accounts This works the same as it does for bills If you don t see the Expenses Items panes turn on the Inventory and purchase orders are used preferences in Inventory preferences If the charge is for an inventory part non inventory part service or other charge item At the bottom of the windows click the Items pane If you don t see the Expenses Items panes turn on the Inven
166. cord the time he or she just spent on a phone conversation with a client QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 133 Weekly timesheets A weekly timesheet shows the time spent by one person doing any number of activities for any number of jobs within a seven day period While the timesheet can only display one week at a time you can easily view the hours entered for other weeks 00o Weekly Timesheet Name CalOil Company T Timesheet for week of Dec 9 to Dec 15 2013 Prev Week Next Week Set Date M Tu w Th F Sa Su CustomerJob Service Item Notes Class 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 Total Billab Babcock s Music Removal 4 00 4 00 D Burch Jason Removal 4 00 4 00 D Balak Mike Utility Shed Removal 4 00 4 00 D Carr s Pie Shop Remodel Removal s 4 00 4 00 0 Totals 0 00 8 00 8 00 0 00 0 00 0 00 0 00 16 00 Copy Prev Sheet Edit Activity NewSheet Cancel OK If you prefer to enter a person s hours on a single form at regular intervals this method might work best for you For example a general contractor could use a weekly timesheet to record the time spent on each job for that week You have two views of your date You can move back and forth between the two time entry forms If you are viewing a single activity entry you can display that person s weekly timesheet with a click of the mouse On a weekly timesheet you can select any hourly entry and view it as a single activity entry The two forms are simply d
167. count as one of the special balance sheet accounts that QuickBooks automatically creates when the need for the account arises If you are creating an import file use one of these keywords to identify the account OPENBAL Opening Balance Equity RETEARNINGS Retained Earnings SALESTAX Sales Tax Payable UNDEPOSIT Undeposited Funds Import and export files can contain complete information about your budgets The keyword for a budget is BUD ACCNT PERIOD AMOUNT STARTDATE CLASS CUSTOMER Required The name of the account to which this budget applies If the account is a subaccount the account s name includes the names of the parent accounts beginning with the highest level account If you are creating an import file use a colon to separate subaccount names A keyword that identifies the time intervals within the budget Because QuickBooks only allows one month intervals in a budget an export file always shows the keyword MONTH If you are creating an import file type MONTH Required The budget amounts Because a QuickBooks budget covers an entire year an export file shows 12 amounts one for each month of the year If you are creating an import file each month s amount must have its own column The starting date of the budget If you are creating an import file enter the date in MM DD YY format For example 1 30 04 The name of the class that the budget applies to If the class is a subclass the class
168. ction on the left side of the Center to view information about the transaction As you click on a transaction the right side of the Transaction Center displays the information associated with your selection o Find a transaction On the left side of the Transaction Center click any category of transaction You can then use the search box to search within that transaction type QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 172 o Create a transaction Click the menu at the bottom of the transaction list and choose the type of transaction you want to create o Edit a transaction Double click the name of a transaction to open it and edit the transaction s details o Rearrange the columns Click and drag the top of a column to move it to another location in the list o Filter the information you see You can filter the transaction list using the filters located under each list For example with the Invoices category selected on the left side of the center you can select Overdue from the View pulldown menu and then This Month Tips and tricks Control click on a transaction category on the left side of the center to access a shortcut menu e You can sort transactions by clicking the title of a column e Show different columns or hide columns you don t need Right click or Control click on the column headers then select the columns you want to see and unselect the ones you want to hide e Click an area on the Income Tracker bar
169. ctions as new transactions in the account register Select an unmatched transaction and click Add One to add just that one transaction to the register Or you can click Add Multiple to add all the transactions from that payee QuickBooks creates new transactions in the account register and pre fills the payee and amount fields Enter the rest of the transaction details and then click Record Be sure to complete and record this new transaction You will be unable to continue matching from Downloaded Transactions until you do e Delete the transaction from the Downloaded Transactions window Select the transaction and click Delete Important Once you delete a transaction that has been downloaded you cannot undo that deletion by downloading the transaction again Basically you can t undelete So be very sure you want that transaction to go away permanently before you click Delete Other things to know about matching transactions e Close the Downloaded Transactions window when you re done QuickBooks asks if you want to remove the matched transactions from the Downloaded Transactions window click Remove The next time you open the Downloaded Transactions window only unmatched transactions will appear QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 185 Use renaming rules for different payees who are really the same vendor So if you ve bought services from three different locations of one vendor they probably appear as three different payees in
170. culate the tax at a different rate by choosing a different tax item directly from the sales form Applying tax to a sale If you have set up a default sales tax assigned taxes to your customers and marked taxable items you sell as taxable QuickBooks automatically calculates and applies the tax when you make a sale e To apply a different tax to a sale select the tax you want to apply from the list of tax items at the bottom of the sales form e To apply tax to an item you normally don t tax in the Amount column of the sales form click the space between the line item amount and the right edge of the column A T appears next to the line item to indicate you are collecting tax on the item e To make a non taxable sale o If you never tax the customer clear the Taxable checkbox on the customer s record o If you usually tax the customer but don t want to for this particular sale clear the Tax checkbox at the bottom of the sales form but leave the correct sales tax QuickBooks then records the sale as a non taxable sale for the tax district e To sell to an out of state customer choose the special Out of state 0 00 tax rate item as the tax for the sale QuickBooks then records the sale as non taxable out of state so you can report it when you pay taxes e If you use a tax group QuickBooks calculates each tax in the group individually and then adds the individual taxes together to get the total tax Because QuickBooks
171. d choose New Vehicle OR Open an existing vehicle o Double click the vehicle name o Inthe Vehicle list Control click the name of the vehicle you want to edit and choose Edit Vehicle o Select the name of the vehicle and click the Edit button at the bottom of the list 3 Enter the vehicle information o Vehicle and Description Enter a name and description for the vehicle You can use anything that s meaningful to you We re not picky o Picture You can click on the photo box and browse for a photo or you can drag and drop a photo right into the box 4 Click OK Other things you can do on the Vehicle list e Make a vehicle inactive This means that the history of the vehicle s use stays in QuickBooks but you can t use the vehicle to track mileage Edit the vehicle and check Inactive If you only want to see active vehicles in the list choose Active Vehicles from the View menu at the bottom of the list e Search for vehicles If you have a long list of vehicles you can search for the one you want in the Search box at the top of the list Enter mileage When you have mileage you want to track choose Company gt Enter Mileage and use the Enter Mileage window QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 138 e Vehicle Select the vehicle you used If you don t have any vehicles you can type the name here and add it with QuickAdd Or you can add the vehicle to the Vehicle list Lists gt Vehicles e Trip Dates Enter t
172. d click Edit at the bottom of the Chart of Accounts WA 3 Select the Subaccount of checkbox From the list select the account that will be the higher level account for this subaccount 4 Click OK Note You can also select the account then drag and drop it under the name of the account you want to make it a subaccount of What happens The balances of subaccounts are added to their parent account balance in the chart of accounts The register of a parent account shows all the transactions in the subaccounts When you reconcile a balance sheet account that has subaccounts such as a joint checking account reconcile the parent account so that you reconcile all transactions for that account QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 53 Deleting an account You can delete an account only when it is not used in any transactions e is not assigned to any line items e does not have subaccounts To find transactions that use an account For balance sheet accounts only double click the account in the chart of accounts to display its account register e For income and expense accounts only double click the account in the chart of accounts to display its QuickReport e For all accounts create a Transaction Detail by Account report by choosing Reports Accountant amp Taxes Transaction Detail By Account To delete an account 1 Choose Lists gt Chart of Accounts 2 Select the account you want to delete 3
173. date the amount for you To get the latest threshold information go to the IRS website and search for a copy of Instructions for Forms 1099 1098 5498 and W 2G If you turn off 1099 tracking QuickBooks removes all menu items and options related to 1099s You will not be able to print 1099 MISC forms create 1099 reports or QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 275 indicate that a 1099 form must be filed for a vendor QuickBooks retains all 1099 related data however Attachments Attachments preferences Attachments preferences let you create a folder where you can put documents photos and other files you ll attach to invoices customer info and other QuickBooks transactions and files You can also choose to apply optical character recognition OCR to photos drawings and other graphic files OCR means that QuickBooks will analyze your photo or graphic for text When you search for words in QuickBooks it ll find any attached photos and graphics files with those words in them and show them to you as search results If you think or know that OCR is going to be important to you be sure you ve optimized your graphics files so that QuickBooks can read them clearly How do set Attachments preferences 1 Goto QuickBooks gt Preferences 2 On the Preferences pane click Attachments 3 Click the Attached Documents Library menu to choose or create a folder on your Mac where all your QuickBooks attached documents which actu
174. de inactive checkbox in the Employees list Note If you plan to use QuickBooks Payroll for Mac be sure the employee name is spelled exactly the same first name middle initial and last name in both places Employee names in paycheck data imported from QuickBooks Payroll for Mac must match your QuickBooks employee list Other names list Do you have a name that is not a customer vendor or employee You can use the Other Names list to add contacts that you need for your business but don t fit in anywhere else You can also use this list to capture any items you use repeatedly on forms for example Annual Depreciation or ATM Withdrawl To add or edit an other name 1 Choose Lists gt Other Names 2 Add anew name or open an existing name Add New Other Name Edit Existing Other Name e Click the menu at the e Double click the other name bottom of the list Or select the name of the other name and click Lt the Edit button at the bottom of the list Or control click anywhere in LZ the list and choose New Other Name from the shortcut menu e Orin the Other Name list control click the name of the other name you want to edit and choose Edit Other Name from the shortcut menu 3 Complete the Address Info pane 4 Add any notes you want to add for this name 5 Click OK To mark a name as inactive select the Inactive checkbox You can then hide inactive names by clearing the Include inactive checkbox in th
175. dentifies the company file from which you exported the Ship Via list Export files only A unique number that identifies an entry in the list Transactions TRNS and SPL Import files can contain information about transactions in a QuickBooks company file The keyword for a transaction is TRNS the keyword for each distribution line is SPL The distribution lines appear immediately below the transaction The keyword ENDTRANS appears after the last distribution line In an import file the first column for a transaction that has three distribution lines would look like this TRNS SPL SPL SPL ENDTRNS TRNSID TIMESTAMP A unique number that identifies the transaction QuickBooks generates this number when you create an export file Export files only A second unique number that works with TRNSID to identify the transaction QuickBooks generates this number when you QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 268 TRNSTYPE DATE ACCNT NAME CLASS AMOUNT DOCNUM MEMO CLEAR TOPRINT create the export file Required A keyword that identifies the type of transaction These keywords can appear in the TRNSTYPE field BILL Bills from vendors BILLCCARD Bill payments you make by credit card BILLPMT Bills payments you make by check BILL REFUND Refunds from a vendor CASH REFUND Cash refunds you give to customers CASH SALE Sales receipts CCARD REFUND Refunds you receive on credit card charges CHECK
176. different size or orientation When you change the paper size or orientation the Template window canvas size changes too The page setup is saved with the template so that all transactions that use the template will be formatted according to the template settings QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 243 e What happens to a template customized in a previous version of QuickBooks for Mac and then upgraded to the most recent version of QuickBooks for Mac Templates created in the 2011 2012 and 2013 versions of QuickBooks for Mac will work in 2014 You can continue to apply the template to transactions and print it but you will no longer be able to edit it e Can I use templates I created in QuickBooks for Windows No QuickBooks for Windows saves templates in a different format and will not be converted for use in QuickBooks for Mac e Can I apply my template format to another template You can copy and paste fields and other objects to another template which will preserve the formatting of the objects If you are pasting fields into a different form type for instance invoice fields into a purchase order any fields that do not apply to purchase orders will not be pasted A template can only have one set of columns so you cannot copy and paste columns into a template that already has a set of columns Budgeting QuickBooks for Mac s budgeting feature isn t what you d call mighty but if you re needs are minor it ll do the job f
177. dit amount your memo about the amount and a source QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 61 name If the Use Class Tracking preference is in effect you can enter a class in the Class column 6 Enter additional distribution lines until the transaction reaches a zero balance the total in the Debit column should equal the total in the Credit column The entry appears in the register for any balance sheet account involved and in reports showing any income or expense for the accounts you included To print a journal entry 1 Choose the journal entry you want to print from the list on the left side of the window if you re not already looking at it 3 On the print screen check to make sure everything looks okay and that you ve chosen the right printer 4 Click Print QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 62 CHAPTER 4 Items When the QuickBooks term items comes up many users immediately think inventory that is things that retail businesses sell Service business owners may wonder why they need to fool around with items since they sell services rather than physical things Whatever your business you ll need to use items If you buy it or sell it it s an item whether it s a physical thing or a service In a doctor s office an exam is an item For a writer a blog post is an item For a lawyer a courtroom appearance is an item Items can also be discounts sales tax and subtotals QuickBooks fo
178. duct qb2014 Sample 2 Drag the company file with the qb2014 extension where you want it to be 3 Drag the Attached Documents Library folder where you want it to be Tip We recommend that you put your Attached Documents Library in the same place as your company file 4 Open your company file 5 Goto QuickBooks gt Preferences 6 Choose Attachments QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 255 APPENDIX A Keyboard shortcuts Keyboard shortcuts are a great way to get to commands faster and enter data more easily and efficiently With most software programs tend to look for keyboard shortcuts to speed things up and QuickBooks is no exception If you re not currently using keyboard shortcuts or are only using a few of them I think you ll find some of these will really enhance your data entry experience p Check out this video on keyboard shortcuts and see them in action http www qblittlesquare com 2010 05 shortcuts for names and numbers General QuickBooks gt Preferences QuickBooks gt Hide QuickBooks QuickBooks gt Hide Others QuickBooks gt Quit QuickBooks File gt New Company File gt Open Company File gt Close Company File gt Close window File gt Print Window gt Minimize Help gt QuickBooks Help Display contextual menu Display product and company file information Editing Edit gt Undo Edit gt Cut Edit gt Copy QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide Shortc
179. e If the left side is missing increase the horizontal alignment in the Fine Alignment window If the right side is missing decrease the horizontal alignment Some printers simply can t print the entire width necessary for standard forms In this case use the custom forms which have larger margins e My invoices print with dollar amounts but no cents How can correct this Decrease the horizontal alignment for invoices by customizing your invoice e How do I print a logo on my checks When you click Print on the Print window choose QuickBooks from the print options pop up menu and click Logo Drag or past your logo in the white box and select Print company logo e When I print a register the dates are clipped off for example get 07 0 instead of 07 01 05 How can I correct this problem The report font is too large When you click Print on the Print window choose QuickBooks from the print options pop up menu and click Format and then Show Fonts Try a font size of 10 points or smaller e Why is text near the edges of my report missing or clipped The report margins are too small Choose File gt Print Setup gt Report Graph List and increase the size of the margins e The standard self adhesive sheet of labels on backing and card stock is too thick for my printer to handle How do print labels Print the labels using ordinary paper Then photocopy the printed names and addresses onto real labels e How can
180. e o Statements with a balance less than a certain amount o Statements for customer with no account activity o Statements for inactive customers 9 If you ve set up payment terms for your customers you can click Assess Financial Charges so QuickBooks can assess finance charges for any customers whose payments are late 10 If you want to print statements click Print If you want to email statements click Email You can also print the statement as a PDF making it easy to keep records and share with others Setting up for automatic charge entry If you bill the same charge to a group of customers on a regular basis you can set up QuickBooks to enter the charges automatically when it s time to send out your statements For example a property management company could enter monthly rents automatically A health club could enter membership fees automatically To set up for automatic charge entry Step 1 For your first billing enter the statement charges for each customer Tip If you have many customers that you want to enter charges for at once you may find it faster to enter the charges in your Accounts Receivable A R register instead of the individual customer registers QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 105 Step 2 Create a memorized transaction group for the statement charges Choose Lists gt Memorized Transactions Choose Make New Group from the Action pop up menu Enter a name that describes the statement charges For
181. e Employees list Customer and Vendor Profile lists You can use the Customer amp Vendor Profile lists to set up categories you can use to group information within QuickBooks For example when you create a Job you can give it a Job Type then use the Job Type in reports to see what category of jobs are the most profitable These lists also contain lists for the payment terms you use for your customers customer messages and payment methods QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 38 You can set up e Customer Types Apply this category when you add or edit a customer e Vendor Types Apply this category when you add or edit a vendor e Job Types Apply this category when you add or edit a job Terms Terms are the payment terms for your customer or from your vendor This list is preconfigured for you with common payment terms You can edit these or add new ones You can assign terms to a specific customer or select terms when you are filling out a sales form like an invoice e Customer Messages These are messages you apply to sales forms you send your customer such as Thank you for your business e Payment Methods Payment methods categorize payments from your customers When you receive payments from your customers you can select a payment method and then sort your deposits by payment method and create reports based on payment method e Ship Via This list is preconfigured with common shipping methods You can edit these or
182. e Make Account Inactive or Make Account Active QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 49 e To reorder the accounts in the list On the Action B menu be sure Enable Custom Ordering is checked Then you can drag and drop account names where you want them to appear in the list When Enable Custom Ordering is unchecked the list uses the default ordering of account names In any case all of the account names of a given account type will appear together For example you can drag an expense account to a different place within the list of expense accounts but not to the middle of your income accounts e To change the view By default QuickBooks lists accounts in a hierarchy Click the arrow beside an account name to view its subaccounts You can also choose Flat View from the Action menu that lists each entry as the account name plus any subaccount name You can change the view by selecting Hierarchical View or Flat View from the Action menu Adding or editing accounts When you set up your company file QuickBooks sets up certain accounts for you automatically As your business grows or changes you can add new accounts to your Chart of Accounts to better organize your finances For example you might want to create expense accounts to track office supply purchases separately from advertising costs To add or edit a new account 1 Choose Lists gt Chart of Accounts 2 To add an account click at the bottom of the Chart of Accounts ra
183. e Past Due Past Due c h arg e 0 00 0 00 0 00 0 00 0 00 0 00 Date and amount of each payment received e Finance charges e Total amount due To use statements you enter statement charges and then you create a statement Entering Statement Charges Entering charges is the first step in preparing statements to send to your customers Back in the chapter on Accounts told you about a customer s register Now you re going to use it You enter the charges directly in each customer s register that will appear on the statement To enter statement charges 1 Open the register for the customer you want to send a statement to o Open the Customer Center Select the name of customer and click Open Register o Choose Customers gt Enter Statement Charges In the register window check the name shown in the Customer Jobs field If the charges are for a different customer or job choose the customer or job from the list QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 103 Important If the Customer Jobs list shows more than one job for the customer be sure to select the correct job QuickBooks maintains a separate register for each job 2 If the date of the charge is different from today change the date Why would you change the date The date of the service you performed may have been in the past 3 In the Item field enter the item you use to track this kind of charge 4 Enter the quantity
184. e project You start by creating an estimate for the job You don t have to give this estimate to the customer if you don t want to Just use it for tracking purposes Then as you complete each phase you can transfer items from the estimate to an invoice You can specify which items to include on each invoice and how much of that item you re charging for on that invoice Later on you can run reports to help you track your estimated versus actual costs Note Be sure you turn on progress invoicing in Preferences Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences gt Sales amp Invoicing To create progress invoices for a job 1 Create an invoice using an estimate You can do this by opening an estimate Customers gt Create Estimate and clicking Create Invoice Or create an invoice Customers gt Create Invoice and choose a customer name that you ve created an estimate for QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 97 2 Tell QuickBooks what you want to include on the invoice and click OK o Remaining amounts on the estimate QuickBooks creates an invoice for the full unpaid amount on the estimate QuickBooks copies all the information on the estimate to an invoice You can then edit the invoice or you can change the invoice to a progress invoice by clicking Progress Invoicing on the invoice o A percentage of the estimate Enter how much of the estimate you want to include on the invoice For example if you created an estimate for 1 000 and
185. e report to specific income and expense accounts or to just one account Use the Profit amp Loss Budget vs Actual By Job report Choose either a date value like month or Total Only from the Columns list on the report buttonbar Then click Customize and choose Customer Job from the Row Axis list To see only one customer or job click Filters on the report buttonbar and filter by Name Use the Profit amp Loss Budget vs Actual By Job report Choose either a date value like month or Total Only from the Columns list on the report buttonbar Then click Customize and choose Class from the Row Axis list Use the Profit amp Loss Budget vs Actual By Job report To see only one customer or job click Filters on the report buttonbar and filter by Name Use the Profit amp Loss Budget vs Actual By Job report Choose Customer Job from the Columns list on the report buttonbar and then click Customize and choose Class from the Row Axis list or vice versa To see only one customer or job click Filters on the report buttonbar and filter by Name Use the Profit amp Loss Budget vs Actual report Choose Class from the Columns list on the report buttonbar and then click Customize and choose Accounts from the Row Axis list 246 QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 247 Printing in QuickBooks Sometimes you just need to put something on paper No problem Tips Just about anywhere in QuickBooks press Command P to print
186. e window QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 190 4 Look at the Difference amount in the bottom right corner of the Reconcile window o If the amount is 0 00 zero Click Reconcile Congratulations You ve reconciled the account with the statement You can now print a reconciliation report if you are reconciling a bank statement or pay your credit card bill o If the amount is not zero Oops your account doesn t balance for the period of time covered by the statement and you need to correct the difference Keep reading for help with this Congratulations Viewing and printing reconciliation reports You re done reconciling your account and you got a 0 difference The Congratulations window appears To view a reconciliation report 1 Choose a report to view o Summary shows only the beginning and ending balances and amounts reconciled o Detail shows every transaction you marked o Both shows both Summary and Detail information 2 Click Display The report appears To print a reconciliation report 1 Open the report you want to print for viewing 2 Click Print on the report If you don t want to see or print a reconciliation report right now click Close on the Congratulations window But what if you want to print a report from the last time you reconciled this account Or any previous reconciliation report If you reconciled this account using QuickBooks for Mac 2014 go to Reports gt Banking gt Previous R
187. ear as accrual basis reports when you create them from the Reports menu To change one of these reports to cash basis click Options in the Report window e How do I save a report as a PDF file and email it You can save and email reports as PDF files making it easy to share with your customers and vendors Display the report you want to save or email and then choose File gt Print Report and click the PDF button to save it as PDF or choose File gt E mail Report as PDF to email it as PDF Working with graphs Graphs show data visually with pie charts and bar graphs QuickBooks offers these graphs to help you visualize your information e Company amp Financials gt Income amp Expense Graph e Company amp Financials gt Net Worth Graph e Customers amp Receivables gt Accounts Receivable Graph e Sales gt Sales Graph e Vendors amp Payables gt Accounts Payable Graph Budgets gt Budget vs Actual G Note Go to your Reports preferences to change how QuickBooks displays your graphs QuickBooks gt Preferences Creating a graph To create a graph From the Reports menu choose the report graph you want to create e You can also open the Report Center Reports gt Report Center and open graphs from the report list on the left side of the window Changing the data you see on the graph You have a few options once you create a graph e Change dates When QuickBooks displays the graph click the Dates butt
188. eck numbers you used e If you re paying by some other method than check debit card funds transfer then select Check for your payment method and Assign check numbers When prompted you can enter anything for the check number that s meaningful to you such as ATM of FT Tracking bills and credits Track your bills and credits using an accounts payable account in your Chart of Accounts Lists gt Chart of Accounts Tips for using accounts payable e See more transactions in the window at once by selecting 1 line view e To find a transaction fast choose Edit gt Find with the account window open What you can do with your bills and credits e Find a bill or credit You can find any bill in the Transaction Center Company gt Transaction Center Just click Bills in the left column You can also access a bill from the Chart of Accounts Lists gt Chart of Accounts in the Accounts Payable account you use for paying bills Edit bills and credits Find the bill or credit with the Transaction Center or Chart of Accounts and double click it to open it Make your changes and click OK If you reduce the bill amount QuickBooks creates a credit with the vendor you overpaid If you increase the bill amount QuickBooks considers the bill not fully paid until you pay the additional amount QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 164 Using 1099s For vendors that require a 1099 1096 you need to set them up for these forms
189. econciliation If you re looking for a reconciliation you did ina previous version of QuickBooks we can t show you that report We re sorry about that Reconciling fast with Mark All If you re pretty sure your account is going to balance you can skip the process of checking and marking each transaction individually 1 Click Mark All All the transactions in the window are marked 2 Check the Difference down at the bottom right corner of the window If it s 0 00 you re done reconciling Click Reconcile to finish up QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 191 If the Difference is not 0 00 you re going to have to check individual transactions to find the problem Click Unmark All to unmark all your transactions then start at the beginning marking each transaction individually What to do if your account doesn t balance Sometimes your bank statement just refuses to balance with your QuickBooks accounts Don t worry we can help you fix it If you ve got an account that s not reconciling here s what you do Go back to Banking gt Reconcile Check the following e Was the Ending Balance entered incorrectly e Did you miss a transaction that should be cleared Did you enter a transaction inaccurately If the Difference is small like less than a dollar you might not care enough to track down the discrepancy To enter an adjustment to your account that will make it balance 1 Click Reconcile A message appears warning you t
190. ed 3 Click Print 4 Take a look at each invoice on the print preview window to make sure everything looks good 5 Click Print To email a batch of invoices Tip Emailing a batch of invoices works a bit differently than emailing a single invoice read carefully keep from being surprised 1 Click Email 2 On the Email Forms window choose all the invoices in the batch 3 Click Email 4 Change the text in the cover email that will go to your customers so it ll sound good to your customers Important Do not edit lt lt contacts gt gt at the beginning of the email QuickBooks uses it to put the name of each individual customer into the email that s attached to his or her invoice so that you don t have to 5 Check Include text in emails to tell QuickBooks to send the cover email text to your default email account 6 Get ready to send out the emails with invoices attached a If you want QuickBooks to send these emails now do not check Save emails as drafts QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 101 b Click Send QuickBooks sends the emails with invoices attached as PDF forms from your business email account OR a If you want to review the emails in your default email account before you send them check Save emails as drafts QuickBooks puts the emails with the invoices attached as PDFs into the Drafts folder of your default email account b Whenever you re ready go over to your email account Drafts folder and s
191. ed Funds to your QuickBooks bank account To deposit the funds now click Deposit to and enter the name of the bank account where you would like QuickBooks to deposit the payment Process a customers credit or debit card on a sales receipt If you have an Intuit Merchant Services account you can process your customer s credit or debit card when you fill out a sales receipt Important You should always swipe the credit card when you have it in hand even if you already have the credit card on file Only transactions from a card swipe are eligible for a lower discount rate 1 Be sure you select a credit card for the Payment Type 2 Be sure the Process credit card checkbox is selected QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 114 3 Swipe the credit card or enter the card information Note When you use the Intuit card reader you may see a message box that says the card reader needs to be identified You can ignore this message by clicking the red circle in the top left corner of the message box to dismiss it 4 Click OK You ll see a confirmation when the transaction is complete Other things to know about sales receipts Q Add time and costs to your sales receipt If you ve incurred expenses for your customer such as mileage or other expenses you can add that to as sales receipt to be reimbursed by your customer Apply sales tax If you re charging sales tax for the items click Taxable to apply sales tax View the cred
192. ed to expense accounts if any amount is assigned to an item you must double click the transaction to edit the split amounts For all other kinds of transactions only certain fields can be edited directly in the register To edit one of these transactions without restrictions double click the transaction to display it in its complete form QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 57 Entering split transactions When you enter a transaction in a register you can split the transaction to different accounts customers jobs or classes so that you can keep track of how much you re spending on each account customer job or class From the register you can also view split transactions that you entered by using the Expenses tab in the Write Checks Enter Bills Enter Credit Card Charges or Create Item Receipts windows Restriction From a register you cannot view or enter a split transaction that tracks items To enter split transactions 1 10 In the account s register select the transaction you want to split or click in the blank entry at the end of the register Enter the payee vendor or name Enter the total amount of the transaction in the payment field If you don t know the total leave the Amount field blank QuickBooks totals the amount as you fill in the splits and displays it in the Payment field Click Splits In the Account field enter an account In the Amount field enter the amount to be assig
193. eet Add an Income Account to every item now listed in the QuickBooks window if you didn t have this info in your original spreadsheet It s a required field Inventory Items only Add a COGS Account and an Asset Account for every item now listed in the QuickBooks window if you didn t have this info in your original spreadsheet They are required fields Make sure the Import box is checked for every item row Click Import Click OK when QuickBooks finishes importing your items You re done All your items are now in QuickBooks Go to Lists gt Items to see the items you just imported Troubleshooting when the import fails Did you get a message in the Import status window that says you have errors in some of your items We can help you fix them 1 2 Close the Import status window by clicking OK On the spreadsheet look for the items that have red Xes on the far left side Click on the item with the red X A message pops up to the right of the item s row describing what went wrong Fix the items with the red Xes and click Import again Click OK when QuickBooks finishes importing your items Other things to know about items Now that you know all about creating different types of items I m going to tell you how to change the price of items and create subitems QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 75 Changing the price of items Got something selling like fans in a heat wave Maybe you should apply a little supply
194. efore entering a discount item that calculates on a percentage basis To create subtotal items 1 Choose Lists gt Items 2 Click the at the bottom of the list 3 Inthe Type field of the New Item window choose Subtotal 4 Enter an item name such as Subtotal 5 Enter the description that you want QuickBooks to put on your sales forms when you apply the subtotal 6 Click OK QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 69 Creating group items You can create groups of items that can help you with e Fast data entry Group items let you enter a great amount of line item detail quickly On a sales or purchase form enter the name of the group item and QuickBooks fills in all the details about the items in the group for you e More detailed reports Group items let you track the items you sell in greater detail For example a construction firm that remodels houses could set up a group item that lists the significant components of a remodeling job lumber carpentry hours markup etc Sales reports for the company would then show income broken down by each component instead of a single lump sum for all remodeling jobs e Less detail for customers Use group items to track a lot of detail about your items while also giving your customers simple uncluttered invoices Set up a group item so that the printed version of an invoice reduces a group item to a single line item and one amount When you view the invoice on your screen
195. eive Payments 2 Choose the customer to whom you just wrote the refund check You ll see the amount of the credit included in the Existing Credits field and the refund check in the bottom section of the window 3 Select the Apply Existing Credits checkbox 4 On the Refund Chk line enter the check amount in the Payment column if not already entered by QuickBooks and then click OK If you now choose Customers gt Create Credit Memos Refunds to display the credit memo you just entered and click Tx History you should see the refund check listed in the Transaction History Credit memo window Other things to know about credit memos View payment history for the credit memo Click history to see the payments for this credit memo Apply sales tax If you re charging sales tax for the items click Taxable to apply sales tax Print email add to iCal or Calendar You can mark the credit memo as to be printed or emailed later Then choose File gt Print forms or File gt Email forms You can also add a reminder to iCal or Calendar ala 8 Getting paid for time and costs When you work for a customer many times you charge them for time you ve worked expenses you ve incurred and mileage you ve put on your car You can track that in QuickBooks and include that on the forms you sent to your customers to get reimbursed If you are writing an invoice you can also have QuickBooks calculate a markup and apply the markup to each expense
196. en you try to sell more of an item than you currently have in stock o Warn about duplicate purchase order numbers Cause QuickBooks to warn you when you try to record a purchase order that has the same number as a previous purchase order The warning causes QuickBooks to take more time to record a purchase order If you are not concerned about duplicate numbers do not select this preference Jobs preferences Jobs If you use job tracking you can edit the descriptions to indicate the status of a job Normally these are Pending Awarded In progress Closed and Not awarded When you set up or edit the information for a job you can choose one of these descriptions to indicate the job s current status A job s status appears on the Customer Job list and in job reports 1 Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences 2 On the Preferences pane select Jobs 3 Set the preferences described below 4 Close the Preferences window To change the label of a job status enter the new status name Once you ve changed the label all the jobs with that status use the new label For example if you change the Pending status to Still thinking about it all the jobs with the status Pending now have the status Still thinking about it QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 282 Merchant Service preferences Merchant Service You can use QuickBooks to accept your customers debit and credit cards Use Me
197. end out your invoices 7 Click OK to close the Review Invoices window All the new invoices show up in the left wing of your Invoices window Tips for batch invoicing Want to print out the whole batch of invoices Email the whole batch On the Review Invoices window use the checkmark shaped menu at the bottom left of the window to select all invoices to print select all invoices to email A batch invoice isn t the same as a memorized transaction You still have to create an invoice for your group of customers every time you want to bill them QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 102 Statement charges Say you re a web designer A client needs you to do odds and ends work update a page here add a video Bill To Babcock s Music Shop Kristie Babcock 10923 Samson Dr Millbrae CA 94030 there you get the picture Sometimes the work takes a few minutes and sometimes Date Amount Due Enclosed it takes hours In this a 12 15 13 0 00 Date Description Amount Balance situation it may make sense SASA SBa 0 00 to use a statement to bill the client You can also send statements as a record of invoices you ve sent and payments you ve received A statement includes the following information e Any balance the customer owes e Date number amount and description for each Current 1 30 Days 31 60 Days 61 90 Days OVER 90 Days Amount Due i nvo i ce an d statement Past Due Past Du
198. entage be sure to include the sign o Inthe Markup Account field enter the name of the account you use to track markup income o If you don t want your customer to see the markup amount on the invoice select the Print selected time and costs as one invoice item checkbox When you print the invoice it shows one amount the sum of all the expenses plus the markup The Description column lists the amount as Total reimbursable expenses If you want you can change this description by editing the onscreen version of the QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 130 invoice The onscreen version of the invoice also shows the Total reimbursable expenses line item In addition it lists the individual expenses and amounts that make up the total 8 Optional If you want the costs you select to appear as a single line item when you print the invoice select the Print selected time and costs as one invoice item checkbox When you view the invoice on your screen you ll see a separate line for each cost when you print the invoice only the total for the entire group of costs appears Important Do this only if you are certain you want the printed invoice to show only the total of the costs and not a line by line listing of each cost Once you record the invoice you will not be able to print the costs separately 9 If you have other kinds of costs to add to the invoice click the appropriate tab and repeat Steps 5 through 8
199. enter that historical information That way you re records for your fiscal year will be complete You ll find out more later in this chapter e Are you the kind of person who likes to have everything organized up front before you start Then the best place to start is creating your lists Lists are the building blocks for QuickBooks They include the things like what you re selling your customers and what you re buying from your vendors They also include the names and contact info for all your customers and vendors and much more I ll talk about lists in the next chapter and Set Up and Go might work well for you too I ll talk about Set Up and Go in the next section e Are you the kind of person who just wants to get started and fill in the details later You can do that too Go ahead and start entering transactions QuickBooks will prompt you to enter information along the way The Home Page is a good place to start eee RockCastle Construction Home Page j rt z NJ H Ad ul 2 AN Getting Around Snapshot Community Little Square Help TN X A i B i t g O e Purchase Receive Pay Chart of Transaction Enter Bilis 3 Orders Inventory Against Inventory Sales Tax piia Serer s0puen E Report Enter Bills Pay Bills Coat Online Invoice Accept reate Payments Credit Cards Sales Receipts O 3 E Estimates Greate Receve Record Reconcile Invoices Payments Deposits _t we F re S g Ey St
200. entering a cost of 10 00 when the markup is 25 causes QuickBooks to fill in the sales price as 12 50 o Track reimbursed expenses as income Track an expense and your customer s reimbursement for the expense in separate accounts QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 289 When this preference is on QuickBooks adds this checkbox and field to the New and Edit Account windows for expense accounts When this setting is off QuickBooks does not let you track customer reimbursements in a separate income account The income you receive for reimbursable expenses posts to the expense account thus canceling the original expense o Automatically apply payments Automatically apply a customer s payment to the outstanding invoices for that customer If the amount received is less than the customer s outstanding balance QuickBooks applies the payment to the oldest invoices first When this setting is off QuickBooks does not automatically apply customer payments You must specify how to apply a payment when you are in the Receive Payments window o Automatically calculate payments When this preference is on you can select an invoice in the table of the Receive Payments form before entering an Amount Received and QuickBooks prefills the amount of that selected invoice into the Amount Received field QuickBooks continues to automatically calculate the Amount Received based on the invoices you select or deselect for that payment When this preference
201. er the description as you would like your customers or vendors to See it 7 Enter the rate price or amount QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 66 o Service The RATE for the service The amount can be either a flat fee or an hourly rate If you purchase this service enter the vendor s rate If you sell this service enter the rate you charge your customers o Non inventory part The PRICE of the part If you purchase this part enter the vendor s price If you sell this part enter the price you charge your customers o Other charge The AMOUNT of the charge You can enter either a dollar amount or a percentage If the amount is a percentage be sure to include a sign o Enter an account for the item o Sales The name of the INCOME account you use to track income from this item o Purchases The name of the EXPENSE account you use to track purchases of this item 8 Sales only If you don t charge sales tax for this item clear the Taxable checkbox 9 Optional Fill in any custom fields that apply to this item 10 To mark an item as inactive select the Inactive checkbox 11 Click OK Creating items for inventory Use inventory part items to represent materials or parts you buy track as inventory and then resell You can keep track of how many items remain in stock after a sale how many items you have on order your cost of goods sold and the value of your inventory To create items for inventory 1
202. er the liability account at the bottom of the check e If the check is for items on your items list enter the item in the Item field of the Items pane Deposits Choose Record Deposits and enter your unrecorded deposits Be sure to refer to your bank account register so you don t record a deposit that s already in there e Fees and transfers In your bank account s register window enter any other fees charges or interest earned from your bank statement Be sure to enter amounts in the correct column Increase or Decrease Also enter any transfers between bank accounts You can also use Banking gt Transfer Funds to record transfers Entering credit card transactions Now that you entered your unrecorded bank account transactions in QuickBooks let s look at your credit cards Just to be clear these are transactions on your credit cards Accepting credit cards as payment from your customers is another topic QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 21 How you enter these historical transactions depends on whether you pay your balance in full each month If you pay your balance in full each month you can simply record a check Banking gt Write Checks for each payment Here are a few things to keep in mind e If you entered a balance for your credit card account as of your start date the first check should pay off that balance In the Account field of the check enter the name of the credit card account For check
203. ess Info pane enter the contact information for the vendor Take special note of the fields needed for 1099s e Company Name If you send a 1099 MISC form to this vendor enter the company s legal name e First Name M I Last Name If the vendor is a large corporation for example your utility company you can leave these fields blank If you send a 1099 MISC form to this vendor enter the vendor s LEGAL name in these fields e Address The vendor s address QuickBooks has partially filled in the Address field on the basis of what you ve entered so far Enter the address as you want it to appear on printed checks to the vendor Click Address Details to make sure each individual address field is filled in correctly especially if you are using contact sync Mail merge If you use mail merge be sure to include in the last line of the address the two letter state abbreviation and the zip code This ensures that the address will print correctly in mail merge documents e Print on check as The vendor s name as it will appear on printed checks you send to the vendor QuickBooks prefills this field with the vendor s company name but you can edit the name if you want it to print differently on your checks QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 150 Note The information in shaded fields is synchronized with Mac OS X Address Book and other applications that use Sync Services Additional Info On the Additional Info pane enter the infor
204. ess your customer s credit or debit card You ll be prompted to enter the customer s card number and information e You can also save a customer s card information when you edit a customer Once it s saved you can just select it when you create a sales receipt or enter a payment My Company amp My Company preferences My Company preferences set basic and very important information about your company such as your company s name and when your fiscal year starts 1 Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 283 2 On the Preferences pane select My Company 3 Set the preferences described below 4 Close the Preferences pane e Company Name The name of your company Note The company name does not have to be the same as the filename for your company data e Address The address for your company as you want it to appear on invoices checks and other forms You can also enter different addresses for Shipping appears on purchase orders and Legal appears on 1099 1096 e Country The country for your company s address Federal ID The ID you use when filing your company s federal taxes e Phone Number Fax Number Website Email address Additional contact information for your company Reporting Info QuickBooks uses your fiscal year to set the date range for certain reports and graphs For example if your fiscal year begins on July 1st the beginning date for reports based on your fi
205. etail area of the check Some advice on creating accounts Don t create too many accounts Too much detail can be burdensome You can always see the details by running a detailed report Be as descriptive as possible when naming your accounts Descriptive names help you find the correct account quickly and easily Be consistent when entering your transactions For meaningful reports and comparisons it s very important to use the same accounts for the same transactions each time Tips and tricks on using your Chart of Accounts Try these tips and tricks to make using the Chart of Accounts even easier e Customize the color of an account Double click any account name that has a register and is the type you want to change Then choose Edit gt Change Account Color You can only color code balance sheet accounts that is accounts with registers e Sort information by clicking the column titles e Rearrange the columns by clicking and dragging the top of a column to move it to another location Select multiple names in one of these ways QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 51 o Shift click to select a range of names Select the first name you want hold down the Shift key and then select the last name in the range o Command click to select a group of nonadjacent names Select a name hold down the Command key 8 and then select each additional name o Command A to select all names No need to click jus
206. ew of your Customer Center the Customer Jobs list is on the left side of the Center and the detailed information and transactions list for the selected customer or job are on the right Use the views and icons at the bottom of the Customer Center to manage your customers and job information QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 78 00e Q Filter Customers amp Groups Customer Groups Click below to create a Customer Group rJ 7 Customer Center Customer Information ve Abercrombie Kristy e Residential Kristy Abercrombie 5647 Cypress Hill Rd Guide Me JFF Edit Customer Edit Notes t Kristy Abercrombie e 415 555 6579 kristy samplename com Gustomen ion Balance Total Bayshore CA 94326 Me gt Abercrombie Kristy s Net 30 Allard Robert 14 510 00 gt Babcock s Music Shop 0 00 Map Directions Baker Chris 0 00 gt Balak Mike 0 00 9 15 2003 Send Kristy estimate for den remodel gt Barley Renee 0 00 9 20 2003 Called Kristy to discuss job Kristy is not interested at this time Estimate was competitive not gt Bauman Mark 0 00 using another firm gt Bolinski Rafal 0 00 10 15 2003 Further discussion of bathroom remodel offered 10 discount on project if she would sign the contract now gt Bristol Sonya 0 00 n gt Burch Jason 1 005 00 Name Type Number Date Account Amount Memo gt Campbell Heather 13 900 00 Abercrombie Kris Invoice 1024 2 1 13 1100
207. example Monthly rents Click Automatically Enter From the How Often list choose how often you want QuickBooks to enter the charges Weekly Monthly etc In the Next Date field enter the NEXT service date in your billing cycle For example if the service date for the statement charges is February 1st and you bill monthly you would enter March 1st Step 3 In the A R register or the individual customer registers memorize each statement charge that you entered 4 5 In the register click the statement charge Choose Edit gt Memorize Stmt Charge Optional In the Memorize Transaction window change the name of the transaction This affects how QuickBooks lists the transaction in the Memorized Transactions list it does not affect the transaction itself Click With Transactions in Group From the Group Name list choose the memorized transaction group you just created When you have finished QuickBooks automatically enters the statement charges for each billing cycle All you have to do is print and mail the statements Stopping automatic entry of a charge If you enter statement charges automatically but no longer need to charge a particular customer you can remove that customer from the memorized transaction group Choose Lists gt Memorized Transactions In the Memorized Transaction list select the customer You ll find the customer in the list of names immediately below the name of the memo
208. f field enter your QuickBooks start date QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 83 Important Leave these fields blank if you are planning to set up one or more jobs for this customer QuickBooks will calculate the overall balance for this customer from the balances you enter for the individual jobs To keep your records up to date enter all historical transactions from the day after your start date through today For example if you wrote invoices to this customer between your start date and today you must enter those invoices into your QuickBooks records This gives QuickBooks the ability to provide full financial reports for your company for any period of time after your start date e Customer is taxable Tax Item When this checkbox is selected QuickBooks automatically calculates sales tax for each taxable item you sell to this customer QuickBooks uses the sales tax rate specified in the Tax Item field If you do not charge sales tax to this customer clear the checkbox If these options do not appear it means that sales tax is turned off in QuickBooks This could be because you indicated that you don t charge your customers sales tax when you were setting up your QuickBooks company through the New Company Setup Assistant Tip Ordinarily you don t charge sales tax on items that a customer buys for resale If this customer is strictly a resale customer be sure to clear the Customer is taxable checkbox e Resale number If the
209. f you re tracking by job to the job you are doing for the customer To find out how to enter job related expenses see the sections on entering bills checks and credit card charges Set up your vehicles in the Vehicles list Then enter your mileage using Company gt Enter Mileage To track your mileage see the section on mileage starting on page 138 If you have been tracking billable hours or expenses for a particular job you can invoice your customer for your costs To invoice for actual costs 1 Choose Customers gt Create Invoices 2 Choose the name of the job from the Customer Job list 3 Click Time Costs at the top of the window Le QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 129 4 Click the tab for the kind of cost you want to include on the invoice o Items Items you purchased for this job These include inventory parts non inventory parts subcontracted services and other charge items o Mileage Mileage you ve entered and assigned to this job o Expenses Other costs and expenses you incurred for this job o Time Time billable to this job 5 Inthe Use column click next to each cost you want to include on the invoice A check mark next to an item indicates that the cost will appear on the invoice or statement charge O If you see this symbol in the Use column it means that you have included the cost on the invoice but you have not yet recorded the invoice o Items For inventory parts resale
210. f you are a graphic designer and one of your job types is brochure you could create a job profitability report and filter the report so that it lists only your brochure jobs You would then know how much money you had made from designing brochures Use types in reports Now that you re using customer and job types you can apply that filter to a report to get better insight into your business Classes I m a data nerd Seriously It s being able to see how the numbers fall into what categories that makes me go all moony eyed So that s why classes are one of my favorite features about QuickBooks Classes are simply categories You can then apply a class to transactions to get more insight into your business data A class can be a department name a location or anything that means something to you Say you re a magician You might create the classes corporate event and children s party That way when you need to buy a custom costume for your rabbit Hopscotch that spells out Happy Birthday Princess in pink glitter you can classify that expense as being related to a corporate event Hey it could happen Really it could Then you can create a class report to show all your income and expenses related to a class Creating classes e800 Class List The first thing you need to do to use classes is be sure ee i they are turned on in your Preferences Choose isi Remodel Overhead QuickBooks
211. ff QuickBooks logs only the most recent version of each transaction in the audit trail report e Warn about duplicate bill numbers Cause QuickBooks to warn you when you try to record a bill that has the same number as an existing bill The bills do not have to be from the same QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 293 vendor for the warning to occur The warning causes QuickBooks to take more time to record a bill If you are not concerned about duplicate numbers do not select this preference e Bills are due _ days after receipt Enter the number of days you want QuickBooks to use when it calculates the due date of your bills QuickBooks initially assumes that bills are due 10 days after receipt This means that if you enter a bill dated January 1 QuickBooks will show January 11th as the due date QuickBooks uses the due date to determine when to add the bill to the Bills to pay section of your Reminders list Enable Autolmport folder Used for third part applications such as Xsilva s Lightspeed Point of Sale If you need this the third party application s set up information will tell you QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 294 a Users amp Passwords preferences amp You can set up user accounts with full or limited access to features in your company file Say you have an employee who does data entry work for you You want this user to have access to basic bookkeeping features but not more advanced feature
212. fields o Initials QuickBooks fills in the employee s initials as you fill in the employee s name Normally you do not have to enter anything into this field If your employees earn commissions for items they sell you can select an employee s initials from the Rep pop up menu when entering a sale or estimate to give the employee credit You can then produce reports showing all sales for each employee o Address Complete the employee s address QuickBooks has partially filled in the Address field on the basis of what you ve entered so far Click Address Details to make sure each individual address field is filled in correctly especially if you are using Contact Sync The address information you enter can be exported for mail merge If you use mail merge be sure to include in the last line of the address the two letter state abbreviation and the zip code This ensures that the address will print correctly in mail merge documents o Social Security Number QuickBooks observes federal standards for social security numbers If the number you enter causes QuickBooks to display an error message call your local Social Security Administration office to check the validity of the number 4 Optional Click the Additional Info tab Fill in any custom fields that apply to this employee QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 37 5 To mark an employee as inactive select the Inactive checkbox You can then hide inactive employees by clearing the Inclu
213. first blank line to enter a new item press Tab to move from field to field Examples refunds from vendors or money that an owner is investing in the company 5 Enter cash back details or credit card fees 6 Click OK To print a deposit summary and or slip 1 With the Make Deposits window still open choose File gt Print Deposit 2 Choose whether you d like to print a deposit summary only or a deposit slip and summary 3 Ifyou choose slip and summary choose whether to include cash in the deposit and whether to print check numbers on the deposit slip 4 Click OK 5 Inthe Print window make any desired changes and then click Print 6 Click OK Things you should know e You can also save or email this item as a PDF file making it easy to keep records and share with others e If your bank separates different kinds of deposits checks credit card payments etc you may want to separate your deposits in the same way 1 Select only one type of payment checks for example in the Payments to Deposit window and then click OK 2 Complete the Make Deposits window and then click next 3 Click Payments to redisplay the Payments to Deposit window 4 Start the process over by choosing another group of payments Visa for example QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 174 Editing or deleting a deposited payment To edit or delete a payment you ve already included in a deposit you must first remove the payment from the or
214. for Mac 2014 User s Guide 171 Paying a credit card bill When you have finished reconciling a credit card account you can pay part or all of the balance due on your credit card To pay a credit card bill 1 When you have finished marking the transactions in the Reconcile window click Done 2 Decide how you want to pay the bill o To write a check for the bill Select Write a check for payment now o To enter the bill for later payment through accounts payable Select Enter a bill for payment later 3 Click OK 4 Complete the transaction o If this is the first time you are paying this credit card company enter the name of the credit card company in the Pay to the order of field if you are writing a check or the Vendor field if you are entering a bill o To pay part of the amount due edit the amount that QuickBooks has filled in o Click OK to record the transaction If you are writing a check you can print the check by clicking Print Managing your checks and credit cards Transaction Center The Transaction Center gives you access to information about all of your transactions The Income Tracker up top shows you the basics of how your business is doing right now today In the Center you can quickly find transactions for all your customers in one place such as checks invoices and bill payments To open the Transaction Center 1 Choose Company gt Transaction Center 2 Select a transa
215. for a customer Choose Customers gt Create Invoices Statement A statement is a list of charges the customer has rung up over a period of time You create statement charges to record what you ve done for the customer as you go along and then send a statement that lists all the accumulated charges For example you can senda statement once a month for all the work you ve done for a customer that month Choose Customers gt Create Statements Sending your customer an invoice Any time that you do something or sell something for a customer they need to pay you If they don t pay you on the spot then you can send them an invoice so they ll pay you later If you have an open estimate for a customer QuickBooks lets you know this when you select the customer name on the invoice You can then select which estimate you want to use to create an invoice Q Watch a video on how to create an invoice http www qpblittlesquare com 2011 09 video creating an invoice in quickbooks 2012 Creating or editing an invoice 1 Choose Customers gt Create Invoice 2 To create a new invoice click the Create an Invoice on the left panel or click the at the bottom of the list To edit an invoice select an invoice in the list on the left panel 3 Enter the information for the invoice and click Save Note You can also create invoices using the Customer Center and Transaction Center What s on an invoice e Customer Job Select the
216. g as much as possible the fonts and colors you set in the original report You can then use formatting and data analysis features to further customize the report 3 When the file opens choose File gt Save As to save the file where you want it Note QuickBooks opens XLSX files in either Microsoft Excel or Apple Numbers depending on which application you have set to open XLSX files To change the default application locate a XLSX file right click and choose Get Info On the Open With menu select the application you want to open XLSX files then select Change All Zoom in for more detail in a report QuickZoom helps you investigate any amount or transaction on accrual basis reports Use QuickZoom whenever the mouse pointer changes to this symbol D QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 234 To zoom in for more detail in a report double click the amount or transaction you want to investigate QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 235 CHAPTER 10 Other cool things about QuickBooks OK admit it have a bunch of things to tell you about QuickBooks that couldn t really find a place for elsewhere in this eBook So I put them all in one chapter hope that s OKO Your toolbar Picking the icons you want So you don t have employees but you use statements all the time And there s a report you view every day Guess what You can get to your common tasks quickly using the toolbar RockCastle Constru admin Drag
217. g in weekly timesheets 134 108 Entering single activities 136 Including reimbursable expenses on a Editing time entries 137 statemen 109 Tracking mileage 138 QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide ji Enter mileage 138 Enter mileage rates for taxes 139 Categorizing for more insight into your business 140 Customer and job types 140 Examples of customer types 140 Categorize your jobs 141 Use types in reports 141 Classes 141 Creating classes 141 Applying classes 143 Using classes in reports 144 CHAPTER 6 Paying others 146 Vendor Center 146 How do use it 147 Tips and tricks 148 Entering vendors in QuickBooks 150 Types of vendor transactions 153 You receive the things your ordered and need to pay for them 153 You have a credit from a vendor 153 You need to pay your sales taxes 153 Ordering items you ll pay for later 154 What s on a purchase order 155 When you receive your goods 157 Other things to know about POs 157 Paying your bills 158 Entering bills and credits 158 Tracking expenses related to a bill 160 Listing items included in a bill 161 Bills FAQs 162 Paying bills and using credits 163 Tracking bills and credits 164 Using 1099s 165 Setting up for 1099s 165 Verifying 1099 Information 165 CHAPTER 7 Banking 168 Writing checks and entering credit card charges 168 Writing a check 168 What s on a check 169 Entering a charge or refund to your credit card 170 What s on a credit card charge 170 Pa
218. go back to the 1099 Summary report the first report you created Return the report to its original state by clicking Only 1099 Vendors Only 1099 Accounts and Use Thresholds in the report buttonbar The report should list every vendor to whom you send 1099 MISC forms and it should show the correct 1099 amounts for each vendor QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 167 CHAPTER 7 Banking Now we get to the part of QuickBooks that will probably already feel familiar to you banking You ve probably had a bank account for a long time whether it s a personal account or one for your business Writing checks and using your credit cards to pay for things isn t anything new to you But how do you track all of that in QuickBooks That s what I m going to get into in this chapter Writing checks and entering credit card charges When you write a check or use your credit card you should track those transactions in QuickBooks Writing a check You can write checks in QuickBooks for a couple of reasons Record a bank account withdrawal you made either by manually writing a check or through an ATM withdrawal e Write a check that you will print on blank checks with your printer that you ll send to vendors to pay them You can customize a check you re printing such as adding a logo on the Print window when you print the check To write a check 1 Choose Banking gt Write Checks 2 To write a new check click the New Che
219. gt Create Batch Invoices Read the Batch Invoicing info that pops up Click OK to send the pop up away Click New Group to create a group of customers to invoice Choose the group you just created in the Customer Job Group field Read the info about sales tax and batch invoicing that pops up Click OK to send the message away Add items to the invoice Make sure the date invoice number customer message and other info on the invoice are correct When your invoice is complete click Save The Review Invoices window pops up Check each invoice which appears as one line in the table to make sure all the info including the sales tax charged to the customer is correct QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 100 10 Choose the To Print checkbox if you re going to print this invoice Choose the To Email checkbox if you re going to email this invoice to the customer Tip You can both print and email the same invoice 11 Make sure that QuickBooks has checked all the invoices you want created in the left checkbox If you don t want one of the customers in this group to get this invoice uncheck the box 12 Click Create QuickBooks creates the batch of invoices assigns them numbers and saves them But wait you re not quite done yet You still need to email and or print the invoices you ve created To print a batch of invoices 1 Click Print 2 On the Print Forms window make sure all the invoices you want to print are select
220. has on order her cost of goods sold and the value of her inventory When she creates her items she has the option to select one of her vendors as a preferred vendor for that item To learn how to create an inventory item see page 67 Set up accounts Hannah also makes sure she has these accounts in her Chart of Accounts e Inventory Asset which is an Other Current Asset account to track the current value of her inventory This is created automatically when Hannah creates an inventory part QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 200 e Sales an Income account to track the income from the sale of her inventory items If you sell both items and services you may want to use a Sales account for each depending on what works best for your business Because she s created an inventory item QuickBooks automatically creates a Cost of Goods Sold account to track the costs to Hannah of the items she s selling Hannah purchases her inventory Start up small business Hannah s Illusion Watch thevideol McCormick s Hannah s on her way to buy the stock for the Wand shop Supplies is now set up for inventory and Buy stock with cash Hannah goes to McCormick s Wand Supply and buys a gross of wands She pays McCormick s with cash Back in her office Hannah records the purchase in QuickBooks by using Write Inventory Part 2 Hannah gets her stock Checks and selecting her Petty Cash account http www qpblittlesquare com
221. hat your account doesn t balance and telling you how much the Difference is 2 Click Enter Adjustment QuickBooks creates a transaction that balances the account and marks this transaction as cleared If you want to see this transaction open the account register and look for a tiny little transaction Compare the opening balance amount shown on your statement with the amount shown in the Beginning Balance field in the Reconcile window If your opening balances don t match it means either that 1 you mistakenly cleared a transaction in the current statement period or 2 a previously cleared transaction in your register one dated before the current statement period was changed or deleted between today and the last time you reconciled You can handle the discrepancy in one of two ways e Quit reconciling and look for the problem in the register When you fix the problem choose Banking gt Reconcile again Your opening balances should now match e Ignore the discrepancy in the opening balances for now When you finish reconciling choose Enter Adjustment to make QuickBooks add a balance adjustment transaction to the register Undoing a Reconciliation If your Beginning Balance when you open up a new Reconcile window doesn t match the Ending Balance of your last reconciliation you ve got a problem One good way to solve this is to use the Previous Reconciliation Reports to find transactions that aren t cleared or have changed You ca
222. he Pay Bills To pay your entered bills 1 Choose Vendors gt Pay Bills use the Pay Bills window 2 Show the bills you want to pay Choose All bills to see every bill you ve entered or enter a due date to see all bills due on or before that date If you don t see a bill you want to pay you probably need to change the date here 3 Choose a payment type You record a bill as paid by Check or Credit Card If you choose Check choose one of these options o If you re printing the checks through QuickBooks select To be printed After you exit the Pay Bills window you can then choose File gt Print Forms gt Checks to print your checks o If you re writing checks by hand select Assign check numbers When you exit the Pay Bills window you ll be able to enter the check numbers you used 4 Select the bills you want to pay with the payment type In the column click the bills you want to pay To select all the bills click Select All Bills To clear your selections click Clear Selections Note To pay only part of a particular bill edit the amount shown in the Mat Paid column 5 Choose the account you re paying the bill from By default your bills are paid from the first account listed in the Chart of Accounts You can reorder the Chart of Accounts so that a different account is listed first 6 If you have more bills to pay click Next If you re done with selecting your bills to pay click OK Note You might cli
223. he address you have for the customer displays here This is how the customer contact information will appear here You can make any changes you need to e Date Today s date which you can change Tip Press to increase the date by one day press to decrease the date by one day e Credit No QuickBooks automatically increments this number by one for each new credit memo Tip Press to increase the number by one press to decrease the number by one e PO Number If there s a related purchase order PO enter that PO number here Item Select what you re creating the credit memo or refund for You can include anything on the Items list here You also enter a new item and QuickBooks will prompt you to set it up Tip If you need to insert an item between two others select the item line where you want the new one and choose Edit gt Insert Line Likewise if you want to delete an item select the item then choose Edit gt Delete Line e Description The description of the item you entered when you created the item You can change this if you need to Tip You can enter multiple lines for your description up to 4095 characters Use Option Return to put in a line break e Quantity How many of the items are you crediting the customer for This could be 400 antennae or 10 hours of web design If you leave this blank QuickBooks assumes the quantity is 1 Rate How much you charge for the item If you entered this when you created
224. he bottom of the list Lt Or control click anywhere in the list and choose New Class from the shortcut menu Edit Existing Class Double click the class name Or select the name of the class and click the Edit button at the bottom of the list LZ Or in the Class list control click the name of the class you want to edit and choose Edit Class from the shortcut menu Enter a name for the class Optional If you want the class to be a subclass of another class select the Subclass of checkbox and enter the name of the parent class QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 36 Employees list If you have employees you should enter them in the Employees list omno Is your worker an employee or a contractor AA http www qblittlesquare com 2011 01 hiring for your business part 1 contractors vs employees To add or edit an employee 1 Choose Lists gt Employees 2 Add anew employee or open an existing employee Add New Employee Edit Existing Employee e Click the menu at the bottom of e Double click the employee name the list Or select the name of the employee and di click the Edit button at the bottom of e Or control click anywhere in the list the list and choose New Employee from 4 the shortcut menu Orin the Employee list control click the name of the employee you want to edit and choose Edit Employee from the shortcut menu 3 Complete the Address Info tab Take special note of the following
225. he customer and tax information e Type A word or phase that categorizes this customer for your reports You can choose a customer type you have already set up from the list or you can enter a new customer type and have QuickBooks add it to the list To create a customer type choose Lists gt Customer amp Vendor Profile gt Customer Type For more about this see page 38 e Terms Associates a specific set of payment terms with the customer You can choose an existing set of terms from the list or you can enter a new set of terms and have QuickBooks add it to the list For more information see page 39 Rep The initials of the sales representative who deals with this customer on a regular basis When you write an invoice to this customer QuickBooks automatically associates the sales representative with every invoice you send to the customer This gives you the ability to create sales reports that are subtotaled by sales representative e Credit limit Optional The credit limit that the customer has with your company QuickBooks remembers the limit and warns you when the customer is about to exceed the limit e Opening balance As of Applies only if you are setting up records for a new QuickBooks company They help you establish a correct accounts receivable balance as of the start date you chose for your QuickBooks records o In the Opening Balance field enter the amount this customer owed as of your start date o Inthe as o
226. he dates of your travel time If it was just one day use the same date for both dates e Odometer and Total Miles You can tell QuickBooks how far you drove by entering your starting and ending odometer settings The Total Miles is calculated from those numbers Or you can just click in the Total Miles box and enter the number of miles you drove e Notes Enter any notes you may have about this trip such as Travel to planning meeting or Whoopee cushion delivery Billable If you plan to bill a customer for this mileage check Billable The status tells you whether the mileage has already been billed to a customer Once Billable is checked you can then use the mileage with the Time Costs option when you create and invoice e Assign to Customer Job If your trip was for a specific customer you can select that Customer Job and item and assign a class Be sure to select a Service or Other Charge item so QuickBooks know what mileage rate to apply Then when you create an invoice for that customer you ll be reminded you have mileage expenses assigned to that customer Enter mileage rates for taxes If you plan to deduct trips on your taxes you need to enter the rates allowed by the IRS The rate and your trips appear on Mileage reports Reports gt Note Be sure to check the IRS s rules about deducting mileage at http www irs gov 1 Choose Company gt Mileage Rates 2 Click the key to add a new rate or the key to dele
227. he field in the label column o Select the lists where you want the field to appear Note You can select a custom field for all three lists customer vendor employee but each list can only have a total of seven custom fields 4 Click OK QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 44 To add custom fields to items 1 On the Items list edit an item 2 Click Custom fields If you already have custom fields you ll see them here 3 Click Define Fields 4 For each new custom field o Enter the name of the field o Select the Use checkbox Note Custom fields are available for all item types except subtotals sales tax items and sales tax groups 5 Click OK 6 Optional Fill in the fields for this item If you fill in information for a field the information you enter transfers automatically to any custom form where the field appears For example if the field is named Color and you ve entered navy blue as the color of a particular item the Color field on your sales forms prefills to navy blue each time you enter a sale of the item Leave a field blank if you d prefer to fill it in at the time you make a sale write a purchase order or prepare an estimate To remove or rename a custom field throughout QuickBooks Keep in mind that changes to custom fields affects all transactions and reports where the custom field appears For example if you change a name from Sales Region to State a previous tr
228. he fields you want to see Use the Fields window to choose what information should appear on your form Click the Print or Screen box for the fields you want to see either on screen in QuickBooks or on the printed form If you aren t using a field clear its checkbox to remove it Depending on which form you re customizing there will be some fields that you can t remove Look for any custom fields you ve created in the Fields area of the window Move a field In the template select any field When you see boxes on the corners of the field it s selected Move the field to where you want it Change the name of a field Select the field name you want to change delete the current name and replace it with the name you want to appear on the form Add text boxes and lines to the template In the template window click the Text Text Box Box or Line button on the toolbar then draw the object in the template window You can then use the Formatting Palette to customize the way the object looks Double click on text to edit it Add a status stamp such as Pending Paid Received in Full or Closed to the printed form The stamp that appears depends on the type of form you select o PENDING this stamp appears on invoices sales receipts and credit memos that you mark as pending o PAID this stamp appears on invoices for which the balance due is zero o RECEIVED IN FULL this stamp appears on purchase orders for which the balance due is zero
229. he item on a sales form To set up an item as taxable 1 Choose Lists gt Items 2 Add a new item or edit an existing item 3 Select the Taxable checkbox To apply tax to a non taxable item 1 Ona sales form enter the item as you normally would 2 Click the Tax column to the right of the Amount column What happens When you enter a taxable item or click next to the amount of a non taxable item a T appears beside the item amount If the customer is taxable QuickBooks includes all items marked with a T in its tax calculation Assigning a tax rate to a customer You can set automatically charge sales tax when you make a sale to a particular customer Do this by completing two fields on the customer s record in the Customer Job list QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 217 To assign a tax rate to a customer 1 Choose Lists gt Customer Jobs 2 Find the customer you want to make taxable and edit the customer Double click the name of customer or select the name and click Edit Customer 3 Click the Additional Info tab 4 Ifa customer is sometimes exempt from sales tax enter the customer s tax exemption ID in the Resale No field 5 Select the Customer is taxable checkbox 6 Inthe Tax Item field select the tax you usually charge this customer When you make a sale to the customer QuickBooks automatically calculates the tax by using the tax item you choose for the customer If you want you can cal
230. header information e Collapse Hide subaccounts jobs and subclasses by summarizing their amounts under the main heading This choice affects both the onscreen and printed report Click the checkbox again to display the subaccounts you previously hid Formatting your reports After you create a report Reports gt Report Center and you display the data you need you can format your report so it looks like you want it to Customize columns e Make a column wider or narrower Move your mouse between two columns until you see the bar with an arrow cursor Drag the cursor to the right or left e Rearrange columns Drag the column s header to its new position The red arrow shows where the moved column will go e Sort data by a particular column Click any column header to sort on it click the header again to sort in the opposite direction The arrow next to the column header shows whether the column is sorted in ascending or descending order e Eliminate a column on reports that list transactions On the Report button bar click Options On the Columns list unselect the column s you want to eliminate e Display a column not currently displayed reports that list transactions On the Report button bar click Options On the Columns list unselect the column s you want to eliminate Specifying a header or footer At the top of the report click Header Footer and make your changes on the Header Footer window e Change the header
231. his list click the Left View View Ga 3 Enter the information for the bill and click Save Note You can also enter bills using the Vendor Center and Transaction Center QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 158 What s on a bill Bill or Credit Are you entering a bill or a credit from a vendor Vendor Choose the vendor from the Vendor list or type in the vendor s name If you have an open purchase order for this vendor QuickBooks asks you if you ve received the items your ordered If you have click Yes Then in the Open Purchase Orders window click each purchase order that contains items you ve received and are being billed for and then click OK Amount Due or Credit amount Enter the amount of the bill or credit Date QuickBooks automatically enters today s date but you should change it to the date on the bill Ref No Enter the bill statement or invoice number Terms Bills only QuickBooks uses the terms to determine the due date of your bill payment as well as the date you ll need to pay by to receive a discount for early payment Bill Due Bills only Enter the date the bill is due Memo Enter a memo that will appear on reports that include the bill or credit Show in iCal or Calendar Adds a reminder to pay the bill in iCal or Calendar Expense and Items Choose either the Expenses of Items pane Enter information about what you re being billed for expenses you track through expense accounts
232. hout a bill Enter an item receipt and then enter the bill when it arrives o Receive items with the bill included Receive the items and enter a bill at the same time Sell your inventory Now that you have inventory it s time to sell it You can track your sales in QuickBooks o Selling inventory to customers Sell inventory the same way you would sell other types of items by writing an invoice or a cash sales receipt o You can summarize sales If you don t need to track cash sales for each customer you can record all your cash sales for a specific period of time on a single cash sales receipt e Analyzing and adjusting your inventory Though QuickBooks adjusts your inventory as you buy and sell things you may need to do some things manually o Adjusting your inventory If the quantities change because of say fire theft or breakage you need to adjust the quantity on hand for each inventory item affected o Analyzing your inventory You can use inventory reports the Items list and the Purchase Order list to get information about your inventory QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 198 o Taking physical inventory You can use QuickBooks to create a worksheet for taking a physical count of your inventory stock To give you a feel for how all of this works together To see how inventory works we ll follow Hannah who has decided to be her own boss and open a new store Illusion Supplies QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User
233. however you ll see a separate line entry and amount for each item in the group To create a group item 1 Choose Lists gt Items 2 Click the menu at the bottom of the list and click New Item bait 3 Inthe Type field of the New Item window choose Group 4 Inthe Group Name Number field enter a name or number for the group item 5 Enter a description of the group item What you enter here appears on the list of items when you are filling out a sales form or purchase order Enter a name or number that will help you distinguish this item from all the others on the list 6 Optional Select the Print items in group checkbox o Select this checkbox if you want your customers to see a list of the individual items and their amounts on your printed forms o Leave the checkbox clear if you don t want the details of the group to appear on your printed forms You ll still see the details when you view the form onscreen 7 Inthe Item column select the items that you want to include in this group 8 Inthe Qty column enter the quantity you want QuickBooks to enter for each individual item when you use the group item on a form If you do not enter quantities QuickBooks assumes that the quantity of each item is 1 You can always change the quantities when you enter a sale or purchase You make the changes directly on the sale or purchase order form 9 Optional Fill in any custom fields that apply to this group of items QuickBook
234. iar with what data is converted from QuickBooks for Windows to QuickBooks for Mac Note If you don t have access to QuickBooks for Windows to convert your file we can help you In QuickBooks open the Welcome window Help gt Welcome to QuickBooks and click Switching to QuickBooks On your Windows computer 1 In QuickBooks for Windows open the company file you want to convert 2 Choose File gt Utilities gt Copy Company File for QuickBooks Mac Follow the onscreen instructions QuickBooks creates a Mac qbb backup file 3 Copy the qbb file to a CD or USB drive or some other media Most Macs read and write data to and from PC formatted media On your Mac 1 In QuickBooks for Mac choose File gt Open Company select the qbb file and then click Open 2 Click OK on when asked if you want to restore a QuickBooks for Windows file 3 Enter a name for the restored file and then click Save Depending on the size of your data file the conversion process can take up to ten minutes When conversion is complete QuickBooks opens the file What is and isn t converted when you switch to QuickBooks for Mac Although Intuit has used reasonable efforts to include all features affected Intuit disclaims that all features are included in these lists Be sure to compare the newly converted data with the original data to learn what data was not converted Data that IS converted from Windows to Mac e Account list chart of accou
235. ick the Recalc button in the Splits window Changing an opening balance Normally when you create a balance sheet account you ll enter a starting balance for it But there are times when you might either skip this step or find a need to change that balance First of all want to talk about what an opening balance is In a nutshell it s the amount of money or the value of an account when you start using QuickBooks So if you have 5000 in savings account when you start using QuickBooks you enter that as your opening balance when you create that account e If you don t have any transactions recorded for that account just edit the account and enter an opening balance e If you ve already got transactions recorded then open the Chart of Accounts and double click the account to open the register Look for the Opening Balance Equity entry and change it to the correct amount e If you don t have an Open Balance Equity entry in your account s register you need to add one Add a transaction to the register with Opening Balance Equity as the description and a date you want to record for the opening balance Enter the opening balance amount o Ina bank account enter the amount in the Deposit column o In an asset liability or equity account enter the amount in the Increase column o In a credit card account enter the amount in the Charge column Q To see how this works check out this video on Little Square http www qbli
236. ies In some lists you can combine two list entries into one For example you may find that you ve been using two customers because of different spellings when you really need only one on your Customer Jobs list Limitations You can merge list entries for these lists only Chart of Accounts Item Customer Jobs Vendor Employee and Other Name Once you merge two list entries you can t go back To merge list entries _ Display the list that has the entries you want to merge 2 Select the list entry whose name you DON T want to use and edit it Usually this means just double clicking the entry name 3 Change the list entry s name to be the same as the entry you re combining it with 4 Click OK 5 Click Yes to confirm that you want to merge the two list items under the same name Exporting names for mail merge You can select names and addresses from your QuickBooks records to merge with documents you create with a word processor This feature works with all QuickBooks lists of names Customer Job Vendor Employee and Other Names For example you can create a form letter to your vendors in your word processor and have your vendors names and addresses incorporated automatically into the letter Watch how to export contact information to a mail merge file http www gblittlesquare com 2011 06 exporting contact information for mail merge utc_source iph To export names for mail merge 1 Choose File gt Expor
237. ifferent views of the same data When you make a single activity entry QuickBooks automatically records the entry on that person s weekly timesheet Likewise if you fill in a weekly timesheet QuickBooks also saves each hourly entry as a separate single activity entry Filling in weekly timesheets A weekly timesheet is a record of the time spent by one person on any number of jobs over one week Use timesheets to record work done on several days or several jobs Anything you previously entered as a single activity entry automatically appears on a person s timesheet To fill in weekly timesheets 1 Choose Employees gt Time Tracking gt Use Weekly Timesheet QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 134 2 Inthe Name field enter the name of the person who performed the work and press Tab If you have already made time entries for that person for that week the entries appear on the timesheet You can add to or edit those entries 3 If necessary change the date range of the week displayed o To change to the next week click Next Week o To change to the previous week click Prev Week o To change to any other week click Set Date and enter a date in the week you want to display 4 Inthe Customer Job field enter the customer for whom the work was performed If you are tracking individual jobs as well enter the customer name a colon and a job name Press Tab o Non billable time If you do not intend to invoice your customer f
238. iginal deposit transaction To edit or delete a deposited payment 1 Open the Undeposited Funds register 2 Double click the deposit that contains the payment you want to edit or delete 3 Select the line containing the payment you want to edit or delete 4 Press dD QuickBooks deletes the payment from the deposit The payment still exists in your QuickBooks records it s just undeposited QuickBooks puts the money back into Undeposited Funds 5 Click OK to record the deposit without the payment you ve just deleted 6 Edit or delete the original payment transaction Entering credit card fees when making a deposit Say your customer has paid you 1000 using a credit card but your bank statement shows the deposit as 960 because the credit card company charged a fee of 40 How do you make the deposit in QuickBooks so that it calculates the difference 1 When you re making a deposit Banking gt Make Deposit be sure to select only credit card payments to deposit 2 On the Make Deposits window enter the total deposit as shown on your bank statement QuickBooks then calculates the difference between what you charged your customer and what was actually deposited This should equal the amount of credit card fees 3 Select an account for the credit card fees 4 Optional Enter a memo for the fees 5 Click OK Questions you may have process credit cards outside of QuickBooks Can still do this Yes You must set up your P
239. il Address column next to the name and enter the email address You will be asked if you want to use this email address once or if you want to save it in the customer or vendor list Adding a Note to the Emails You can add a note to the emails you send from QuickBooks such as a custom message to a customer or vendor On the Select Forms to Email window click Save as Drafts to Send Later The email messages with the sale forms attachments are saved to the Drafts folder of your email program From there you can access each email message add text to it and then send Troubleshooting email If you re having trouble with the email features of QuickBooks try the tips in this checklist QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 253 Is your email program supported by QuickBooks QuickBooks supports Apple Mail Microsoft Entourage 2008 or Outlook 2011 for Mac e Did you set up an email account Your email program must be installed and an email account created before you can send email through QuickBooks Check the Help for your email program for instructions on setting up your email account If you have more than one email account QuickBooks uses the default account e Are you connected to the Internet Be sure you re connected to the Internet before trying to send email Did you change email programs If you ve changed email programs be sure the one you are using is Apple Mail Microsoft Entourage 2008 or Outlook 2011 fo
240. imates credit memos statements and purchase orders by applying a template to them Open the form then choose a template from the Template pop up menu at the top of the form Clover green b lil New Template L Custa e aT ELGEN _ Things to know e QuickBooks provides several standard templates And if those templates don t work for you keep reading e You can customize a template Select the template in the Template menu and click Customize Layout Designer will open and you can use it to choose the information you want to see on the form or change the form s format You can t change the standard templates but you can customize them and save them under a different name e You can also create a new template from scratch From the Template menu select New Template Layout Designer opens and you can design to your heart s content QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 241 Choosing what goes on a template In Layout Designer use the Fields window to choose what information you want displayed on the form You can choose to show fields only on the screen in QuickBooks on the printed form or both You can also use Layout Designer to customize the look of your invoices sales receipts estimates credit memos statements and purchase orders Tip You can also change the format of the form such as adding a logo or changing the font Using Layout Designer to choose what goes on your forms Pick t
241. in the Qty field 5 Optional Edit the description that QuickBooks filled in the Description field The description that QuickBooks fills in is the sales description you entered when you set up the item It also appears on the customer s statement when you print it QuickBooks uses only the first line of the description If you want a different description to appear on the statement edit the text in the Description field 6 If you have more than one A R account choose the account you want to use from the Account list Using the A R register instead You can enter all your statement charges directly into your accounts receivable register instead of the individual customer registers If you have a few customers or if you like to see all your statement charges listed in one place you may prefer the A R register Each charge you enter in the A R register also appears in the appropriate customer register Creating Statements After you ve entered statement charges you re ready to create your statement 1 Choose Customer gt Create Statements 2 Select an Accounts Receivable A R account for the statements you want to print 3 Optional Select a template to format the statement the way you want If you want to customize the look of you statements such as adding your logo select New Template and use Layout Designer see page 237 4 Select the statement dates o Statement Date The date displayed at the top of the statement o Sta
242. ing o Enter new dates in the From and To fields o Choose one of the preset date ranges from the list To change the accounting basis of the report 1 Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences and click Sales Tax 2 In Sales Tax Accrues select the basis you want o Select As of invoice date to get an accrual basis report o Select Upon receipt of payment to get a cash basis report If you use a group tax QuickBooks calculates each tax in the group individually and then adds the individual taxes together to get the total tax Because QuickBooks rounds the individual tax amounts to the nearest cent the total for tax group may be slightly different than the total you would get if you combined the rates of the individual taxes and applied the single rate to the sale Don t worry about this discrepancy QuickBooks calculates and reports each individual tax amount correctly QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 219 Using the Sales Tax Payable register Each time you write an invoice or sales receipt that includes sales tax QuickBooks enters the information in your Sales Tax Payable register No matter how many tax agencies QuickBooks tax vendors you must collect for QuickBooks keeps track of transactions for all tax vendors in the same Sales Tax Payable account To display the Sales Tax Payable register 1 Choose Lists gt Chart of Accounts 2 Double click your Sales Tax Payable account o Each entry in the register is a single ta
243. ing menu choose one of the following o Write Checks If you wrote a check or paid with cash o Enter Credit Card Charges If you paid by credit card 2 Fill in the check or credit card form in the top part of the window 3 Click the Items tab Did you write a purchase order for the items o Yes Click Select PO and select the POs that contain the items you re receiving When you re finished click OK If you didn t receive all the items on the purchase order you can edit the quantity or cost of any item or delete an item completely from the detail area of the check or credit card window Tip If you make a mistake when you are editing the quantities click Receive All to return all quantities to their original values o No Enter the items in the detail area From the Item list choose the first item you are being billed for You can also type the item name directly into the Item column If the item is not on your list QuickBooks asks you to set it up In the Qty column enter the quantity you received If necessary edit the cost of the item Repeat these steps for the other items you received 4 Optional Enter any additional expenses such as sales tax Click Expenses For each expense enter the amount and relevant expense account in the detail area of the Expenses tab 5 Save the check of credit card charge Receiving items and getting a bill later When you receive items and get the bill later you enter information in two
244. int are highlighted in blue Click Select All to print all the checks listed or Select None to print none of them To select only some of the checks click Select None then hold down the Command key while you select the checks you want to print Or Select All and hold down the Command key and deselect the checks you don t want to print QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 249 4 Click Print A Print window appears with options that will be familiar to you if you ve printed from other Mac software Make any adjustments you want 5 Optional On the Print window choose QuickBooks from the print options pop up menu and set the Options Format Logo or Alignment settings 6 Click Print 7 On the confirmation box click OK if the check printed correctly If it didn t select the checks you want to print again and click OK If you need to change a check number click the number and enter the new one Printing everything else Print labels 1 Choose File gt Print Forms gt Labels Note You can also print labels from the Print Forms window see Print a group of sales forms above by clicking Print Labels If you print labels from this window you must print the labels before you print the forms 2 Choose who you want to print labels for o Names Print labels for specific names If you choose Selected Names click Select and select the names o Customer Types or Vendor Types Print labels for a specific type of customer or
245. invoices and sales forms leave the rate or price of the parent item at zero You ll still have to assign an account to the item however QuickBooks requires an account even if you don t plan to sell the item 2 For the subitem add a new item or edit an existing one 3 Select the Subitem of checkbox and choose the name of the parent item 4 Be sure the Type of the subitem is the same as the parent item 5 Click OK QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 77 CHAPTER 5 Getting paid Getting paid is what being in business is all about right In this chapter l II show you how to manage your customer information and track the transactions related to getting paid Customer Center The Customer Center is where you find information about all of your customers and jobs and their associated transactions in one place In QuickBooks a customer is anyone who pays you for goods or services A job is a specific project or scope of work that you want to track You can watch a video on the Customer Center on Little Square http www qpblittlesquare com 2011 01 video overview of the customer center utc_source iph Here you can quickly find customer contact information what your customers bought in the past what invoices they ve paid the balance they owe notes you want to keep about them and more You can also quickly access transactions such as sales receipts received payments and statement charges In the default vi
246. irst name Company name Company name Work email Email Work phone Phone Mobile phone or Home phone Alternate phone whichever one appears first in the Address Book contact Work address Address To add a contact from Address Book In QuickBooks if it is not already on turn on Contact Sync Company gt Contact Sync Settings QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 87 1 In QuickBooks open the list or center where you want to add the contact For example if you want to add a contact as a customer open the Customer Center 2 Open Address Book and select the contact s you want to add to a list 3 In Address Books drag and drop the selected contacts to the list in QuickBooks As you drag the contact to the list you ll see card icon with a green plus If Contact Sync is on the contact is automatically synced with Address Book Note If you are adding a name to the Employees list that already exists the green plus does not appear and QuickBooks does not add the duplicate name Setting up jobs If you re a service provider and if you re Customer job S Balance Total Notes Job Status w Cook Brian 9 397 33 E fortunate enough to win multiple projects 2nd story addition 5 418 00 In progress from the same client Jobs are an excellent akc abil wil shea way to track different projects you do for the same customer For example say you re a video producer and you have a project to produce a video series for a c
247. it card information for the customer If you are using Intuit Merchant Account Service to charge customer credit cards you can click Charge Info to see the credit card information of this customer you selected Print email add to iCal or Calendar You can mark the sales receipt as to be printed or emailed later Then choose File gt Print forms or File gt Email forms You can also add a reminder to iCal or Calendar 63 amp Receiving payments If you ve sent a customer an invoice and then they pay you receive the payment Customers gt Receive Payments The invoice is your customer s record of sale so you don t need to give them a sales receipt When a customer pays an invoice or a statement you ve sent them record the payment in QuickBooks with Customers gt Receive Payments gt Watch a video on how to receive a payment http www qblittlesquare com 2011 10 3731 Tip There are times when a customer pays when you shouldn t use Receive Payments such as when the customer pays in full at the time of the sale Enter a sales receipt instead Or when you receive a partial payment at the time you write an invoice enter a payment item on the invoice To receive a payment 1 Choose Customers gt Receive Payments Note You can also receive payments using the Customer Center and Transaction Center QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 115 2 To receive a new payment click the Create an Payment on the lef
248. itive information such as all reports memorized transactions Chart of Accounts lists and inventory adjustments Access all time tracking features If you re setting up more than one user here are a couple of important things to think about e Tell QuickBooks which accounts you use for payroll Payroll information is very sensitive Click Set Payroll Accounts to select the accounts that you are using for payroll transactions Only users with access to Payroll will be able to see transactions in these accounts Set a closing date so new users can t edit transactions on or before that date Consider doing this if you ve been using QuickBooks and want to make sure new users you create can t change anything you ve done in the past QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 296 1 Click the Attached Documents Library menu and choose Select Existing Attachments Guide Me __JOFF QuickBooks uses an attached documents library to store copies of all your attached files associated with this company file To use the attachment feature you must create a new library or select an existing library Attached Documents Library Attachments Library Sample xj Create New E Select Existing a eee Optical Character Recognition OCR allows you to search text within attached image files M Enable OCR scanning when attaching image files 2 Navigate to the Attached Documents Library folder you restored in Step 3 and
249. iven time When your inventory reaches this level QuickBooks informs you that it is time to reorder the item Adds additional information about the invoice item These keywords can QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 266 CUSTFLD1 CUSTFLD2 CUSTFLD5 appear in the EXTRA field AUTOSTAX lIdentifies a sales tax item as the automatic tax rate you set up for your QuickBooks company REXPGROUP Indicates that the item is a group of reimbursable expenses that you included on the invoice REXPSUBTOT Indicates that the item is the subtotal amount for a group of reimbursable expenses you included on the invoice Custom fields let you track information about the item such as color unit or measure or size Customer Message list INVMEMO Import and export files can contain the list of customer messages you use in QuickBooks The keyword for the Customer Message list is INVMEMO NAME TIMESTAMP REFNUM Required The text of the customer message Export files only A unique number that identifies the company file from which you exported the Customer Message list Export files only A unique number that identifies an entry in the list Other Names list OQTHERNAME Import and export files can contain all the information in your Other Names list The keyword for the Other Names list is OTHERNAME NAME TIMESTAMP REFNUM BADDR1 5 PHONE1 PHONE2 FAXNUM CONT1 NOTEPAD SALUTATION COMPANYNAME Required A name
250. job from the Customer Jobs list QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 99 Click Add gt gt The customer or job shows up in the Group Members list Keep adding customers and jobs until you ve got all the customers you want in this group Tip Press Command A to choose all the customers and jobs at once Use Shift click and Command click to choose more than one customer at once Click OK to save the group and close the New Group window You can add notes to your group info about who s in this group what kind of work you do for this group and any other detailed info you d like to keep about this group To add notes to your group 10 Click the Notes tab up at the top of the New Group window 11 Click your cursor into the big field Add away Sales Batch invoicing With batch invoicing you can save tons of time by filling out one invoice then sending it toa whole group of customers This works well if you sell the same products or services to lots of customers at about the same time Say you ve got a pool cleaning business 15 of your customers have pools that are about the same size and you provide the same cleaning and maintenance services for these customers each month Using batch invoicing you can add all these customers to a group fill out the invoice form only once and then send it to all the customers in the group To create batch invoices for a group of customers 1 2 3 4 Go to Customers
251. k Address Details to make sure each individual address field is filled in correctly QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 82 especially if you are using Contact Sync The address information you enter can be exported for mail merge If you use mail merge be sure to include in the last line of the address the two letter state abbreviation and the zip code This ensures that the address will print correctly in mail merge documents o Ship To If the customer has a separate shipping address enter the address as you d like it to appear on printed invoices and other forms If the shipping address is the same as the billing address click Copy to copy the billing address to the Ship To field Click Address Details to make sure each individual address field is filled in correctly especially if you are using Contact Sync What are Address Details This window shows how the multi line Address field displayed on the Add Edit Customer Vendor Employee or Other Name window is separated into the individual address fields Note We strongly recommend keeping the Show this window again checkbox selected so that QuickBooks can automatically alert you when it detects possible address field entry errors Note The information in shaded fields is synchronized with Mac OS X Contacts and other applications that use Sync Services Additional Info pane On the Additional Info pane enter more information about the Customer such as a category for t
252. k the gold Open Invoices bar QuickBooks shows you a list of all your company s open invoices complete with details From there you can open individual transactions to double check them or change them if you need to Company snapshot Use the Company Snapshot to get real time company information and perform tasks in one place Here you can quickly see trends in your income and expenses who owes you money who you owe money reminders of things to do and the balances in your accounts You can also quickly access transactions for all your customers such as sales receipts received payments and statement charges QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 222 RockCastle Construction Home Page Income Tracker UNBILLED Es 62 947 Account Balance i Income And Expense Trends UNBILLED TIME amp COSTS 31 168 Balance Savings Petty Cash Accounts Receivable Undeposited Funds Inventory Asset Employee Advances Pre paid Insurance Retainage Receivable Furniture and Equipment Vehicles Buildings and Improvements Construction Equipment Land 46 969 10 17 910 19 500 00 93 007 93 2 440 00 28 991 23 832 00 4 050 00 3 703 02 34 326 00 78 936 91 325 000 00 15 300 00 90 000 00 Chart of Accounts UNPAID OPEN INVOICES 93 008 View This Year E Labor Income E Materials Income E Subcontracted Labor Income E Other Total 452 754 20 QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide
253. lances owed by customers Past due items are in red Double click a line item to open the Customer Center and see transactions for that customer Click Receive Payments to open the Receive Payments window The total amount owed is displayed at the bottom Click on the total to see a Customer Balance Summary report e Vendors to Pay Shows balances you owe to vendors Past due items are noted in red Double click a line item to open the Enter Bills window for that bill Click Pay Bills to open the Enter Bills window for all bills The total amount you owe is displayed at the bottom Click on the total to see a Vendor Balance Summary report e Reminders Lists reminders grouped by category based on your Reminder preferences Past due reminders are in red Click the arrow next to a category name to see the reminders in that category Click an item to open the transaction or note for that reminder Click Preferences beneath the list to change your Reminder settings Tips and tricks Accoun AA scum aie Construction Income Design Income Here are some more tips and tricks so you can Construction Income Equipment Rental Income Construction Income Labor Income make the best use of the Com pany Snapshot Construction Income Less Discounts given Construction Income Materials Income i Construction Income Subcontracted Labor Income e Sort any column by clicking the column title Interest Income Other Income Rearrange the columns by clicki
254. lect a report from the left bar The report you select displays in the center Search for a report Enter one or more words in the Search box in the top right corner of the Report Center QuickBooks finds all reports with those words in the report title or description and lists then in the left pane To see all your reports again click the X in the Search box Browse available reports The left pane of the Report Center lists all your reports in groups that you can browse You can also click the arrows at the bottom of the right side of the center to browse through your reports When you find the one you want double click it to open it or click Display at the bottom of the center e Change the report date range Use the date controls at the bottom of the Report Center to change the date range and then double click the report to open it with the new dates e Add reports to your favorites In the left pane of the Report Center select the name of a report and click the star located to the left of the title The report now displays in the Favorite Reports list at the top of the pane so you can easily find it e Customize a report Choose a report and click Customize at the bottom of the Report Center You can then change the information covered in the report e Print a report Select a report and click Print at the bottom of the Report Center Or open the report and choose File gt Print Report or Command P To fit the entire report on one
255. les appear Find and select the attachment remember that s any kind of file you want to attach Click Open QuickBooks attaches the file you chose to the record or transaction A box with the document s name date thumbnail and keywords appears in the Attachments window Your file probably doesn t have any search keywords associated with it Add some in the Keywords box so you can find this file later if you re searching for it Tip Use commas or spaces to separate the keywords You can t create multi word key phrases Close the Attachments window by clicking anywhere outside of it Yes really That s it you ve attached a file to your transaction or record Important QuickBooks doesn t move your files from their original folder Instead it makes a copy of the attached file and puts it into the Attached Documents Library you chose in the Attachments Preferences see page 276 To remove an attachment from the Attachments Center 1 2 5 6 Open the record or transaction you want to remove the attachment from Open the transaction or record for example the invoice or the customer you want to remove an attachment from Click 0 at the top right corner of the window The Attachments window appears Choose the attachment you want to remove The attachment s title bar turns blue when it s chosen Click the at the bottom left corner of the Attachments window Click OK if you re sure you want to remove this document
256. like rent then use Enter Bills so that QuickBooks knows about the bill that is due and can give you an accurate look at how much money you actually have To manage your bills Enter your bills When you get your bills enter them so QuickBooks knows about them e Track your bills Accounts payable tracks all your pending bills e Pay your bills Pay your bills by writing a check or with a credit card Then you re done Things to know Enter bills as they come in To get the most benefit from tracking what you owe accounts payable enter bill as soon as you receive them That way your cash flow reports will be up to date and you won t run the risk of setting bills aside and forgetting about them e Check your cash flow reports They show your bills and show you what s coming due e Set up reminders or show the bill in iCal or Calendar Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences gt Reminders to set up reminders to pay your bills The bill will display on the Reminders list Or you can show the bill in iCal or Calendar Entering bills and credits When you receive a bill you should enter it into QuickBooks That way QuickBooks knows about it and can help you track information about how you spend money To enter a bill 1 Choose Vendors gt Enter Bills 2 To enter a new bill click the New on the left panel or click the at the bottom of the list To edit a bill select a bill in the list on the left panel If you don t see t
257. lose and reopen it 4 If you prefer to make time entries one at a time click Single Activity This preference determines which time entry form appears when you click the Timesheet button on the toolbar or the Record Time button on the Employee list QuickBooks provides two forms one for entering the time spent by one person on a single job on a single date the single activity entry form and one for entering the time spent by one person on multiple jobs over longer periods of time the weekly timesheet Which way should you enter time There are two ways to enter time You can enter single activities at the time they occur or you can enter all the hours for each job on weekly timesheets Choose the method that works best for your business Single activity entries A single activity entry shows the time spent by one person doing a single activity for a single job ona single date If you are recording time spent on different jobs you would have to make a separate entry for each job even if the same person performed all the work 80800 Enter Single Activity Status Not Billed Date 12 15 13 m Billable Next Name Elizabeth N Mason Previous Customer Job Bolinski Rafal 2nd story Service Item Installation Timesheet Cancel Duration OK If you prefer to jot down the details of one day s work as the day progresses this method might work best for you For example an attorney could use a single activity entry to re
258. lowing services Direct Connect automatic QuickBooks connects directly with your online account using your financial institution s server Your transactions are downloaded directly into QuickBooks Your financial institution may apply a fee for this service e Web Connect manual You log into your financial institution s website and manually download a QuickBooks compatible file to your computer Then you import the downloaded file into QuickBooks Which service you use depends on what your bank offers QuickBooks guides your through the connection to your online bank account and lets you know what service is available for your account Why use online banking with QuickBooks e Save time You no longer need to manually enter transactions recorded by your bank Reduce errors By importing the transactions instead of entering them manually you reduce the chance of errors Also QuickBooks compares the bank transactions to the ones in your company file and alerts you to discrepancies Types of Accounts You can import transactions from the following types of accounts e Checking e Savings e Money market Credit card e Line of credit Before You Begin e You must have online banking set up with your financial institution before you can access your bank account with QuickBooks Check with your financial institution for information about setting up online access to your account e You must have an Internet connection to
259. ly to handle checks like these o Inthe Pay to the order of field enter the name of the owner or partner QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 91 o Be sure the Print later button is not selected at the bottom of the window o Leave the No field blank o On the Items pane enter each service item for the work performed On each line enter the number of hours in the Qty field and the job in the Customer Jobs field o On the Expenses pane enter the name of the person s equity account in the Account field In the Amount field enter the negative of the total amount on the Items tab Do not enter a job name If you have not yet invoiced the customer Be careful not to invoice the customer twice for the same work When you go to the Choose Billable Time and Costs window you ll see the cost both on the Time tab because you entered the time and made it billable and on the Items tab because you associated the service item with a Customer Jobs when you wrote the zero amount check Mark ONLY the work shown on the Time tab To avoid confusion we recommend that you click in the Hide column to remove the service item entry from the Items tab What you ll see in your reports After you record the zero amount check the cost as shown on the Items tab in the Choose Billable Time and Costs window appears on all job and item reports that show costs by job or item On the other hand the cost does not appear as an expense on a profit and
260. mation about your credit terms with the vendor and how you want to categorize the vendor on your reports e Account Enter any information that you want QuickBooks to print in the Memo field on checks that you send to the vendor For example if you enter your company s account number with the vendor QuickBooks automatically adds the account number to the Memo field on each bill payment check that goes to that vendor You can also enter a short note or message instead of an account number e Type This is a word or phrase that categorizes this vendor for your reports Use vendor types to categorize vendors by the types of products or services they provide A building contractor might use vendor types to keep track of where subcontractors are located for example by county e Terms This field lets you associate a specific set of payment terms with the vendor When you enter a bill from the vendor QuickBooks automatically fills in the payment terms you specified QuickBooks accepts two types of terms o Standard This type specifies 1 the number of days until you earn a discount from the vendor and 2 the number of days until payment is due o Date driven This type specifies 1 the day of the month by which you earn a discount from the vendor and 2 the day of the month by which payment is due QuickBooks uses a shorthand notation to express terms For example 2 10 Net 30 means 2 discount if paid within 10 days net due in
261. me and type of each account in gt 24000 Payroll Liabilities Other Current Liability 5 404 45 your company When you set up View All Accounts your company file QuickBooks Lt LZ Q sets up certain accounts for you automatically As your business grows or changes you can add new accounts to your Chart of Accounts to better organize your finances For example you might want to create expense accounts to track office supply purchases separately from advertising costs The Chart of Accounts lists the name of each account the type of account and the balance If the account shows a blue dot in the last column then online banking is enabled for that account e To open the Chart of Accounts Choose Lists gt Chart of Accounts e To add an account Click at the bottom of the Chart of Accounts and enter information ES the account e To edit an account Select the account name click Edit at the bottom of the Chart of Accounts then change information Z Jthe account e To open the register for an account Double click the name of an account to open the register Or click Open Register at the bottom of the Chart of Accounts e To show only active or inactive accounts Use the View menu at the bottom of the Chart of Accounts to change the view to show only Active Accounts or Inactive Accounts To make an account active or inactive edit the account and check or uncheck Inactive Or Control click the account name and choos
262. me you want hold down the Shift key and then select the last name in the range QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 86 e Command click to select a group of nonadjacent names Select a name hold down the Command key and then select each additional name The Contact Sync icon appears next to the names that are now synced with Address Book Managing syncing e To turn off Contact Sync choose Company gt Contact Sync Settings Then uncheck Use Contact Sync and click Apply All contacts remain in both QuickBooks and Address Book but are no longer synced e To turn off syncing for a specific contact Control click the contact name in a list and select Unsync with Address Book Or edit the name and uncheck Sync at the bottom of the Edit window The contact remains in both QuickBooks and Address Book but is no longer synced All other contacts with the Contact Sync icon are still synced Adding a contact from Address Book You can add a contact from Apple s Address Book to any contact list in QuickBooks by dragging and dropping the name from Address Book to the list Q Watch Contact Sync in action http www qblittlesquare com 2011 03 address book and quickbooks syncing your contacts What information is added from Address Book You may have more information for the contact in Address Book than QuickBooks needs Here the contact information that is added to QuickBooks Last name Last name First name F
263. mer ID and password you use to access your online account then click Sign In 2 For each account at your financial institution click Select an Account to display a list of available QuickBooks Accounts Choose which QuickBooks account you want to associate with the online account 3 Only the QuickBooks accounts applicable to the online banking account type are displayed in the Select an Account list You can only associate a QuickBooks account with one online banking account To open a new QuickBooks account click New from QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 179 the Select an Account list or create a bank credit card or Other Current Liability account first Click Next to download your transactions After QuickBooks has successfully downloaded your transactions click Finish The Downloaded Transactions window displays the transactions downloaded from your online banking accounts You have completed setting up Direct Connect and can now update your register Skip any remaining steps I m asked to select an account type 1 2 Select the account type for the account you want to download Enter in the account number If this is a banking account enter in the routing number Click Select an Account to display a list of available QuickBooks Accounts Choose which QuickBooks account you want to associate with the online account Only the QuickBooks accounts applicable to the online banking account ty
264. mistakes too If this is the case let QuickBooks make an adjustment transaction as described in the previous section then contact your bank The bank will make an adjustment that appears on your next statement Because a QuickBooks adjustment appears as a cleared item in the check register your account will be off by the same amount at the end of the next reconciliation Delete the QuickBooks balance adjustment transaction when you reconcile the next statement Or just let QuickBooks enter another adjustment that effectively reverses the first adjustment This guarantees a clean paper trail that reflects what actually happened Viewing and printing previous reconciliation reports QuickBooks for Mac 2014 saves the reports every time you reconcile one of your accounts Any time you need to check a reconciliation you can create a report to see it Tip When you view a previous reconciliation report we recommend that you use a PDF Reader to get the most out of this experience For previous reconciliations you ve done in QuickBooks for Mac 2014 you can use our Previous Reconciliation report function to look at these reports and print them out But if you re looking for a reconciliation you did in any other version of QuickBooks we can t show you that report We re sorry about that To see a previous reconciliation report 1 Goto Reports gt Banking gt Previous Reconciliation 2 Choose the account you want to see the reconciliation for
265. mpany s federals taxes 4 Next you ll see the Choose your industry and chart of accounts window Select the type of business that comes closest to describing your company QuickBooks creates all the accounts that have a check mark This is our best guess for the accounts we think you ll need based on the type of industry you re in You can make changes if you like If you make changes and want to go back to QuickBooks suggested accounts click Default Expert Settings You may need to set some non standard options while creating your company file You ll probably only need these if your accountant has given you specific instructions Click Finish when you re done o Summary Reports Basis In QuickBooks an accrual basis report shows income regardless of whether all your customers have paid up and expenses regardless of whether you have paid all your bills A cash basis report shows income only if you have received it and expenses only if you have paid them You can change this later with Reporting preferences o First month in tax year If your company s tax year starts in a month other than January select that month o First month in fiscal year If your company s fiscal year starts in a month other than January select that month o Customers are charged sales tax Select if you are charging your customers sales tax Then create your sales tax items You can change your sales tax items later on the Items list
266. n Charge column To change the interest rate click Settings and enter the new rate 4 Optional If you plan to print the finance charge invoices to send to customers select the Mark invoices To be printed checkbox If you send statements leave this checkbox cleared QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 124 Using Intuit PaymentNetwork with QuickBooks for Mac It can be pretty easy to get paid and keep payment records when you use Intuit PaymentNetwork with QuickBooks for Mac Step 1 Set up QuickBooks for Mac to work with Intuit PaymentNetwork When you re in Preferences you ll see that Use Intuit PaymentNetwork for all customers is checked by default Keep it checked if you want to give all your customers the option to pay you online via Intuit PaymentNetwork You can always turn the option off for specific invoices Uncheck this box if you want to add links to Intuit PaymentNetwork manually only to certain invoices Step 2 When you create invoices add a link to Intuit PaymentNet work that your customer can click to pay you online e Click F When you save the invoice QuickBooks adds a link so your customer can pay you online If the button is dark Intuit PaymentNetwork is already turned on e Click F again and resave the invoice to remove the Intuit PaymentNetwork link from the invoice Refresh the invoice form A link appears under the Items table That s the link to your Intuit PaymentNetwork account
267. n also open the account register then search for and fix the problem transactions in it But when neither of these methods work or they uncover a tangled mess in your last reconciliation you can choose the brute force method Undo Last Reconciliation QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 192 1 On the Reconcile window click Undo Reconcile A window appears that shows you how far back you re going back to the beginning balance of the most recent reconciliation you ve done on this account 2 Click OK QuickBooks undoes the most recent reconciliation 3 Now you go back and re reconcile the account being careful to look for any errors or changes to transactions so that you end up with the Ending Balance you need If you think the problem is further back than the most recent reconciliation you can undo multiple reconciliations one at a time Follow steps 1 3 above After QuickBooks undoes the most recent reconcile the window reappears Click Undo Last Reconciliation again Lather rinse and repeat until you ve undone reconciliations back to where you need to begin re reconciling Troubleshooting reconciliation So you ve done everything talked about in the previous to reconcile your accounts Everything went right and you re in good shape Yep nothing else to do here Well maybe Reconciling isn t hard but it doesn t always go smoothly So what do you do First off don t panic Then keep reading Note Though some
268. n QuickBooks and how you install it System requirements Before you install QuickBooks be sure your computer meets these requirements Mac OS X v10 7 Lion or v10 8 Mountain Lion At least an Intel processor Core 2 Duo required Minimum 2 GB of RAM 4 GB of RAM recommended Minimum 250 MB of available disk space additional space required for data files CD DVD drive or Internet connection for installation You will also need the product registration to run QuickBooks Integration compatibility requirements What other software do you need Well it depends on what you want to do in QuickBooks QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide If you want to export report data you ll need Apple Numbers 09 or Microsoft Excel 2008 or 2011 for Mac If you want to email forms like invoices and sales receipts from QuickBooks you must have Apple Mail Microsoft Entourage 2008 or Outlook 2011 for Mac QuickBooks has features that use Calendar or iCal Messages or iChat and Contacts or Address Book which are included when you install Mac OS X from Apple Inc I ll show you how to use these features in QuickBooks later on QuickBooks for Mac 2014 supports one way conversion from QuickBooks for Windows 2012 and 2013 QuickBooks for Mac 2014 supports conversion to and from QuickBooks for Windows 2014 Installing and Upgrading QuickBooks Installing and upgrading QuickBooks is super easy To install QuickBooks 1 I
269. n inventory Part QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 155 o Service o Other Charge When you write purchase orders for non inventory items you can still track your open POs to see what you have and have not received Note however that QuickBooks excludes non inventory items from reports that show items on order e Description The description of the item you entered when you created the item You can change this if you need to Tip You can enter multiple lines for your description up to 4095 characters Use Option Return to put in a line break e Quantity How many of the items are you ordering If you leave this blank QuickBooks assumes the quantity is 1 Rate How much does your vendor charge for the item If you entered this when you created the item QuickBooks enters it for you If you didn t or you need to change it just edit this box e Amount This is the total amount Quantity x Rate for this item that QuickBooks calculates for you e Vendor Message A message for your vendor Note You ll see a mark in the Rec d column when you ve told QuickBooks you ve received the items QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 156 When you receive your goods When you receive goods you ordered with the PO you also record that in QuickBooks The transaction you use depends on when you pay for the items Item receipt You ve received the goods but won t get the bill until later Bill You ve received the go
270. n the chart of accounts The account number also appears in Account fields in reports that list the account and on graphs e If you turn off account numbers QuickBooks does not display numbers for accounts However it saves numbers you already entered and displays them if you turn the preference on again Combining two accounts Combine two accounts of the same type into a single account if you want to see those accounts represented by a single line in your reports To combine two accounts 1 Choose Lists gt Chart of Accounts 2 Make sure that the accounts you want to merge are at the same hierarchical level How do move an account Drag and drop the account name to the level on the hierarchy where you want it to be If you make a mistake press Control Z to undo the move 3 Select the account whose name you DON T want to use for the merged account QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 55 4 Choose Edit at the bottom of the Chart of Accounts 5 Change the account name so that it is the same as the account you re merging it with 6 Click OK 7 When prompted to merge the selected accounts click Yes 8 Click Merge Accounts to confirm that you want to merge the two accounts Working with registers Date 12 15 13 12 15 13 12 15 13 12 15 13 12 28 13 12715713 a R _Number Type 10077 Elizabeth N Mason PAY CHK split 10100 Checking _ Payment 932 92 Balance 62 352 34 Gregg O
271. n the list Click the Hide column next to the cost Hiding the cost won t remove its association with the job you ll still see the cost along with other job related expenses on job reports QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 110 Applying a discount to a statement charge Before you can apply a discount to a statement charge you must first create an Other Charge item To apply a discount to a statement charge 1 2 10 Choose Lists gt Items Click the at the bottom of the list za In the Type field of the New Item window choose Other Charge Enter an item name such as Statement Discount You don t have to assign a dollar amount or percent yet Select an account for the item and click OK Open the register for the customer who you want to give a discount On the first blank line select the other charge item you created such as Statement Discount For Amt Chrg enter a negative dollar amount and a description Click Record Go to Receive Payments and select the same customer name you choose in Step 2 The statement discount is shown as an existing credit that can be applied to an invoice now or when receiving payment QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 111 Marking a sale as pending Sometimes you might want to enter an invoice cash sale or a credit memo you can mark the sale as pending Here are some reasons why e Order entry When you receive an order from a customer enter
272. name includes the names of the parent classes beginning with the highest level class If you are creating an import file use a colon to separate subclass names The customer that the budget applies to If you are applying the budget toa specific job for the customer the customer name includes the job name The customer s name comes first then a colon and then the job name Class list CLASS Import and export files can contain the list of classes you use in QuickBooks The keyword for the Class list is CLASS NAME Required The name of the class If the class is a subclass of another class the name includes the name of the parent classes beginning with the highest level class If you are creating an import file use a colon to separate subclass names QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 262 TIMESTAMP REFNUM Export files only A unique number that identifies the company file from which you exported the Class list Export files only A unique number that identifies an entry in the list Customer Type list CTYPE Import and export files can contain the list of customer types you use in QuickBooks The keyword for the Customer Type list is CTYPE NAME TIMESTAMP REFNUM Required The customer type If the customer type is a subtype of another customer type the name includes the name of the parent types beginning with the highest level type If you are creating an import file use a colon to
273. nder the transactions on the right pane to filter the transactions to view Bills filtered by Open in the date range of This Month Tips and tricks Try these tips and tricks to make using Vendor Center even easier e Sort information by clicking the column titles e Rearrange the columns by clicking and dragging the top of a column to move it to another location e Show different columns or hide columns you don t need Right click or Control click on the column headers then select the columns you want to see and unselect the ones you want to hide Select multiple names in one of these ways o Shift click to select a range of names Select the first name you want hold down the Shift key and then select the last name in the range o Command click to select a group of nonadjacent names Select a name hold down the Command key 4 and then select each additional name o Command A to select all names No need to click just press Command A to select the entire list e Control click a name in the left pane to access a shortcut menu to common tasks ity of Bayshore Hel City of Middlefield elp Computer Services GR SENAVET YT fig Conner Garden Supg i Employment Develo New Transaction gt Express Delivery Ser Edit Vendor Great Statewide Ban Use Gussman s Nursery Quick Report Internal Revenue ser Make Vendor s Inactive QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 148 QuickBooks for Mac 2014 U
274. ndor What s ona purchase order e Vendor The vendor you re ordering from If the vendor isn t in this list you can add them in the Vendor Center or through Quick Add here e Class If you are using classes select the class you want to use here If you don t see this list turn Classes on through QuickBooks gt Preferences gt Transactions e Vendor address When you select a vendor from the dropdown menu at the top of the form the address appears here You make any changes you need to If you re adding the vendor through QuickAdd you ll need to manually enter the address e Ship To The address that you want the goods shipped to By default this is your company s address Expected The date you expect the goods to arrive e FOB Indicate to the vendor how you want your order to be shipped FOB refers to free on board Set your preferred FOB on Preferences e Item Select what you are order You can include anything on the Items list here You also enter a new item and QuickBooks will prompt you to set it up Tip If you need to insert an item between two others select the item line where you want the new one and choose Edit gt Insert Line Likewise if you want to delete an item select the item then choose Edit gt Delete Line You can use a purchase order for items you don t stock or even resell When you write a purchase order for non inventory items you can include these types of items on the PO form o No
275. ned to this account QuickBooks subtracts the amount entered from the total amount and displays the remainder on the next free line of the Splits window If you left the transaction amount blank QuickBooks adds the split amount to the transaction amount Optional Enter a note about the split amount in the Memo field Optional Enter the name of a customer or job in the Customer Job field In the column indicate whether the expense is billable to that customer o If the expense is billable do not change the invoice icon next to the customer s name o If itis not click the invoice icon next to the customer s name This marks an X through the icon Clicking again removes the X Optional Enter a class in the Class field The class field appears only when you select the Use Class Tracking checkbox choose QuickBooks gt Preferences and click Transactions Continue to add accounts and amounts and customers jobs or classes if needed until you have added one line for each part of the transaction If the split amounts don t add up As you enter amounts in the Splits window QuickBooks enters the remainder on the next free line Sometimes the total of the QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 58 amounts entered in the Splits window doesn t equal the figure you originally entered in the register This happens when you delete a splits line or change the total amount in the register To balance your transaction cl
276. ng estimate Checking for duplicate numbers slows QuickBooks a bit when you record an estimate If you are unconcerned about duplicate numbers clearing the checkbox lets QuickBooks record estimates faster o want to create progress invoices from estimates Select this option if you want to be able to invoice a customer progressively through a project If you using progress invoicing you may have a situation where an item on one of your invoices has an amount of 0 If you don t want to have these items appear on the invoice select Don t print items that have zero amounts Usual FOB Enter the name of your FOB site if you have one FOB which stands for free on board refers to the site from which you usually ship your invoiced products When you specify an FOB site QuickBooks automatically fills in the FOB field on each sales form where the field appears e Usual shipping method Enter the shipping method to automatically enter in the Ship Via field on each form where the field appears Default markup percentage Set the percentage markup to use to calculate the sales price of items that have both a cost and a sales price You do not need to enter a sign You ll see the effect of the default markup percentage when you create inventory part non inventory part service and other charge items When you enter the item s cost QuickBooks automatically calculates the sales price and enters it in the Sales price field For example
277. ng and Reimbursement Income d h f Reimbursement Income Mileage Income ragging the top or a column to move it to Reimbursement Income Permit Reimbursement Income another location Reimbursement Income Reimbursed Freight amp Delivery e Customize what you see Use the links and pull down lists below a pane on the Company Snapshot to change the information the pane displays QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 225 Reports and graphs So much of QuickBooks is about entering data When you want to know what s going on in your business you need to take a look at how all that data adds up That s where reports come in To create a report 1 Open the Report Center Reports gt Report Center 2 On the left double click the type of report you want to create You can stop here and use the standard report QuickBooks provides If you d like to customize your reports see below Report Center The Report Center is a central location for all your reports QuickBooks provides reports to give you information and comparisons about jobs costs revenues and time You can learn how profitable your jobs were find out how well you estimated the costs and revenues for a job and see at a glance which jobs and projects consumed the most time You can also customize these reports for a specific date range or to add columns and other information To open the Report Center Choose Reports gt Report Center To use Report Center Se
278. ng other bills To pay subcontractors 1 Choose one of the following o Banking gt Write Checks to write a check directly to the subcontractor o Vendors gt Enter Bills to enter a bill from the subcontractor In the top part of the form fill in the name of the subcontractor and the date In the detail area at the bottom of the form click the Items tab In the Item column enter the service item you set up for this type of subcontracted work In the Cost column check the amount QuickBooks filled in If the cost is incorrect for this job change it QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 90 6 Inthe Qty column enter the appropriate quantity For example if the subcontractor charges an hourly rate you would enter the number of hours If the Qty column doesn t apply to this work leave it blank 7 Inthe Customer Jobs column enter the name of the job or customer for which the work was done Important Entering the name here gives you the ability to invoice the customer for the work later Also you ll be able to create reports that show your costs and revenue from the work Tracking services performed by an owner or partner Because owners and partners do not submit bills the costs of the services they perform will not be part of the overall costs of the job unless you enter a transaction to account for the work If you want owner or partner time to contribute to the job costs on reports such as job profitability or
279. ng the actual amount you spent for each income and expense account and the difference between your budgeted and actual amounts o Profit amp Loss Budget by Job Overview Shows total budgeted amounts by customer and by job for each income and expense account for which you have entered a budget for a job QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 245 o Profit amp Loss Budget vs Actual by Job Shows total budgeted amounts by customer and by job for each income and expense account for which you have entered a budget for a job including the actual amount you spent on each job and the difference between your budgeted and actual amounts o Balance Sheet Budget Overview Shows monthly budget amounts for each balance sheet account for which you have entered a budget amount o Balance Sheet Budget vs Actual Shows monthly budget amounts for each balance sheet account for which you have entered a budget amount including the actual account balances as of the last day of the month and the difference between your budgeted and actual account balances Some tips to see how you re doing against a budget If you set up budget items for Income and expense accounts only Customer or job only Class only Customer or job and accounts Customer or job and class Class and accounts QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide Do this Use the Profit amp Loss Budget vs Actual report Click Filters on the report buttonbar to limit th
280. ngs with your reports that can help you get the most out of them Memorize a customized report Whenever you change the settings for a report modify it you can memorize the report with the new Settings and save it in the Memorized Report List Then when you want to create a similar report you go to the Memorized Report List to find it After you have customized a report click Memorize at the top of the report To open a memorized report click Reports gt Memorized Reports If you have recalled a memorized report and changed it indicate whether you want QuickBooks to replace the earlier report under the same name or create a new memorized report under a new name Note When you display a memorized report it applies the settings you memorized not the data from the previously generated report For example if the report is set to cover last month and you memorize the report in September then regenerate it in December the new report will contain data for November rather than August Export a report to Microsoft Excel or Numbers You can export your report in a format that you can view in Microsoft Excel 2008 Excel 2011 and Apple Numbers 2009 XLSX or in Microsoft Excel 2004 SYLK To export a report to Microsoft Excel or Numbers 1 Display the report you want to export 2 Click Export QuickBooks opens a copy of report in Excel or Numbers depending on your setting in QuickBooks gt Preferences gt Reporting preservin
281. nsert the CD into your computer s CD drive or open the downloaded dmg file A window will open showing a QuickBooks icon and an Applications folder icon Drag and drop the QuickBooks 2014 icon onto the Applications folder icon Go to the Applications folder on your hard drive and double click the QuickBooks 2014 icon To upgrade QuickBooks 1 If you re upgrading from a previous version of QuickBooks for Mac you ve got a few more steps to get up and going Make a backup copy of your company file using the previous version of QuickBooks for Mac File gt Back Up Quit any previous versions of QuickBooks that are running Start QuickBooks for Mac 2014 Choose File gt Open Company select your file and then click Open Note QuickBooks for Mac 2014 may automatically upgrade and open your last used company file QuickBooks 2014 upgrades your file and adds a qb2014 file extension For example MyCompany qb2014 QuickBooks also saves your original file and renames it to show it is an older file for example MyCompany QB2013 qb2013 if it was originally a QuickBooks 2013 file Converting your file from QuickBooks for Windows If you re switching from QuickBooks for Windows you ll have to go through a couple of more steps to convert your file for QuickBooks for Mac Go to page 23 to find out everything you need to know QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide What s New in 2014 Welcome to QuickBooks f
282. nt Service for QuickBooks for Mac To get the card swipe rate you cannot edit any of the card information after the swipe To find out more go to http pointofsale intuit com barcode inventory software 1 Enter the card number expiration date name on the card optional CSC Card Security Code code and cardholder s zip code The CSC code is the three digit number on the back of the card and is only required for a credit card You can verify how the card information is entered by the message Keyed or Swiped under the credit card symbol next to the number 2 Optional If you re processing the card from the Enter Sales Receipt or Receive Payments window click Optional for additional security features 3 Click Process 4 On the Payment Approved window you can print or email the sales receipt You can also void the payment Double clicking on the transaction ID takes you to your online Merchant Service account where you can review more details of the transaction Voiding a credit card transaction We all make mistakes And if you make one with a credit card transaction you can void it When you void a transaction it s like it never happened To void a credit card transaction e When you re processing a customer s card there s a Void Payment button at the bottom of the confirmation window for the charge Click it to void the transaction you just processed e You can also edit the customer and find the transaction you want
283. nt to deposit customer payments o Group with other undeposited funds Holds the payment in your Undeposited Funds account To deposit the payment choose Banking gt Make Deposits and select the payment When you record the deposit QuickBooks transfers the payment amount from Undeposited Funds to your QuickBooks bank account o Deposit to Click Deposit to and enter the name of the bank account where you would like QuickBooks to deposit the payment 6 Optional Change how QuickBooks applies the payment QuickBooks normally applies the payment to the oldest invoice first then the next oldest and so on To distribute the amount of the payment differently o Click Clear Payments In the column click each invoice to which you want to apply the payment o When you see the QuickZoom symbol gt in the Outstanding Invoices Statement Charges area double click an item to display more detail QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 116 Each time you select an invoice QuickBooks automatically inserts the amount to be applied to the invoice in the Payment column When the undistributed amount of the customer s payment is greater than the amount due QuickBooks pays the invoice in full When the undistributed amount is less than amount due QuickBooks applies the entire amount to the invoice leaving a balance due on the invoice 7 Optional Enter a note about the transaction here Your note will appear on reports that include this
284. nto sections Make each section correspond to one phase Enter a subtotal item after items for each phase e When you turn the estimate into a progress invoice for one phase it will be easy to invoice 100 or another percentage of the items for that phase alone Modifying your progress invoice When you use progress invoicing you can modify the amounts that are on each invoice on the Specify Invoice Amounts window At a minimum the Specify Invoice Amounts window contains this information o Item The item s copied from the estimate when you created the invoice o Est Amt The amount of the item you entered on the estimate o Prior Amt The amount you ve previously invoiced your customer for If this is the first invoice you ve sent the customer for this job this amount will be 0 QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 98 o Amount The amount you are invoicing the customer for on this invoice o Tax The tax that is applicable for the item If you select Show Quantity and Rate you ll see these additional columns o Est Qty The quantity of the item you entered on the estimate o Est Rate The rate you entered on the estimate o Prior Qty The quantity that appeared on prior invoices for the original estimate o Prior Amt The amount that appeared on prior invoices for the original estimate o Qty The quantity you re invoicing your customer for on this invoice o Rate The rate you re invoicing your customer for on this inv
285. nts To show only the checking transactions that contributed to your company s profit use the Source Account field to select QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 228 the checking accounts Important the Source list also shows all of your income and expense accounts Ignore these accounts when you select the balance sheet accounts If you also want to restrict the report to specific income and expense accounts use the Account list to select those accounts e To Be Printed Restrict transactions based on whether they have been printed or not e Transaction Type Choose the type of transactions checks payments and so on you want included in this report e Vendor Type Limit your report to transactions related to one of your vendor types Grouping and subtotaling data e Choose column headings for subtotals Some reports let you subtotal amounts in columns for time periods or other factors For example you can show weekly subtotals on the Profit and Loss Detail report 1 Create the report 2 On the report buttonbar click Options 3 Choose an item from the Columns list Make sure the dates and other options on the Options window are correct 4 Click OK The column appears on the left side of the P amp L Detail report e Choose row headings for groups If none of the preset reports have the row headings you want create a custom report 1 Choose Reports gt Custom Summary Report 2 On the report buttonbar click Options
286. nts e Customer list QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 24 Vendor list notes will not be converted Item list Payment terms list Shipping via list Customer type list Vendor type list Employee list notes will not be converted To do list alerts will not be converted Other names list without notes Job types list Payment method list Customer message list Classes Reminders alerts will not be converted Links between pay items and other items QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide Custom field definitions Transactions and their links Invoices Bills Deposits Payments Transfers Memorized transactions Multiple estimates per job All list reports History of QuickBooks versions used with the data file Transaction statistics 1099 categories Notes Audit trail Preferences Company name and address 25 Data that ISN T converted from Windows to Mac Important QuickBooks for Mac 2014 does not support multiple currencies Because accounts and balances are affected by the multiple and home currency settings these settings cannot be changed in QuickBooks for Windows once they ve been set If you have used multiple currencies in your Windows company file you will not be able to convert your data for use in QuickBooks for Mac Some features and data will NOT be converted from Windows to Mac including but not necessarily limited to the following Intuit integrated payroll and payroll
287. nts you give to customers When you ve applied payment to the wrong invoice If you apply a payment to the wrong invoice you can correct the error by editing the payment transaction To correct the application of a payment 1 Open the accounts receivable register 2 Double click the payment transaction you want to change QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 122 3 Correct the error in the Receive Payments window Setting up for finance charges If you ve set up payment terms for your customers QuickBooks can assess finance charges for any customers whose payments are late To set up for finance charges 1 Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences and then click Finance Charges 2 Enter your finance charge information annual interest rate minimum finance charge grace period o Annual interest rate This is the interest rate QuickBooks will use to calculate finance charges QuickBooks assumes the rate is a percentage For example you would type 12 5 if your rate is 12 5 o Minimum finance charge To apply a minimum finance charge regardless of the amount overdue enter it here o Grace period days To allow a grace period before finance charges apply enter the length of the grace period in days This delays the application of finance charges For example if the starting date is June 1st and the grace period is 3 days QuickBooks waits until June 4th to assess finance charges 3 Optional Enter a finance charge title
288. ny file s start date and today Enter these transactions in this order and be sure you enter the correct date You can enter all these transactions from the Home page e Purchase orders If you use them enter your purchase orders first You ll use these PO transactions when you enter bills e Bills For all the bills you ve received enter the information about each bill Be sure to assign amounts to the correct expense accounts or track the quantities and costs of items received If you need details about doing this check the Help e Inventory item receipts If you received items you ve ordered but didn t get a bill for them choose Receive Inventory and enter an item receipt e Credits from vendors If you have a credit from a vendor choose Enter Bills and select Credit at the top of the windows e Payments For payments you ve made choose Pay Bills Be sure the Payment Date field shows the actual day you made the payment Also check that you select the correct bank account for the payment That s it for entering your vendor transactions Next we ll talk about entering transactions related to your customers QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 17 Entering customer transactions Customer transactions you need to enter are e Estimates e Invoices e Sales receipts Refunds and credit memos e Payments received Gather the information you ll need Depending on the type of business you have you
289. o help you with a project The Vendor Center gives you access to information about all of your vendors and your transactions in one place Here you can quickly find vendor contact information what you ve bought in the past what bills you ve paid the balance you owe notes you want to keep about a vendor and more You can also quickly access transactions such as bills payments and purchase orders In the default view of your Vendor Center the Vendor list is displayed on the left side of the Center and the detail information and transactions list for the selected vendor are displayed on the right Use the views and icons at the bottom of the Vendor Center to manage your vendor information Note You can click Expand to expand the Vendor list to the full Vendor Center E QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 146 Vendor Center Vendor Information Edit Vendor Edit Notes Balance Total 0 00 V Bruce s Office Machines Bruce Anderson 0 00 Equipment 650 555 8923 Bayshore CalOil Service 0 00 Bruce s Office Machines 650 555 0982 Bayshore Water 0 00 Bruce s Office Machines x 650 555 0293 y 3 Bruce Anderson r banderson myemail com Bruce s Office Machines 0o00 P O Box 23884 i C U Electric 750 00 Millbrae CA 94030 Cal Gas amp Electric 122 68 ns Net 15 Cal Telephone 91 94 nee toe CalOil Company 0 00 a City of Bayshore 0 00 City of East Bayshore 0 29 City of Middlefield 0 00 Custom Kitchens of 0 00 5 Daigle
290. o specific accounts e Aging Include only those invoices and bills that are past due by a specific number of days Click lt to specify invoices and bills that are past due beyond a specific number of days Click gt to specify invoices and bills that are past due up to a specific number of days e Amount Restrict transactions based on a particular amount Click the lt or gt button and type an amount in the field For example to see a report that shows customers who have purchased more than 500 00 worth of items from you click the gt button and type 500 in the field e Class Restrict transactions to particular classes choose the classes you want to include from the list You can choose Selected classes to select multiple classes for inclusion e Cleared Choose transactions for the report based on whether you have marked them as cleared or not e Customer Type Limit the report to transactions related to one of your customer types QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 227 Date Restrict the transactions to those with a date that falls within your specified date range Choose an item from the list or type a beginning date and an ending date Pre set dates e Detail Level Limit the report to selected detail lines in a transaction for example the line items on an invoice or the expense account detail on a check When you create a transaction report you can use this filter to show or suppress the detail lines fo
291. o you if you ve printed from other Mac software Make any adjustments you want Click Print Check your printouts If everything looks good click OK on the confirmation window If not select the checkbox next to the forms you want to reprint and click OK Tip You can also save or email a form as a PDF file making it easy to keep records and share with others Printing checks Tip When you click Print on the Print window choose QuickBooks from the print options pop up menu and click Logo Drag or past your logo in the white box and select Print company logo Print one check 1 Find and open the check you want to print If you need help try the Transaction Center On the check window press Command P or click Print at the top of the window A Print window appears with options that will be familiar to you if you ve printed from other Mac software Click Print Optional On the Print window choose QuickBooks from the print options pop up menu and set the Options Format Logo or Alignment settings Click Print On the confirmation box click Yes if the check printed correctly If it didn t click No and try printing the check again Printing a group of checks 1 For each check you want to print select the Print later button at the bottom of the Si es 8 window When you re ready to print choose File gt Print Forms gt Checks Select the checks you want to print Checks that will pr
292. ods and the bill at the same time e Check or credit card charge You ve received the goods and paid for them at the same time Other things to know about POs e View history for the purchase order Click history to see the history for this invoice e Print email add to iCal Calendar You can mark the PO to be printed or emailed later Then choose File gt Print forms or File gt Email forms c2 Cz 5 You can also add a reminder to iCal Calendar that the items on the PO are due to arrive e Close the purchase order When you receive all the items on the purchase order QuickBooks marks the PO as Received in Full If you do not expect to receive all the L items you ordered you can close part or all of the PO manually so that QuickBooks doesn t show the items as on order anymore When you close a PO manually QuickBooks marks the PO as Closed QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 157 Paying your bills Bills are what vendors send you so that you ll pay them You get bills for things like equipment supplies products or services Here s a common question we get here at QuickBooks for Mac Central When do I use Enter Bills and when do I use Write Checks In a nutshell you don t have to enter your bills If you pay your bills as soon as they arrive you don t need to use Enter Bills Just use Write Checks to pay the bill But if you wait until the bill is due to pay it or if you want to track recurring bills
293. oice If you select Show Percentage you ll see these additional columns o Prior The percentage of the original estimate you included on prior invoices o Curr The percentage you are currently invoicing your customer for with this invoice o Tot The total percentage of the original estimate you have invoiced this customer for Invoicing groups of customers Say you ve got a pool cleaning business Fifteen of your customers have pools that are about the same size and you provide the same cleaning and maintenance services for these customers each month Using batch invoicing you can add all these customers to a group fill out the invoice form only once and then send it to all the customers in the group Creating a group for batch invoicing QuickBooks lets you create groups of customers that you can then invoice in batches Tip Create groups of customers you invoice for the same things Say you run a landscaping company and you have two dozen customers you mow the lawn for every week To make billing these customers faster and easier you d create a group named Weekly Mow and add all your weekly lawn mowing customers to that group To create a new group 1 Choose Customer gt Customer Center to open the Customer Center 2 Click the at the bottom left corner of the Customer Center 3 Choose New Group OR Click the New Group button in the Invoices window 4 Give your group a Group Name 5 Choose a customer or a
294. oing to stay in the office Imagine the dirty looks you ll get if you put it on a laptop and then take that laptop ona customer visit when the office manager is trying to work on payroll think we all can agree for the sake of your happy workplace environment this situation should be avoided at all costs e It s best if the computer with the company file is connected to the network through an Ethernet cable and not Wi Fi It ll work fine on Wi Fi but you ll probably have better performance from a cable e Some activities are single user only so it s good idea to put the company file on the computer of the person who will be doing those things That way that person can switch between multi user and single user mode on their own Important Backing up your company file is just as critical in a multi user environment as it is in single user To back up your data stop sharing the company file then back up the file on the computer running QuickBooks server Then you can start sharing the file again Other things to know about multiuser mode There are a few other things to keep in mind when you re using QuickBooks in multiuser mode e You don t have to have QuickBooks running on the server just QuickBooks Server You ll have both QuickBooks and QuickBooks Server installed on the computer you are using as a server But you only have to have QuickBooks Server running to share the company file with others QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User
295. on of the window Then go on to Checks and Payments below 1 Match the first Deposit Credit on your bank statement with the same transaction on the Reconcile window Tip Would it be easier to find and match transactions if the transactions in the Reconcile window were sorted in order by Date Check Number Payee name Memo or Amount Click any of the column headers to sort the transactions Click it again to reverse the sort order 2 If the transaction amount matches with the same transaction on your bank statement check the box next to this transaction to mark it as cleared 3 If the transaction amount doesn t match the transaction amount on your bank statement double click the transaction in the window to open it then correct the transaction 4 Ifyou find a transaction on your bank statement that is not shown in QuickBooks list of uncleared transactions add the transaction now Step 3 Finishing Up the Reconciliation After you ve finished marking transactions you ve got just a few more steps to complete your reconciliation 1 When you ve finished marking the transactions double check the Service Charge Interest Earned and Ending Balance amounts at the bottom of the window to make sure they match the totals of all Service Charges Interest Earned and Ending Balance on your bank statement 2 If they don t click the amount link to open the Begin Reconcile window 3 Make any changes then click OK to return to the Reconcil
296. on on the graph to change the dates for the graph You can enter dates or in some cases choose a predefined date range Tip If you enter a date range much longer than a year the graph may get too cluttered e Pick different criteria Click any button on the graph to group the data in a different way For example the sales graph usually displays sales by item but you can change it to display sales by customer or by rep QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 232 Hiding data in graphs At times you may want to hide the largest pie slice or bar so that you can see the other portions of a graph more clearly e Hide a pie slice or bar Hold down the Shift key while you click the mouse button Redisplay what you ve hidden Recreate the graph Note Hiding is not the same as filtering When you filter data in reports QuickBooks excludes specific amounts from the report When you hide data in graphs QuickBooks still includes the hidden value when it calculates the values in the graph Seeing the small groups of data that may not show up If a pie chart has more than ten data groups for example more than ten customers QuickBooks displays the largest ten first It summarizes the rest of the groups in the eleventh slice of the pie called Other To see the rest of the groups in a pie chart click the Next Group button QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 233 Other things you can do with reports You can do other thi
297. on overdue invoices You can set up reminders that appear on your Company Snapshot or when you click Company gt Reminders Reminder preferences set up how much information to show for each reminder 1 Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences 2 On the Preferences pane select Reminders 3 Set the preferences described below 4 Close the Preferences window For each type of reminder set the preference to show the information you want to see You can view reminders on the Reminders list or on the Company Snapshot e Show summary Put in the Reminders list a one line summary that shows the total amount of the transactions affected QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 286 e Show list Put in the Reminders list a list of all the transactions affected with their individual amounts For to do notes QuickBooks lists the text of each note Don t remind me Clear all information about a particular event or activity from the Reminders list e Remind me ___ days before Specify how many days in advance that you want to be reminded of a particular event or activity You can enter a different number for each event or activity e Show Reminders List when QuickBooks starts Display the Reminders list when you start QuickBooks You can also display the list by choosing QuickBooks gt Preferences and then choosing Reminders from the Show pop up menu li Reporting preferences Reporting These preferences control how QuickBooks calculates
298. on receipt of payment You are liable for tax only when you receive cash from a customer cash basis Your choice determines the amount you owe in the Pay Sales Tax window and determines the amounts displayed in the sales tax liability report 5 From the Most common sales tax list choose the tax item or group you use most often Indicate who and what gets taxed Now you tell QuickBooks what items and what customer are taxable QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 216 Marking items you sell as taxable Item Name Number Cabinet Pulls Purchase Information Description on Purchase Transactions Cabinet Pulls Type Inventory Part Cost COGS Account 50100 Cost of Goods v Preferred Vendor Patton Hardware Supplie v Edit Item Guide Me C_D M Subitem of Cabinets Sales Information Description on Sales Transactions Cabinet Pulls Custom Fields Sales Price 0 00 M Taxable Income Account 40100 Construction _ Inactive Inventory Information Asset Account Reorder Point Qty on Hand Avg Cost Qty on Order 15 423 2 70468 0 Cancel e 12100 Inventory Asset v You can set up QuickBooks to distinguish between taxable and non taxable items when you make a sale When you add an item to your Item list you can indicate whether you charge tax for the item QuickBooks remembers this information and automatically shows whether or not an item is taxable when you enter t
299. ooks normally includes only charges dated AFTER the date of the last statement to the customer o This date Use the date shown in the This Date field Normally QuickBooks shows today s date in the field but you can change the date to a different date if you want 4 Click the tab for the kind of reimbursable cost you want to charge your customer for QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 109 o Click Items to bill for items you purchased for this job o Click Expenses to bill for other costs and expenses you incurred for this job o Click Time to bill for time billable to this job 5 Inthe Use column click next to each cost you want to create a statement charge for A check mark next to an item indicates that the cost will appear on the invoice or statement charge Items Time For inventory parts resale non inventory parts subcontracted services and reimbursable other charge item QuickBooks uses your sales price not your purchase cost If you want you can change the price on the statement QuickBooks uses the hourly rate for the service item you assigned to the task If you want you can change the rate on the invoice 6 If a particular item is an overhead cost that you are not going to pass on to the customer make sure that no check mark appears next to that cost in the Use column Tip If you know that you are NEVER going to bill your customer for a cost you can remove the cost so that it no longer appears i
300. ooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 240 Layout Designer Layout Designer is a QuickBooks tool you can use to customize your forms to give them a professional and distinctive look for your business You can use Layout Designer to customize the look of your invoices sales receipts estimates credit memos statements and purchase orders 1 Open Layout Designer At the top of each form choose an existing template and click New Template or Edit Current Template 2 Choose what goes on the template When you customize a template you can choose what information shows up on the form using the Fields window 3 Format the template Add a logo change the fonts add text boxes or borders or lines or a background image Your options are wide open Things to know e Add logos background graphics and other images to the template In the template window click Add Image on the toolbar Choose the image you want to add and then click Open You can add PDF GIF TIF JPG BMP PICT and PNG images e Change the font In the template window select the text you want to change In the Formatting Palette use the options under Text to change the font Export a template In Layout Designer choose File gt Export Choose the format you want to export the template to layoutdesigner can be used with another QuickBooks company file tiff or pdf Opening Layout Designer You customize the look of forms in QuickBooks invoices sales receipts est
301. or Mac 2014 Whether you re upgrading from a previous version of QuickBooks for Mac switching from QuickBooks for Windows or are new to the QuickBooks brand thanks for choosing us We ve added a few great features and made some big improvements in 2014 Set Up and Go New to QuickBooks Feeling a little lost Set Up and Go can help We ve added some assistance for new users to get you feeling comfortable and confident using QuickBooks to manage your business Short videos show you how to get QuickBooks set up then start creating receipts or invoices entering and paying bills generating reports and more e Income Tracker We ve made it easy for you to see where your money is anytime you re in QuickBooks Just open the Company Snapshot or the Transaction Center and there it is up at the top in an easy to to scan colorful bar Turn estimates into purchase orders So you ve created an estimate for a customer and gotten the job Great Now you ve got to buy all the materials for that job With the click of a button on the estimate you can create purchase orders for jobs You don t have to enter items or amounts twice which means you ll save time and keep your data consistent Redesigned toolbar We ve totally redesigned our toolbar to make it easier to use to navigate through QuickBooks It s over on the left side of your screen The buttons are smaller but when you hold your mouse over the toolbar it expands to tell you what each b
302. or debit cards Edit customers to add their credit or debit card Then when you need to process a card payment you can select the card from a dropdown list Keep notes about a customer or job Select a customer or job and then click Add Note or Edit Note in the top right corner of the center e Get a map or driving directions Select the name of a customer and click Map or Directions Intuit Maps displays a map or directions to the customer s address You must be online to get maps and directions I m getting an error with Maps and Directions e Sync customer contact information to Address Book Turn on Contact Sync Company gt Contact Sync Settings Select names of customers you want to sync with Address Book and then Control click and select Sync Customer s with Address Book A dot displays to remind you which names are synced How does Contact Sync work e Change the view By default QuickBooks lists jobs display in a hierarchy below a customer name Click the arrow beside a customer name to view the jobs for that customer You can also choose Flat View from the Action menu which lists each entry as the customer name plus the job name You can change the view by selecting Hierarchical View or Flat View from the Action menu e Print Save or Email the customer list Control click anywhere on the customer list and then select Print Customer List Save Customer List as Text or Email Customer List as PDF e Filte
303. or non inventory items for example to order office supplies for your business eee Purchase Orders L 4 S B standard Purchase Order gt E Lm o Prev Next Share Current Template History a P a _ Sa Filter Purchase Orders DETE p m A Cheung Limited Sort by Date v 7 z J T T i H Summary 4 ofp Create Purchase Order Purchase Order Date P O Number Phone 510 555 5723 A Cheung Limited 3 500 00 y suona d Email AC CheungLimited com 12 13 13 26237 E Vendor Ship To Open balance 0 00 A Cheung Limited Young Kyu Yoo i Daigle Lighting 65 00 Angela Cheung 1967 Appleseed Lane POs to be received 1 12 15 13 6236 3818 Bear Rd West Bayshore CA 94326 Berkeley CA 94688 Recent Transactions a Lew Plumbing 403 40 2 12 12 13 6235 maa FOR 02 28 13 Bill Check 2 000 00 A 12 18 13 E 0131 23 siu 2 000 00 Lane Tile Etc gine Ea Baan Pe a Rvd Clsd 01 31 13 Bill Check 3 500 00 sO Lumber Rough 35 100 00 3 500 00 20 01 20 13 Bill 2 000 00 Wheeler s Tile Etc 188 40 ae eee 12 9 13 6233 4 Notes d Daigle Lighting 163 25 1 12 7 13 6232 Larson Flooring 4 750 00 12 3 13 6231 Daigle Lighting 571 32 12 1 13 6229 Larson Flooring 341 20 Vendor Message 12 1 13 6230 L Total 3 500 00 Patton Hardware Sup 3 459 20 SENNEEEEEEE E 11 30 13 6228 z 3 Slaj BB 2 Perry Windows amp Doors 2 400 00
304. or this particular activity you still may want to enter the customer or job name For example if you spent the time correcting an error on a job filling in the Customer Job field gives you a record of your non billable time for the job You can display non billable time on time reports o Overhead If the time is truly overhead and has no association with any customer or job then leave the Customer Job field blank 5 Enter the name of the service item that matches this type of work and press Tab 6 Optional In the Notes field enter any additional information about this work and press Tab 7 Optional In the Class field enter the name of the class you want to associate with this work Then press Tab 8 For each day of the week that work was performed enter the number of hours worked in the appropriate date column 9 If you are not going to bill the customer for the work click Bi Time entry is billable but you haven t yet invoiced your customer for the time tres Time entry is NOT billable Time entry has already been billed on a previous invoice How service items help you analyze your business When you invoice your customer for this work the service item appears on the invoice It represents the type of work performed and tells QuickBooks which account to use to track the income you receive from the work This in turn gives you the ability to analyze which types of QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 135 w
305. or you Setting up a budget You can set up a budget for an account or for a customer job or class within an account To do so enter budget amounts for the income expense or balance sheet accounts you wish to track Then you ll be able to track actual versus budgeted amounts through budget reports You can have different budgets for different fiscal years but you may have only one budget per fiscal year To set up a budget 1 Choose Company gt Set Up Budget 2 Select an Account and fill in the Set Up Budgets window When you fill in the window you are setting up a budget for a single account balance sheet income or expense account If you also choose a customer job or a class you are setting up a budget for that account and for that customer job or class o Foran income or expense account Enter the projected amount of income or expense for that account for each month o Fora balance sheet account Enter the projected ending balance of that account for each month Tip As a shortcut to enter an amount for each month enter the amount for the first month and then click Fill Down On the Fill Down window you can specify a percentage by which the budget will increase for each month If you want the budget amount to be the same for each month leave the percentage at 0 QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 244 To change a budget 1 Choose Company gt Set Up Budget Tip You can use a printout of your existing budget while
306. ork are the most profitable for your business on sales by item reports and how much company time goes into each type of work on time by item reports Non billable time If you do not intend to bill your customer for this work you still may want to enter a service item For example if you spent the time correcting an error on a job filling in the Service Item field gives you a record of your non billable time for the that type of work How your notes about time activities are used When you invoice your customer for this time you can insert your note into the Description column on the invoice form You can also add the note to a Time by Job Detail report by clicking the Customize button in the report window and adding the Notes column to the report To use the note on an invoice 1 On the invoice form click Time Costs 2 Inthe Choose Billable Time Costs window click the Time tab 3 Click Change 4 Click Do not combine activities 5 Click Transfer service item descriptions Entering single activities A single activity is the time spent by one person doing a single activity on a single job on a single date Single activity entries are especially useful when you want to enter the details of a job as soon as you ve done work on it For example a lawyer might make a single activity entry to record a billable phone conversation To enter several dates or several jobs at once use the weekly timesheet form instead To enter single
307. ou can also run an Audit Trail report to look for modified or deleted transactions Tips for finding problems Sometimes something as simple as counting items or checking your totals can lead you to the culprit transaction that s causing your reconciling problems Here are some tips e Count the number of checks and withdrawals on your bank statement Compare that with the number of these transactions in the Reconcile window Do the same for deposits If you don t have the same number of these transactions in QuickBooks as your bank statement you may have found your problem Check to see if you o Missed recording a transaction in QuickBooks o Missed marking an item as cleared o Mistakenly marked an item as cleared o Entered a transaction twice o Entered a deposit as a payment or a payment as a deposit e Click the top of the Date column to sort your transactions by date or click another column to sort your transactions some other way This can make it much easier to find missing transactions or to match a transaction that s got an incorrect amount e Check to see if the bank summarized your transactions The bank may summarize transactions that you ve listed separately in your register For example if you made several deposits ona single day the bank might indicate the total sum of deposits for that day rather than listing each deposit separately Similarly you may summarize transactions in your register such as bank charge
308. ou deserve it QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 22 Switching from Windows If you ve switched from QuickBooks for Windows to QuickBooks for Mac you ve probably noticed some differences QuickBooks for Mac is built as a Mac product from the ground up so the interface elements will be familiar if you ve used other Mac applications If you re used to using keyboard shortcuts they will be different on the Mac QuickBooks Windows vs Mac What s the difference The biggest difference between the two products is in the feature set Here is a summary of the differences Because QuickBooks for Mac does not have all the features of its Windows counterpart not all data converts when you move your company file from Windows Here are some of the biggest differences between QuickBooks for Mac and Windows No Accountant s Copy You can share your QuickBooks for Mac file with your accountant but you won t be able to continue work in it To find out how to do this search for roundtrip in online Help Online payroll QuickBooks for Mac exchanges data with the online QuickBooks Payroll for Mac service Payroll is not part of QuickBooks for Mac as it is on Windows Limited 3rd party app integration Any applications that rely on the QuickBooks SDK WebConnector or App Center to access QuickBooks data will not integrate with QuickBooks for Mac Basic online banking QuickBooks for Mac offers online banking statement do
309. ou mark an item as inactive its subitems are also marked inactive To mark a list item as inactive 1 Open the list or center containing the entry you want to make inactive For example if you want to make a customer inactive choose Customers gt Customer Center to open the Customer Center 2 Open the entry and select the Inactive checkbox and click OK To view or hide inactive customers and vendors 1 For an inactive customers and vendors choose the center for that item For example for customers choose Customers gt Customer Center to open the Customer Center 2 At the bottom of the list go to the View menu Choose either Active Customer or Inactive Customers To view or hide list items other than customer and vendors 1 From the Lists Customers or Vendors menu choose the list containing the inactive items you want to hide 2 Clear the Include inactive checkbox Clearing the Include inactive checkbox hides all inactive items selecting the Include inactive checkbox displays inactive items in gray QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 43 Deleting an item from a list If an item is in use somewhere within your company file QuickBooks will not let you delete it For example if you have entered a shipping method on an invoice QuickBooks will not let you delete that shipping method from the Ship Via list until you remove it from the transaction To delete an item from a list 1
310. ou order but are getting the bill later use an item receipt to tell QuickBooks you received the items Use Vendors gt Receive Items Then when you get the bill later on you can pay it right away with a check or credit card or enter the bill You have a credit from a vendor Sometimes a vendor may owe you money You can then enter a bill credit Choose Vendors gt Enter Bills and select Credit at the top of the window Then you can apply the credit when you pay a future bill from the vendor You can also do the same thing for credit card credits Use Banking gt Credit Card Charges and select Credit in the window You need to pay your sales taxes When you need to pay your sales taxes use a sales tax payment Vendors gt Pay Sales Tax QuickBooks records the sales tax payment for the organization you ve set up as your tax agency QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 153 Ordering items you ll pay for later To order goods or services to be paid for at a later time use a purchase order PO QuickBooks uses POs to track outstanding orders for you Then when you receive the items or the services you can mark them as received on the purchase order Also when you get the bill you can just use the purchase order to enter the bill When you use POs to buy goods QuickBooks keeps track of which goods are on order so you ll know when they re due to be received Usually you ll use a PO to buy inventory goods but you can also use POs f
311. ou re using multiuser mode you can use iChat to contact other users If you re not using multiuser you can just ignore this Permissions Choose the type of access you want the user to have QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 295 e All areas of QuickBooks Administrative The name says it all A user with this permission setting can do anything and everything in the company file So be careful whom you assign this to If you re the owner of the company file make sure you create an admin user account for yourself and then be careful whom else you created one for e Selected areas of QuickBooks Custom You get to pick what areas the user can access This table is a summary of the permissions The options are additive so if you select more than one options the user will have the permissions for all the options you select Accounts Payable Accounts Receivable Check and Credit Cards Inventory Payroll Sensitive Accounting Sensitive Financial Time Tracking Work on vendor related tasks such as entering and paying bills Work on customer related tasks such as accepting payments from customers Write checks and enter transactions for the company s credit cards Order track and pay for inventory Access all payroll features Work with accounting related data that may have sensitive information such as banking Merchant Services 1099s and Chart of Accounts Work with financial features that may have sens
312. ou recognize the term You ll see this wherever you select payment terms Examples of payment terms Let s say your invoices are due in 25 days of receipt and you give your customers a 1 discount if they pay within 10 days These would be standard terms because payment is due within a specific number of days from the invoice date In the New Terms window click Standard and enter the following 1 10 Net 25 Suppose instead that your invoices are due on the 25th day of the month and you give your customers a 1 discount if they pay within 10 days To let QuickBooks know that 25 means the 25th day of the month and not 25 days after the invoice date click Date Driven in the New Terms window and still enter 1 10 Net e Standard Select this if you want your customer to pay within a certain number of days Now enter the details for this type of payment term o Net due in The number of days in which payments from customers or bills to vendors are due o Discount percentage is The discount percentage a customer earns for early payment of an invoice or that your business earns for early payment of a bill If there is a discount you must also complete the next field Discount if paid If there is no discount enter zero o Discount if paid within Enter the number of days within which a customer or your business can pay and receive a discount for early payment Be sure to enter the discount percentage in the previous field
313. p the money you receive by payment method when you deposit it all checks in one deposit all Visa charges in another deposit etc Simply create a separate payment item for each payment method your customers use Tip If you enter a payment method you can group the money you receive by payment method when you deposit it all checks in one deposit all Visa charges in another deposit etc Simply create a separate payment item for each payment method your customers use If this is the first time you are setting up a payment item indicate how you want QuickBooks to deposit customer payments o Grouped with other payments Click Group with other funds for later deposit o Directly to a bank account Click Deposit to and enter the name of the bank account where you would like QuickBooks to deposit the payment Click OK QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 72 Creating tax items On invoices cash sales receipts and credit memos you specify which sales tax applies to the taxable items QuickBooks calculates the correct tax and prints it on the sales form QuickBooks has two types of sales tax items Sales tax A single tax with a specific rate payable to an agency that you collect from your customers e Sales tax group A group of two or more single taxes collected for the same sale and shown on the sales form as one tax item To create a tax item 1 Choose Lists gt Items 2 Click the at the bottom of
314. p you ll use most often from the list e Mark taxable amounts with T when printing Place a T for Taxable next to taxable line items in the Amount column By selecting this checkbox you can print all the Ts whenever you print sales forms If you clear the checkbox QuickBooks will still show the Ts when you view a sales form on your screen S Sounds preferences Sounds Sounds preferences are where you set what sounds you want to play for certain tasks in QuickBooks If you don t like the sounds that play when you do certain tasks in QuickBooks you can change them QuickBooks offers several sounds to choose from and you can use your own sounds as well Put any AIFF WAV or MP3 sound in the Documents QuickBooks Sounds folder and it will be available for QuickBooks 1 Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences 2 On the Preferences pane select Sounds 3 Set the preferences described below e Play Sounds Check this if you want QuickBooks to play sounds when you use QuickBooks If the checkbox is selected you can choose which sounds you want to hear e Save a record sound Choose the sound you want to hear when you save a record such as when you create an invoice or update an estimate Deleting a record sound Choose the sound you want to hear when you delete a record such as when you delete a sales receipt e No more records sound Choose the sound you want to hear when there are no more records available such as
315. page choose QuickBooks from the print options pop up menu and select the Shrink to Fit checkbox QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 226 Customizing your report After you create a report Reports gt Report Center you can use filters date ranges and other features to customize the data on the report so you see what most important to you For example a sales by customer summary report initially shows your sales to all customers for the current month to date This would be too much information if all you wanted was to see this month s sales to one of your customers You can apply filters either one at a time or in combination with each other Each additional filter you apply further restricts the content of the report Adding a filter You can add filters to filter the report to show just the information you want To add a filter 1 Inthe Report window click Filters at the top of the report 2 On the filters window select the checkbox next to the filter you want to use 3 Set the options for the filter if needed 4 Click Apply To clear the filters click Clear All Types of filters QuickBooks provides lots of filters for your reports see below Also any custom fields you have can be used as a filter e Account Limit the report to certain accounts For example choose All Bank Accounts from the list to limit the report to the accounts from which you write checks Choose Selected Accounts to limit the report t
316. pe are displayed in the Select an Account list You can only associate a QuickBooks account with one online banking account To open a new QuickBooks account click New from the Select an Account list or create a bank credit card or Other Current Liability account first Enter the customer ID and password you use to access your online account and then click Sign In After QuickBooks has successfully downloaded your transactions click Done The Downloaded Transactions window displays the transactions downloaded from your online banking accounts You have completed setting up Direct Connect and can now update your register Online Banking Tips and Troubleshooting Here some tips to help you fix the most common problems with online banking in QuickBooks Setting up online banking e What do I do if my financial institution is not listed If you don t see your financial institution name when setting up access to your online banking account o If you have the Select the financial institution window open click Cancel and reopen the window to refresh the list QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 180 o Be sure your financial institution supports online banking with QuickBooks o Check for typos in the name you entered o Be sure to look for the formal name of the bank For example the formal name of WaMu is Washington Mutual o Use the search field in the top right corner of the Online Banking Assistant o
317. r Mac Try closing and restarting QuickBooks for the switch to take effect e Do you have an email address for the recipient of the email You must have a valid email address for anyone you try to send email to If you do not have an email address for the recipient saved in the customer or vendor list you can add an address on the Select Forms to Email window Click twice in Email Address column next to the name and enter the email address You will be asked if you want to use this email address once or if you want to save it in the customer or vendor list Note The time it takes for QuickBooks to send a document as a PDF depends on the size of the form your computer s speed and your Internet connection speed Try keeping the design of your custom templates simple Remove or replace large images in your template You can also use a standard form template that comes with QuickBooks Restoring Your Company File from a Backup Sometimes things just don t go well files get messed up computers crash But don t worry it s easy to get QuickBooks going again Each disk image dmg file QuickBooks creates when it backs up your data includes a copy of your company file and your Attached Documents Library if you use and back up attachments Here s how you do it QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 254 1 Goto your backed up disk image and double click it to mount it Attachments Library Restore Instructions pdf Sample Pro
318. r Mac has ten different types of items you can use for forms and reports Items permeate the QuickBooks landscape acting as key components in everything from jobs to invoices accounts to reports So where can you find all these items First and foremost in the Items list List gt Items one of the three major lists in QuickBooks The other two are the customers and vendors lists QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 63 Item List _ Q Filter Items Description Account On Hand 2005 pickup 2 Service 15100 Vehicles 2005 Van 14 Service 15100 Vehicles Blueprint changes Service 40100 Construction Inco Blueprints Blueprints Service 40100 Construction Inco Chairs 3 Service 15000 Furniture and Equi Conference Table 4 Service 15000 Furniture and Equi Copier Printer 15 Service 15000 Furniture and Equi Desks 5 Service 15000 Furniture and Equi Desktop computer 6 Service 15000 Furniture and Equi Desktop PC 7 Service 15000 Furniture and Equi Desktop PC 5 8 Service 15000 Furniture and Equi Equipment 17 Service 15300 Construction Equi Floor Plans Floor plans Service 40100 Construction Inco Framing Framing labor Service 40100 Construction Inco Installation Installation labor Service 40100 Construction Inco Labor Service 40100 Construction Inco Laser Printer 9 Service 15000 Furniture and Equi Lexus 16 Se
319. r again print the customer s statement The statement will include the credit memo along with any other charges for the billing period Correcting undercharges on statements If you charge a customer too little on a statement what you do depends on whether you have sent the statement yet To correct undercharges if you haven t sent the statement yet 1 Open either the customer s register or your A R register 2 Find any incorrect charges Change the amounts of those charges 3 Click Record to save your changes 4 Reprint the statement Tip 1 In the Select Statements to Print window make sure that the date range of the reprinted statement is the same as it was for the original statement Tip 2 If you are reprinting a statement for one customer only be sure to select the One customer option when the Select Statements to Print window appears Normally this window is set to print statements for ALL customers To correct undercharges if you ve already sent the statement 1 Open either the customer s register or your A R register QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 108 2 Enter an adjustment charge to appear on the customer s next statement o Enter the item you undercharged This ensures correct accounting on your reports o Make the amount equal to the difference between the correct amount and the amount you charged the customer For example if you charged 5 00 when you should have charged 7 00 enter the adjustmen
320. r each transaction e Due Date Include only those invoices and bills due within a specified date range Entered Modified Limit the report to transactions entered or edited within a specified date range This option works with the audit trail report e FOB Limit transactions to fields that appear in sales or purchase transactions For example choose All sales items from the Items list and FedEx from the Ship Via list to include only those sales transactions that show items you shipped by FedEx Choose Selected from one of the lists to choose list items individually e Job Type Limit the report to transactions related to one of the job types on your Job Type list For example a general contractor who has Bathrooms Family Rooms and Kitchens as job types could choose Kitchens to limit the report to costs and revenues for kitchen remodels Using job type as a filter helps you determine how profitable a specific kind of job is to your business e Memo Restrict transactions based on their Memo fields QuickBooks finds a match if the transaction s Memo field includes the specified sequence of characters For example if you enter pay in the Memo field QuickBooks matches Memo fields with Pay by June 21 or Please pay immediately e Name Limit the report to transactions related to certain names from your Customer Job Vendor Employee or Other Names lists For example choose All
321. r template can be selected It s selected when you see the square handles on the corner Then you can drag and drop it anywhere you like Drag a corner handle to make the object bigger or smaller Move multiple objects together by holding down the Shift key when you select them Guidelines can help Layout Designer has guidelines that can help you align the objects on your form Choose View gt Smart Guides to turn on guides that move with the object Choose Insert gt Guides to insert vertical or horizontal guidelines you can position on your page Guidelines do not appear on the form when you print The grid can help too Click Grid in the Layout Designer toolbar You can then use the Grid bar that appears below the toolbar to set the size of the grid squares and units turn the grid on and off and set the Snap to Grid Layout Designer FAQs Have questions about customizing your forms with Layout Designer Check out these tips have pre printed forms I use How can I create a template that works with them To create templates that work with your own pre printed forms choose File gt Print Without Labels to print your template without field labels This will let you see the labels in the Template window while you are creating your template but the labels will not appear on your printed form The default size for templates is 8 5 x 11 portrait How can change that To change the paper size choose File gt Page Setup to choose a
322. r the information you see You can filter the customer list as well as the transactions by using the filters located under each list For example you can select Customers with Open Balances from the View pulldown menu under the customer list then select a customer name Then you can use the filters under the transactions on the right pane to filter the transactions to view All Sales QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 80 Tips and Tricks Try these tips and tricks to make using Customer Center even easier e Sort information by clicking the column titles Rearrange the columns by clicking and dragging the top of a column to move it to another location Show different columns or hide columns you don t need Right click or Control click on the column headers then select the columns you want to see and unselect the ones you want to hide Select multiple names in one of these ways o Shift click to select a range of names Select the first name you want hold down the Shift key and then select the last name in the range o Command click to select a group of nonadjacent names Select a name hold down the Command key 5 and then select each additional name o Command A to select all names No need to click just press Command A to select the entire list Control click a name in the left pane to access a shortcut menu to common tasks p Burch a Help gt Campt Carr s New Customer i gt Castil Add Jo
323. rchant Service preferences to set up your Intuit QuickBooks Merchant Service account Then when you accept payments you can use your customers credit and debit cards 1 2 Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences On the Preferences pane select Merchant Service In the Step 1 area click Apply Now On the Merchant Service website you can choose the type of payment solution you want to process your customer s debit or credit cards You can sign up for the service on the Merchant Service website or over the phone When you set up your account make sure to create a username and password for your Merchant Service account If you sign up on the website you can create your username and password there If you sign up over the phone you will be emailed a link where you can create your username and password Once you have your username and password log in to your Merchant Services account and create a connection ticket Enter this ticket on the bottom of the Merchant Service preference window and click Save If you need to recreate your connection ticket such as if your Merchant Service account changes then click Create Ticket You will be taken to your Merchant Service account where you can create a new ticket Close the Preferences window After you ve set your Merchant Services preferences you re ready to start accepting your customer s cards for payment e When you create a sales receipt or record an invoice payment you can proc
324. re adding to your inventory leave the quantity on hand and value at zero a If this is an item you already have in stock enter the quantity on hand and value as of the last time you measured your inventory Then be sure to enter any sales or purchases of the item that occurred between the date you measured your inventory and today This ensures that QuickBooks record of your quantity on hand for the item will be accurate a If this is an item you are converting to an inventory part item from a non inventory part service or other charge item the date you enter must be a date that is after the date of the last transaction that uses the item QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 68 o As of lIt s best to use today s date If you re converting this item from a different type of item you must use today s date for accurate records If you use your start date or any date in the past you ll need to enter all purchases and sales of this item up to today in order for your quantity on hand and value to be correct 8 Optional Fill in any custom fields that apply to this item 9 To mark an item as inactive select the Inactive checkbox 10 Click OK Creating subtotal items A subtotal item adds up the amounts of the items above it up to the last subtotal Create a subtotal item if you want to apply a percentage discount to several items Because QuickBooks calculates percentages only on the line above you need to subtotal the items b
325. re used preferences in Inventory preferences If the check is for an inventory part non inventory part service or other charge item At the bottom of the windows click the Items pane If you don t see the Expenses Items panes turn on the Inventory and purchase orders are used preferences in Inventory preferences This works the same as it does for bills Click Select PO and select the PO that 1 contains the items you re writing the check for and click OK Make any necessary changes to the line 2 items If you didn t receive all the items on the purchase order you can edit the quantity or cost of any item or delete an item completely from the detail area of the charge Tip If you make a mistake when you are editing the quantities click Receive All to return all quantities to their original values Other things you should know about writing checks From the Item list select the first item you are being billed for You can also type the item name directly into the Item column In the Qty column enter the quantity you received If necessary edit the cost of the item Repeat these steps for the other items you received Track shipping and other charges You can enter shipping charges or taxes not associated with any one item Go to the Expenses pane In the detail area enter each charge and associate it with its correct expense account QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 169 5 Add this check to
326. retains the date you wrote the check Start with payee field on check Positions the text cursor so that the name of the payee is the first item you enter when you write a check enter a bill or enter a credit card charge Checks Payee field QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 278 Bills Vendor field Credit card charges Purchased from field When this preference is off the cursor starts in the Bank Account field when you write checks and the Credit Card field when you enter credit card charges For bills if you have more than one accounts payable account the cursor starts in the A P Account field otherwise it starts in the Vendor field e Warn about duplicate check numbers Causes QuickBooks to warn you when you try to record a check that has the same number as a previous check The warning causes QuickBooks to take more time to record a check If you are not concerned about duplicate check numbers do not select this preference Default accounts to use in these forms For each of the forms listed you can create a default account to use on each type of form E Sync preferences Contact Sync preferences is where you turn on or off the ability to synchronize contacts in your Contacts Address Book application with your QuickBooks lists of customers vendors and or employees 1 Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences 2 On the Preferences pane select Contact Sync 3 Click the Use Contact Sync checkbox 4 Close
327. rized transaction group Choose Edit gt Delete Memorized Transaction QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 106 Memorizing charges for new customers If you enter statement charges automatically you can add new customers to the memorized transaction group you originally set up to enter the statement charges To memorize charges for new customers Step 1 For each new customer enter the statement charges you want QuickBooks to enter automatically Step 2 Memorize the statement charges and add them to the memorized transaction group 1 Inthe A R or customer register select the statement charge 2 Choose Edit gt Memorize Stmt Charge 3 Click With Transactions in Group 4 From the Group Name list choose the memorized transaction group you want to add the customer to 5 Optional To add this transaction to iCal or Calendar select the Show in iCal checkbox Step 3 When you have memorized all the new statement charges delete them from the register 1 Inthe A R or customer register select the statement charge 2 Choose Edit gt Delete Stmt Charge 3 Click OK to confirm that you want to delete the statement charge Why delete the charges When you use the memorized transaction group QuickBooks reenters the charges If you leave the original charges in the register the next time you print billing statements the charges will appear twice Correcting overcharges on statements Ooops Mistakes happen Here s
328. rom cash sales matches actual bank deposits That ll make it easier to record deposits Refunds and credit memos Click Refunds and Credits and enter returns that may have occurred from the invoices and sales receipts you ve already entered e Payments Click Receive Payments and record each payment received from a customer for an outstanding invoice Be sure that you apply the payment to the appropriate invoice and that the Date field shows the payment date If the payment was for all or part of the customer s open balance as of the start date you ll see a QuickBooks invoice for that balance Deposits For this one you ll venture out of the Customer area of the Home page and go to the Banking area Click Record Deposits and record each deposit of a payment you ve received be sure to select all customer payments whether for invoices or sales receipts deposited on one date Then click OK In the Make Deposits window be sure the Date field shows the deposit date e Payments of sales tax For this one you ll go to the Vendor area and click Pay Sales Tax I know This article is about customer transactions but you re collecting from customers and paying a vendor so it s a gray area Stick with me In the Pay Sales Tax window record each payment you made of sales tax you collected Be sure that you enter the amounts you actually paid the sales tax agencies and that the Date field shows the payment date That s it for
329. rs info into the fields rather than copying it Troubleshooting e I can t click a cell in the Role column after I ve opened the Add Contacts window Click cnt and choose Add Line e got a message in the Import status window that says I have errors in some of my items We can help you fix them 1 Close the Import status window by clicking OK 2 On the spreadsheet look for the items that have red Xes on the far left side 3 Click on the item with the red X A message pops up to the right of the item s row describing what went wrong 4 Fix the items with the red Xes and click Import again 5 Click OK when QuickBooks finishes importing your items Entering historical transactions It s moving day Only instead of moving offices you re moving your data into QuickBooks And as with most moves you probably won t do it all in one fell swoop It may take some time to get everything in there But even if you don t have all the historical data in your company file you can and should still keep going with entering new transactions along the way When you created your company file you entered a start date for your company If you entered a start date in the past you ll need to enter all historical transactions from that start date through today Your business may have existed for longer than that start date but that s OK For example let s say your new year s resolution was to move your business finances from spreadsheets to
330. rs from the list QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 165 o Inthe onscreen version of the report look for vendors who are missing from the printed version If you need to send 1099 MISC forms to any of these vendors you need to set them up as 1099 vendors 3 If you found any missing 1099 vendors set them up as 1099 vendors now Use the Vendor Center and edit the vendor Second verify your 1099 accounts 1 Choose Reports gt Vendors amp Payables gt 1099 Detail This report should include ALL the vendors to whom you send 1099 MISC forms For each vendor the report lists the transactions QuickBooks used to calculate the total for each 1099 category The accounts shown are the accounts you selected for tracking 1099 related payments in the 1099 MISC Setup window 2 Check the report for missing 1099 accounts o Press P to print the report in its current form o Inthe report buttonbar click Only 1099 Accounts Choose All cur asst exp accts from the list o Inthe onscreen version of the report check the accounts listed in the Accounts column Some of these accounts may not appear at all in the printed report If you find an account in the onscreen report that is not in the printed report and you have been using the account to track 1099 related payments you need to set up the account as a 1099 account 3 If you found any accounts that should be 1099 accounts set them up now in the 1099 MISC Setup window Third verif
331. rtcut used in the Mac OS program Spaces To prevent this go to the Mac OS system preferences and change the keystrokes for Spaces Down one screen Up one screen First item on list or first transaction of a month in register Last item on list or last transaction of a month in register First transaction in register Last transaction in a register Close all windows in QuickBooks Activities Lists gt Chart of Accounts Lists gt Customer Jobs Lists gt Employees Lists gt Items Lists gt Memorized Transactions Lists gt Vendors Customers gt Create Invoices Banking gt Write Checks QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide Shortcut Tab Shift Tab Right Arrow Left Arrow Down Arrow Up Arrow Command l Command K Command T Control Down Arrow Page Down Page Up Command Page Up Command Page Down Command Home Command End Shift click to close the box Shortcut Shift Command A Shift Command J Shift Command E Shift Command Shift Command M Shift Command V Command Command K 258 Reports gt Transaction Journal Command T On notebook computers press the Fn key at the same time Next day plus key Previous day minus key Today t First day of the week First day of the month w Last day of the week k m h Last day of the month First day of the year lt Last day of the year r QuickBooks for Mac 2014
332. rting point for assessing finance charges For example for a customer who has 30 days to pay an invoice but is five days overdue QuickBooks assesses finance charges for 5 overdue days plus the original 30 days Finance Charge Account Choose the account you use to track finance charges Usually this is an income account o Assess finance charges on overdue finance charges Calculate finance charges on finance charges that are overdue and unpaid o Mark finance charge invoices To be printed Create an invoice for each customer for whom you assess a finance charge This preference marks those invoices as to be printed QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 281 so you can print all the invoices at once by choosing File gt Print Forms gt Invoices If you send statements leave this checkbox cleared dh Inventory preferences Inventory Inventory preferences turn on off inventory and purchase order features in QuickBooks 1 Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences 2 On the Preferences pane select Inventory 3 Set the preferences described below 4 Close the Preferences pane Inventory and purchase orders are used Create inventory part items write purchase orders and create inventory related reports When you created your company QuickBooks asked whether you tracked inventory If you answered Yes QuickBooks turned this preference on for you o Warn if not enough stock to sell Cause QuickBooks to warn you wh
333. rvice 15100 Vehicles Metal filling cabinets 10 Service 15000 Furniture and Equi Mileage Service 40500 Reimbursement In Office Building 11 Service 15200 Buildings and Impr Office Land 12 Service 16900 Land Removal Removal labor Service 40100 Construction Inco Repairs Repair work Service 40100 Construction Inco Server 13 Service 15000 Furniture and Equi gt Subs Subcontracted services Service 40100 Construction Inco Utility Truck 1 Service 15100 Vehicles View All tems xanga Types of items QuickBooks provides ten types of items to help you fill out sales and purchase forms quickly e Service Use for services you either charge for or purchase such as specialized labor and consulting hours e Inventory part Use for merchandise or parts you purchase track as inventory and then resell e Non inventory part Use for materials or parts you buy but don t keep on hand as inventory These can be either part of your overhead for example office supplies or they can be materials you buy to finish a specific job and charge back to your customer Other charge Use for miscellaneous charges that are not services labor materials or parts Examples include delivery charges setup fees and service charges e Subtotal Use for calculating a subtotal You must use a subtotal item before calculating a discount or a charge that covers several items e Group Use for
334. ry Set QuickBooks to include attached documents in the backup How do I back up my company file manually 1 Set your Backup Preferences 2 Goto File gt Back Up QuickBooks backs up your company file When it s finished you ll see a success message Click OK to get back to work QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 277 Checks preferences Checks These preferences control how QuickBooks behaves when you write and print checks The selections you make affect the current company file 1 Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences 2 On the Preferences pane select Checks o Set the preferences described below 4 Close the Preferences pane e Print account names on vouchers Prints the following information on the voucher portion of each check O O O O Payee Date Account name first 16 lines Exception QuickBooks prints the name of the inventory item on checks for inventory purchases Memo first 16 lines Amount first 16 lines Total amount When this preference is off QuickBooks omits the account or item names but prints all of the other information listed above e Change check date when check is printed Changes the date on a check to today s date when you print the check Example You write a check on March 15 but do not print it yet The date on the check is March 15 You print the check on March 20 Now the date on the check is March 20 When this preference is off QuickBooks
335. s 1 Goto your Intuit PaymentNetwork account page and change your email address there 2 Goto QuickBooks gt Preferences and click Intuit PaymentNetwork 3 Click Edit 4 Enter and Confirm your new email address 5 Click OK QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 285 6 Click the red X to close the Preferences pane QuickBooks saves your changes automatically bz ey Payroll Payroll preferences Payroll preferences set up how the Payroll command works when you select it from the icon on the Payroll Home Page and the Payroll command on the Employees menu 1 Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences 2 On the Preferences pane select Payroll 3 Set the preferences described below 4 Close the Preferences pane If you have employees and want to track your payroll in QuickBooks choose which payroll system you want to use When you select the Payroll command by choosing the Payroll icon on the Home Page or by choosing Employees gt Payroll the system you choose will launch e Displays a choice of services The Payroll command displays both choices for payroll Launches QuickBooks Payroll for Mac Select this option if you are using the Intuit QuickBooks Payroll for Mac If you want to learn more about system click Learn More e Launches Aatrix for Mac Select this option if you are using Aatrix for your payroll Reminders preferences Reminders Need to be reminded when to do something like pay bills print invoices act
336. s that the bank itemizes e Check the dollar amount of the checks withdrawals or deposits If the totals don t agree you may have entered a transaction in QuickBooks incorrectly Fixing the incorrect amount If you find an incorrect amount in a transaction here s how to fix it 1 In the Reconcile window double click the incorrect transaction to open it in its original window 2 Enter the correct amount Click OK to record the change 3 Click in the Reconcile window or choose Banking gt Reconcile to return to the list of marked transactions 4 Mark the corrected transaction as cleared Transferring funds between accounts You can record a transfer of funds from one account to another QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 194 To record the transfer 1 Make the transfer at your bank 2 In QuickBooks choose Banking gt Transfer Funds 3 Select the date you want the transfer to be recorded in your Company file 4 Enter the transfer amount 5 Select the accounts you want to transfer funds from and to The window displays the balances of both accounts 6 Optional Enter a memo for the transfer 7 Click OK Let QuickBooks make a an adjustment transaction What s a few cents between friends right The difference between your QuickBooks account balance and your bank statement may be small enough that it s not worth your time to track down the error So before you go spending a lot of time tracking down a few
337. s Guide 199 Hannah sets up her inventory To see how inventory works we ll follow Hannah who has decided to be her own Watch the video boss and open a new store Illusion Supplies She ll be selling tools of the trade to magicians in North America and around the world Turn on inventory tracking Hannah creates her company file using QuickBooks for Mac of course and Inventory Part 1 Hannah sets up her shop she turns on Inventory tracking through http www gblittlesquare com 2011 03 inve her Preferences When you created your ntory part 1 hannah sets up her shop company QuickBooks asked whether you tracked inventory If you answered Yes the preference is already turned on If you answered No read on To turn inventory tracking on 1 Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences and then click Inventory 2 Select the Inventory and purchase orders are active checkbox Set up vendors Hannah also uses the Vendor Center to create vendors for three suppliers she plans to use for her inventory McCormick s Wand Supply Wright Top Hats Carol s Rabbit Hutch Find out about using the Vendor Center on page 146 Create inventory items Hannah creates inventory items for wands top hats and rabbits When she creates the items she chooses Inventory Part as item type because she plans to resell these items QuickBooks will track how many inventory items remain in stock after a sale how many items she
338. s a list of open POs for that vendor Select the POs that contain the items you re receiving When you re finished click OK Make any necessary changes to the line items If you didn t receive all the items on the purchase order you can edit the quantity or cost of any item or delete an item completely from the detail area of the Create Item Receipts window Tip If you make a mistake when you are editing the quantities click Receive All to return all quantities to their original values o No Enter the items in the detail area From the Item list choose the first item you are being billed for You can also type the item name directly into the Item column If the item is not on your list QuickBooks asks you to set it up In the Qty column enter the quantity you received If necessary edit the cost of the item Repeat these steps for the other items you received To enter shipping charges or taxes not associated with any one item click the Expenses tab Enter each charge and associate it with its correct expense account Click Save QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 209 Selling your inventory Now that you have everything in QuickBooks set up for inventory and you ve bought your goods Now it s time to do what it s all about sell your inventory When you sell something to a customer track that sale in QuickBooks with an invoice page 95 or a sales receipt page 113 e If you will receive payment later choose Crea
339. s for Mac 2014 User s Guide 70 To group items on a form 1 Fill in the form as you normally would 2 Inthe line item area choose the group item from the list in the Item column 3 Optional Change the quantities QuickBooks fills in for the group item If you change the quantity for the entire group QuickBooks automatically adjusts the quantities of the individual items and recalculates the amount for each item If you change the quantity of an individual item the quantities and amounts of the other items remain unchanged Creating discount items A discount item applies a discount either a percentage or a fixed amount to the preceding line ona sales form You do not need a discount item for discounts you give for early payment You can calculate these discounts when you receive payments from customers To create discount items 1 Choose Lists gt Items 2 Click the at the bottom of the list tJ 3 Inthe Type field of the New Item window choose Discount 4 Enter an item name such as Discount 5 Enter the description that you want QuickBooks to put on your sales forms when you apply the discount 6 Enter the discount amount or percentage o If the discount is a percentage include a sign For example 5 tells QuickBooks to multiply the previous line by 05 o If your discount amounts vary you may want to leave the Amount field blank and enter the amount directly on your sales forms 7 Enter the account
340. s like payroll You can set up a data entry user account for that user Choose Company gt Users and Passwords 1 Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences 2 On the Preferences pane select Users amp Passwords 3 Set the preferences described below 4 Close the Preferences pane You can set up user accounts with full or limited access to features in your company file You must have user accounts set up before you can use QuickBooks for Mac in multiuser mode Note If you are the owner of the company file make sure to create an administrative user for yourself before you create other users Add edit or delete a user e To add a user click the Then the User Name and Password options for the user see below e To edit the user double click the user name and make your changes e To delete a user select the user name and click User Name and Password options If you re creating this user account for someone else make sure you share the account information you enter with him or her e User Name The name the user will use to log in to the file e Password Confirm Password The password the user will use to log in to the file e Security Question and Answer If you forget this user s password QuickBooks will ask you this question When you answer it correctly QuickBooks logs you in You can then reset the password by coming back to the User Name and Password window e optional iChat Account The user s iChat account name If y
341. s written to cover credit card charges made between your start date and today split the amount of the payment among the various expense accounts it covers e If you don t record individual credit card charges using the Enter Credit Card Charges window you won t have detailed records of charges If you don t pay your balance in full each month or if you know of charges that have not yet appeared on your statement choose Banking gt Enter Credit Card Charges and enter individual charges When you write a check to cover charges already entered in your credit card account or for the opening balance of that account enter the credit card account in the Account field of the check Don t enter the expense accounts because you re already tracking expenses in the Enter Credit Card Charges window You can enter interest and other fees directly in the credit card account register Reconciling your bank account Using QuickBooks you can reconcile your bank accounts to track which checks have cleared your bank After you ve entered your bank transactions it s a good idea to reconcile your QuickBooks register with each statement one at a time from the first statement after your start date to your last statement Then you ll know that QuickBooks and your bank are in agreement Where to go from here So that s it for getting your historical transactions into QuickBooks Whew You did good Now go do something nice for yourself Y
342. scal year is July 1st Note You can change the date range for any individual report or graph when you create it To setup reporting info Important If you change the tax form QuickBooks resets all of the associations between accounts and tax lines to lt Unassigned gt You ll have to re associate your accounts with tax lines for the new tax form you ve chosen For details see Adding new accounts 1 Choose the first month of your company s tax year QuickBooks uses your tax year to create income tax summary and detail reports For example if your tax year begins on January 1st your income tax reports show all tax related transactions from January 1 through December 31 of the current tax year You can change the date range of any individual report to cover other tax years or periods when you create the report 2 Choose the first month of your company s fiscal year 3 Choose which income tax form you use lonline Invoice Payments preferences Intuit PaymentNetwork is an online payment network Your customers can send payments over Intuit PaymentNetwork that get deposited directly to the bank account you choose and you can pay vendors via the PaymentNetwork Set the Intuit PaymentNetwork Preferences so you can add a link to the PaymentNetwork to your invoices QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 284 How do set Intuit PaymentNetwork preferences 1 Goto QuickBooks gt Preferences 2 On the Preferences pane click Intuit Pa
343. ser s Guide 149 Entering vendors in QuickBooks You can use the Vendor Center or the Vendor List to add vendors to QuickBooks To add or edit a vendor 1 Choose Vendors gt Vendor Center or Lists gt Vendors 2 Add anew vendor or open an existing vendor o Add New Vendor Click the menu at the bottom of the vendor list and click New Vendor Or Control click anywhere in the Vendor list and choose New Vendor from the shortcut menu o Edit Existing Vendor Select the name of the vendor and click the Edit button at the bottom of the list Or In the Vendor list control click the name of the customer you want to edit and choose Edit Vendor from the shortcut menu Or in Vendor Center select the name of the vendor you want to edit in the Vendor list and click Edit Vendor in the top right corner of the center Note You can click Expand to expand the Vendors list to the full Vendor Center 3 Enter information about the Vendor and click OK When you add or edit a vendor you capture this information about them e Vendor Enter the name of the vendor as you d like it to appear on your Vendor list For example if the vendor s name is Russell Poole and you want the list to show last names first you would enter Poole Russell e Vendor is inactive If you don t work with this vendor anymore you can make the vendor inactive This keeps the vendor name out of lists but maintains all the vendor s information Address Info On the Addr
344. ser accounts 29 Creating service non inventory part or Step Four Start multiuser mode 30 other charge items 66 QuickBooks server 30 Creating items for inventory 67 Where to store your file 31 Creating subtotal items 69 Other things to know about multiuser Creating group items 70 mode 31 Creating discount items 71 QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide Creating payment items 72 Applying a discount to a statement Creating tax items 73 charge 111 Importing items in batches 74 Marking a sale as pending 112 Other things to know about items 75 When a customer pays you 113 Changing the price of items 76 Giving your customers sales receipts Creating subitems 77 113 3 Receiving payments 115 CHAPTER5 Getting paid 78 Accepting your customer s credit and Customer Center 78 debit cards 117 How do use it 79 What you should know before processing Tips and Tricks 81 a credit card payment in QuickBooks 118 Adding or editing a customer 82 Processing credit and debit cards FAQ Address pane 82 119 Additional Info pane 83 Entering your customer s credit debit card Payment info if you use Merchant information 120 Services 84 Voiding a credit card transaction 120 Notes 84 Tracking GoPayment and other credit Contact Sync 86 card transactions in QuickBooks 120 How do use it 86 Handling down payments and Adding a contact from Address Book 87 overpayments 121 Setting up jobs 88 Applying a discount for early payment 122 Types of Jobs 88 When you
345. ser mode but other users will not be able to work on it e You can view stats on the company file by selecting it in the left column of QuickBooks Server You can see how long the company file has been shared the number of changes that have happened since you started sharing the file the file location and the users working on the shared file e You can disconnect a user Select the company file name and then the user name you want to disconnect Then click Disconnect The user will no longer be connected to the company file e Chat with other users working on the shared file Sometimes you may need to contact other users when you re all working in the same company file In QuickBooks Server select the company filename and the user name of the person you want to chat with then click Chat Your default Chat application will open a chat with the user you selected Note For Chat to work the user s account must include their Chat ID Where to store your file In multiuser mode your company file sits on one computer and is shared on your network with other QuickBooks users So which computer are you going to use to store the file Here s my advice recommend picking a computer that meets or exceeds the recommendations for processor memory and disk space The amount of RAM on the computer can significantly affect performance so get as much as you can e It s a good idea to pick a computer that will be on during work hours and is g
346. sheet Compare them to your item spreadsheet 3 Make changes to your spreadsheet if you need to to make it fit better with the QuickBooks columns 4 Back in QuickBooks set up Income Accounts that make sense to your business If you ll be tracking inventory in QuickBooks set up COGS Accounts and Asset Accounts too We can help you decipher COGS and other account types if you re new to serious bookkeeping To import items 1 Goto File gt Import gt From Multiple The Add Contacts Products and Services window appears 2 Click the Add Now button on the Add the Products and Services You Sell side on the right of the window The Copy and Paste spreadsheet appears 3 Choose the kind of item you re going to copy into QuickBooks Service Items Non Inventory Items Inventory Items Tip If you ve chosen Inventory Items there are lots more columns in the spreadsheet Drag the window to the right to make it wider If you re working on a laptop or narrow QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 74 10 11 12 13 monitor the whole spreadsheet may not fit on your screen use the scroll bar under the columns to navigate Open your item spreadsheet Copy the Item Name Number column or whatever you Call it Go back to QuickBooks Double click the first cell of the Item Name Number column a white field appears Press Command v to paste the column in Repeat steps 4 6 for all the columns in the QuickBooks spreadsh
347. signer Fields window rename the desired custom field Or to remove the field clear the checkboxes next to the custom field name 4 Save the form template Now only when you use that template you ll see the change only on the form To use custom fields in reports If you use custom fields in transactions you can base your reports on data you ve entered into the fields You can restrict the report so that it shows only transactions associated with a particular entry in one of the fields this is called filtering Restriction You can report only on custom fields that are associated with transactions that is a customer vendor employee or item that uses the field must appear on a transaction Reports cannot show which names on a list Customer Job Vendor Employee are associated with a particular custom field 1 From the Reports menu choose the type of report you d like to create 2 Inthe report window click Filters 3 Choose the custom field you want to use from the Add filter list 4 Enter the information you want to restrict the report to For example if one of your custom fields is Color and you wanted the report to show only sales of navy blue items enter navy blue in the Color field Tips and tricks Quick Add and Setup You can add to any of your QuickBooks lists while you are in the middle of another task For example if you re writing an invoice to a new customer and you type your new customer s name in the Cus
348. st of Goods Sold QuickBooks calculates the cost by using the average cost of the items in stock at the time of sale o Preferred Vendor Enter the name of your preferred vendor for this item This information appears on the stock status report and the physical inventory worksheet 6 Fill in the Sales Information you show to customers QuickBooks uses the sales description and sales price on invoices cash sales and credit memos relating to this item o Description on Sales Transactions You can edit the description on any sales form o Sales Price If your sales price varies you can leave the field blank o Taxable Select this checkbox if you charge sales tax for the item When you make a taxable sale QuickBooks will calculate tax on the item o Income Account Enter the name of the income account you want QuickBooks to use to track the income you earn from sales of this item 7 Fill in the Inventory Information for easy reordering of stock o Asset Account Select a different inventory asset account if you don t want to use the default account If you use the same account for all your inventory items the balance of this account will show the total value of your entire inventory at any one time o Reorder Point Enter the quantity at which you want QuickBooks to remind you to reorder this item This information also appears on the stock status report o Qty on Hand and Total Value a If this is a new item that you a
349. st transactions before you start using QuickBooks Go ahead and start entering current transactions as they occur so you don t get behind Then catch up with historical transactions when you can Try breaking them into digestible chunks like a week or month s worth at a time Remember though that your account balances may be off until you ve entered all the transactions back to your start date Order matters There are two important guidelines to keep in mind as you enter historical transactions Enter transactions in your bank accounts last RockCastle Construction Chart of Accounts This may seem counterintuitive but stay with A Q Filter Accounts me here You want to do this because your Hirter Account Name Type o Balance Accounts Payable and Accounts Receivable 20000 Accounts Payable Accounts Payable 26 636 92 11000 Accounts Receivable Accounts Recei 93 007 93 accounts affect your QuickBooks bank 10100 Checking Bank 46 969 10 10300 Savings Bank 17 910 19 accounts but not the actual account at your 10400 Petty Cash Bank 500 00 P 50100 Cost of Goods Sold Cost of Goods bank So the only bank transactions you ll D SMIDA lt lt icbiccenre e ai aaa have to enter in your bank account are those ES TONAS OE E ae papan that are still missing after you finish entering i as rain a PAR Capita OC ull l transactions for accounts payable accounts me ws 1 receivabl nd payroll
350. steps First create an item receipt to show you received the items Second enter the bill when it arrives Step 1 Create an item receipt 1 Choose Vendors gt Receive Items You can also create an item receipt using the Vendor Center and Transaction Center QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 206 2 To create a new item receipt click the New on the left panel or click the at the bottom of the list To edit an item receipt select it in the list on the left panel If you View don t see this list click the Left View GEJ E 3 Select the name of the vendor you bought the items from 4 Did you write a purchase order for the items o Yes When you click Select PO QuickBooks asks you to enter the name of the vendor you re receiving from then displays a list of open POs for that vendor Select the POs that contain the items you re receiving When you re finished click OK Make any necessary changes to the line items If you didn t receive all the items on the purchase order you can edit the quantity or cost of any item or delete an item completely from the detail area of the Create Item Receipts window Tip If you make a mistake when you are editing the quantities click Receive All to return all quantities to their original values o No Enter the items in the detail area From the Item list choose the first item you are being billed for You can also type the item name directly into the Item column If the item is no
351. sulting e Non inventory Part Materials or parts you buy but don t keep on hand as inventory These can be either part of your overhead for example office supplies or they can be materials you buy to finish a specific job and charge back to your customer e Other Charge Miscellaneous charges that are not services labor materials or parts Examples include delivery fees setup fees and service charges If you have products or services that you both purchase and sell see the information about inventory items and subcontracted services To create items for non inventory sales or purchases 1 Decide whether the new item will represent purchases or sales It CANNOT represent both o Purchases You ll be able to use the item on purchase orders and create purchase reports that show units purchased and amounts spent by item o Sales You ll be able to use the item on sales forms and create sales reports that show units sold and sales by item 2 Choose Lists gt Items 3 Choose New from the Action pop up menu 4 From the Type list in the New Item window choose the item type 5 Enter an item name or number What you enter here appears on the list of items when you are filling out a sales form or purchase order Enter a name or number that will help you distinguish this item from all the others on the list 6 Enter a description of the item The description prefills on sales forms or purchase orders when you use the item Ent
352. t Online Banking Setup Select your financial institution from the list and click Next Sometimes financial institutions present multiple listings one for Direct Connect DC and one for Web Connect WC If you see this be sure to select the WC option If you are prompted to select either Direct connect or Web connect select Web connect and click Next If you do not see the screen go to the next step Click Website to go to your financial institution s website On your financial institution s website find the download area for your account and choose the QuickBooks Web Connect option to download your account statement Your financial institution may call the option Download account activity Download account history or something similar Follow the onscreen instructions to download the file which will have a qbo file extension Contact your financial institution for more information In QuickBooks choose File gt Import gt From Web Connect select the qbo file you want to import and then click Open For each account shown in the Web Connect file select the QuickBooks account you want to associate with it and then click Continue The account pop up menu shows available QuickBooks banking accounts if the account you are importing transactions from is o achecking savings or money market account o available QuickBooks credit card accounts if you are importing transactions froma credit card
353. t gt Addresses To Text File 2 Inthe Select Addresses for Export window choose the names you want to merge 3 Optional Select the Include jobs checkbox to include the jobs associated with the customers you selected Select this checkbox ONLY if there is a different name or address for each job If the customer name and address are the same for each job QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 42 leave the checkbox clear otherwise you ll end up with duplicate form letters to the same name and address 4 Click OK 5 Enter a filename for the names and addresses you selected The file is a tab delimited file that contains name and address information for the names you selected Notes e Each piece of information in a mail merge data file has a field name that you can use in a form letter For example the First Name field inserts the first name of each person when you print copies of the letter Some of the fields let you use parts of an address instead of the entire address For example you can use the City field to mention a person s city within a sentence QuickBooks also provides fields for placing the full block address at the beginning of a letter Inactive list entries When you mark a list item as inactive it is hidden in any windows that use that list For example an inactive item from the Items list will be hidden in the Create Invoices window Inactive list items still appear in reports and transactions When y
354. t charge as 2 00 o Edit the item description in the Memo field so that it shows what you want your customer to see on the printed statement For example you could add the phrase Balance due for to the beginning of the item description o Check the date of the charge If necessary change the date so that it falls within your next billing period 3 Click Record 4 When it s time to bill your customer again print the customer s statement The statement should include the adjustment charge along with any other charges for the billing period Including reimbursable expenses on a statement If you have been tracking billable expenses or hours for a particular job you can include those costs on a billing statement To include the costs you click the Time Costs button in the customer s register To include reimbursable expenses on a billing statement 1 Open the appropriate customer register Important If the Customer Jobs list shows more than one job for the customer be sure to select the correct job QuickBooks maintains a separate register for each job 2 Inthe customer register click Time Costs 3 Indicate how you want to date the statement charges it creates for the costs you select o Dates from table below Use the original date of each cost If the dates occurred BEFORE the date of the last statement you sent to your customer you may want to use the This date option instead When you print a statement QuickB
355. t on your list QuickBooks asks you to set it up In the Qty column enter the quantity you received If necessary edit the cost of the item Repeat these steps for the other items you received 5 Click Save Step 2 Enter a bill when you receive the goods 1 Choose Vendors gt Enter Bill for Received Items You can also create an item receipt using the Vendor Center and Transaction Center 2 Inthe Receive Bill for Items window enter the vendor name in the Vendor field and press Tab 3 Click the item receipt associated with this bill and then click OK QuickBooks changes the item receipt to a bill 4 If necessary change the date shown on the bill the date shown is the date you entered the item receipt 5 Inthe detail area of the bill correct any costs or amounts if necessary 6 Optional Enter any additional expenses such as freight charges or sales tax First click Expenses and then for each expense enter the amount and relevant expense account in the detail area of the Expenses tab 7 Fill in the vendor s terms QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 207 8 Be sure the amount shown in the Amount Due field equals the total on the bill If the amounts disagree click Recalc QuickBooks then adds up all the amounts in the detail area and inserts their total in the Amount Due field Other things to know about bills and item receipts View payment history for the invoice Click history to see the payments for this in
356. t panel or click the at the bottom of the list To edit an payment select a payment in the list on the left panel and edit the information 3 Select or enter the information at the top of the Payments window o Customer job If the payment is for a single job choose the customer s name as well as the job if the payment is to be applied to multiple jobs just choose the customer s name The open invoices and statement charges for the customer you select appear on the Payments widow o Date QuickBooks automatically enters today s date You can enter a different date if needed o Amount When you enter the amount QuickBooks applies the amount to the invoices listed beginning with the oldest invoice The amounts QuickBooks applies appear in the Payment column Note You can set QuickBooks so that it does not apply the payment automatically To do this choose QuickBooks gt Preferences click Sales amp Invoicing and then clear the Automatically apply payments checkbox o Pmt Method The way your customer is paying you You can manage what appears on this menu with the Payment Methods list o Check No If your customer is paying you by check enter the check number 4 Select the outstanding invoices and charges you re receiving the payment for by clicking in the column on the far left A check will appear next to the invoice or charge You can double click any invoice or charge to open and make changes 5 Choose how you wa
357. t press Command A to select the entire list e Control click an account name to access a shortcut menu to common tasks 10100 Checkin 10300 Savings Help 10400 Petty Ci New Account R 12000 Undepo 12100 Invento Use 12800 Employ QuickReport 13100 Pre pai Make Account s Inactive 13400 Retaina Reconcile Adding subaccounts Subaccounts let you track several related types of income or expenses independently yet keep them all under the umbrella of a single parent account For example if your business has substantial advertising expenses you could divide your Advertising expense account into several subaccounts Advertising Directing Mailings Newspaper Ads Signs Yellow Pages Listing Your reports will now show subtotals for the various ways that you advertise as well as the total for all of your advertising To add a new subaccount 1 Create a new account as described in the previous section The account type must be the same as the parent account For example if the parent account is an expense account the subaccount must be an expense account also 2 Select the Subaccount of checkbox 3 From the list choose the account that you want to be the parent account 4 Click OK To turn an existing account into a subaccount 1 Choose Lists gt Chart of Accounts QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 52 2 Select the account you want to make a subaccount an
358. t when the note s reminder date arrives QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 84 e Add a reminder to your To Do notes by editing Notes for a customer In the Customer Center select the customer name and click Edit Notes in the top right corner e You can view your reminders including your To Do list on your Company Snapshot or by clicking Reminders on the toolbar e When you ve completed a To Do note edit the note and mark the To Do note as Done e View notes when you are using the customer or job in a transaction by choosing Edit gt Notepad QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 85 Contact Sync Carry your QuickBooks contact lists customers vendors employees other names wherever you go by synchronizing with Address Book Contact Sync syncs your contact information in QuickBooks with Apple s Address Book and your mobile devices When you make changes in QuickBooks Address Book or your mobile devices the change is synced between the programs and devices Once Contact Sync is set up syncing is all automatic Note Even though you may have used Contact Sync in a previous version of QuickBooks be sure to turn on Contact Sync again How do use it To use Contact Sync you first turn on Contact Sync and then you tell QuickBooks which contacts you want to sync To learn more about how Contact Sync works be sure to read Things to know Step One Turn on Contact Sync 1 Choose Company gt Contact Sync Se
359. tax agencies is important That will guide you as to whether something is taxable Either way if an item ora customer is taxable be sure you use that Taxable checkbox When you sell something apply tax to a sale When you fill out an invoice or sales receipt with taxable items the bottom of the form automatically shows the tax item QuickBooks uses that tax item to calculate the tax for the sale The tax amount appears on the form below the other line item amounts If you need to apply a different tax to the sale select a different tax item from the list on the sales form QuickBooks then recalculates the tax by using the rate for the tax item you selected Find out how much tax you owe As you write invoices and sales receipts QuickBooks automatically tracks how much tax you owe in your Sales Tax Payable account When it s time to pay your tax agencies you need to know what you owe and to whom To view your tax liability choose Reports gt Vendors amp Payables gt Sales Tax Liability The report shows your total taxable sales as of a date you choose the total nontaxable sales and the amount you owe each tax agency Pay your tax agencies When it s time to pay your sales tax choose Vendors gt Pay Sales Tax to see how much you currently owe to each tax agency You can then write a check to each agency Once you ve paid QuickBooks automatically updates your Sales Tax Payable account In a nutshell that s how sales tax
360. te Invoices e If you have received full payment at the time of sale choose Enter Sales Receipts Creating a sales summary If you don t need to track cash sales for each customer you can record all your cash sales for a specific period of time on a single cash sales receipt The cash sales receipt acts as a summary of your sales for that period of time First create a sales summary template 1 Choose Customers gt Enter Sales Receipts 2 Fill in the form as follows o Leave the Customer Job field blank o If you track sales by payment method enter a method cash check etc in the Pay Method field o Inthe detail area enter all the items you normally sell on a given day week or month whatever period you plan to summarize o Leave the Quantity column blank since you ll be filling it in at the end of the specified period 3 Choose Edit gt Memorize Sales Receipt 4 Inthe window that appears enter a descriptive name for template for example Daily Sales Summary 5 Click OK to add the template to your Memorized Transaction list 6 If you track sales by payment method select a different payment method and memorize the template again Repeat this step until you have covered all the payment methods 7 Click Cancel to close the Enter Sales Receipts window Do not record the transaction Then use the template to create sales summaries 1 Choose Lists gt Memorized Transactions QuickBooks for Mac 20
361. te one 3 Enter the date the rate is effective and the rate 4 Click OK QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 139 Categorizing for more insight into your business QuickBooks provides several different ways for you to categorize information to get better insight into what s going on in your business Customer and job types When you re running reports would it help to know what group of customers is generating the most sales If you knew that then you could identify areas to focus your business You can do this with customer types For example if you have categorized your customers by market segment you Can create a separate sales report for each segment Customer types are just a category of customer that means something to you Once you have assigned a customer type to each customer in the Customer Center you can create reports that organize the data by customer type To create a customer type choose Lists gt Customer amp Vendor Profile gt Customer Type Then when you can assign the customer type to a user in the Customer Center Examples of customer types Here are some examples of customer types that might be useful to you By industry Manufacturing Financial Technology Publishing Health Care Banking e Different types of clients you serve Corporate Individual Non Profit Government e How a client was referred Other Client Advertising Colleague Knowing the sources of client referrals can help
362. tement Period Includes transactions that occurred in this date range will be in the statement o All Open Transactions as of Statement Date Includes all transactions up to the Statement Date on the statement You can limit those transactions to include only those past due a certain number of days 5 Select the customers you want to print statements for QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 104 o All Customers Prints statements for all your customers o Selected Customer Click Select and choose the customers you want to print statements for o One Customer Select one customer from the dropdown list o Type of Customer Select the type of customer to print statements for 6 If you want to print a separate statement for each customer or job select Customer or Job for Create one statement for each Otherwise QuickBooks prints a consolidated statement for each customer or job 7 Choose any additional options you want o Show invoice item details Includes details of invoice items sold to the customer on the statement o Print by billing address zip code If you are printing statements not emailing them prints the statements in order of the billing address zip code o Print due dates on transactions Includes the due date of each transaction on the statement 8 Sometimes you may not want some statements to print You can tell QuickBooks to exclude statements that meet these criteria o Statements with a zero balanc
363. the distribution line is the last item of an invoice item group AUTOSTAX ldentifies a sales tax item as the automatic tax rate you set up for your QuickBooks company Vendor list VEND Import and export files can contain all the information in your Vendor list The keyword for the Vendor list is VEND NAME Required The name of the vendor TIMESTAMP Export files only A unique number that identifies the company file from which you exported the Vendor list REFNUM Export files only A unique number that identifies an entry in the list PRINTAS The name you would like checks to be made out to This field allows you to make checks out to a different name than the name that appears on your Vendor list ADDR1 5 The vendor s address VTYPE Your classification for the vendor QuickBooks calls this a vendor type If you import a vendor type that is not on your Vendor Type list QuickBooks adds the new vendor type to the list CONT1 The name of your primary contact with the vendor PHONE1 The vendor s phone number PHONE2 The vendor s alternate phone number FAXNUM The vendor s FAX number NOTE A short note or phrase you want to associate with the vendor QuickBooks automatically puts your note in the Memo field of checks you send to the vendor TAXID The vendor s tax identification number QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 272 LIMIT TERMS NOTEPAD SALUTATION COMPANYNAME FIRSTNAME MIDINIT LASTNAME
364. the order as a pending sale When the customer pays for the order mark the sale as final Draft approval When you need approval for a billing draft before you permanently enter it into QuickBooks enter the draft as a pending sale When the draft is approved mark the sale as final Pending sales do not appear in registers do not affect account balances and with the exception of the pending sales report do not affect reports To mark a sale as pending 1 When you ve finished filling in the invoice or sales receipt choose one of these commands from the Edit menu Mark Invoice As Pending An invoice Mark Sales Receipt As Pending A sales receipt Mark Credit Memo As Pending A credit memo 2 When you choose the command the word Pending appears on the form 3 Optional Enter a phrase like Pending sale or For review in the Customer Message field To mark a sale as final 1 Open the transaction you want to mark as final The Pending Sales report is a handy way to find these transactions You can just double click the transaction on the report to open it 2 Choose Edit gt Mark As Final 3 Ifyou used the Customer Message field to indicate that the sale was pending edit the Customer Message field For example if you entered Pending sale you could edit the Customer Message field to say Final sale QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 112 When a customer pays you Yay Money Now
365. tions cleared plus any changes made to those transactions since the reconciliation report side by side 2 Compare them Look for differences For a transaction that was cleared in the PDF report but that isn t cleared in the live report 1 Open the account s register 2 Mark the transaction as cleared For a transaction with an incorrectly changed amount 1 Open the transaction 2 Change the transaction so its amount to match what it was in the previous reconciliation report QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 197 CHAPTER 8 selling things If you re in the business of selling things you probably acquire inventory and then sell it to your customers In this chapter l II show you how to use the inventory features in QuickBooks and how to track the sales tax you ll need to pay for the items you sell Inventory Selling stuff Great QuickBooks for Mac s inventory features can help you Here s an overview of what you can do to track Inventory in QuickBooks e Set up QuickBooks to track inventory There are a few steps you need to complete to track inventory in QuickBooks turn on preferences set up your items and set up your accounts Buy your inventory Whether or not you use purchase orders there are three ways to record the inventory items you receive depending on how you pay for the items o Buy items over the counter Write a check or enter a credit card charge to track this in QuickBooks o Receive items wit
366. tly into QuickBooks After setting up Direct Connect you can automatically import transactions without having to go through the set up process again Before you can use Direct Connect you must contact your financial institution to activate your account for use with QuickBooks online services The account with your financial institution must be a business account Your financial institution may charge you a fee for using this service If you are unable to set up Direct Connect successfully try using Web Connect instead To set up Direct Connect 1 Choose Banking gt Online Banking Setup 2 Select your financial institution from the list and click Next Sometimes financial institutions present multiple listings one for Direct Connect DC and one for Web Connect WC If you see this be sure to select the DC option 3 If you are prompted to select Direct connect or Web connect select Direct connect and click Next If you do not see the screen go to the next step 4 Select Yes if you have activated your account for QuickBooks online services and click Next If you have not activated your account select No and then click Next to see the contact information for your financial institution The next steps depend on how your financial institution works with Direct Connect To continue click the option below that describes what you see you on your screen I m asked to enter my customer ID and password 1 Enter the custo
367. to be reimbursed by a customer enter the customer in the Customer Job column Billable Time An icon appears indicating this is billable time If it s not click the icon so that an X appears over it e Class To assign the amount to one of your QuickBooks classes enter it in the Class column Note This column only appears when you have selected the Use Class Tracking preference choose QuickBooks gt Preferences gt Transactions QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 160 Listing items included in a bill On the Enter Bills window use the Items pane at the bottom of the window to enter details about items you re being billed for eee Enter Bills Ltit LB La Prev Next History Clear Splits Recalc Q Filter GED crecit Y Bill Received Patton Hardware Supplies z T T ji k ite Summary s dp New Bill Phone 415 555 1370 Patton Hardware Sup 5 064 00 Email 124290723 950357 Open balance 4 479 20 Vu Contracting 1 250 00 Vendor Patton Hardware Supplies gt Date 12 20 13 POs to be received o 12 15 13 Ref No 930357 EE Recent Transactions a Thomas Kitchen amp Bath 585 00 eee er ae 12 15 13 8059 Terms Net 30 Bill Due 01 19 14 1 12 28 13 Bill Check 13 759 00 12 20 13 Bill 5 064 00 Sergeant Insurance 4 050 00 12 15 13 Bill Check 400 00 BS 12 15 13 Bill Check 754 50 Keswick Insulation 670 00 g ona m siao 12 15 13 Expenses 0 00 PU uE EAUS j Notes
368. tomer Job field QuickBooks asks whether you want to Quick Add or Set Up the name e Quick Add Add only the name or item to your list Later if you want to add more information about the name or item you can edit its record in the list itself e Set Up Add additional information about the name or item such as an address or phone number QuickBooks then displays a window where you can enter the information QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 46 CHAPTER 3 Accounts If you were using pen and paper to run your business you might use the old shoebox method of tracking your transactions sorting all your transactions by keeping them in labeled boxes In QuickBooks accounts work kind of the same way Your QuickBooks transactions are associated with an account and your accounts are listed in your Chart of Accounts So your accounts are like the shoeboxes and the Chart of Accounts is like the closet you keep them in Important One mistake new QuickBooks users sometimes make is thinking that their Chart of Accounts lists only bank accounts It s true that your bank accounts are listed in your Chart of Accounts but so are your expense accounts income accounts and others Q We ve got a great video on Little Square that gives you an overview of accounts and why they are important to your business http www qpblittlesquare com 2011 01 video bookkeeping 101 Types of accounts There are two main types of accounts b
369. tory and purchase orders are used preferences in Inventory preferences This works the same as it does for bills 1 Click Select PO and select the PO that 1 contains the items you ve paid for with the charge and click OK 2 Make any necessary changes to the line 2 items If you didn t receive all the items on the purchase order you can edit the quantity or cost of any item or delete an item completely from the detail area of the charge Tip If you make a mistake when you are editing the quantities click Receive All to return all quantities to their original values Other things you should know about credit card From the Item list select the first item you are being billed for You can also type the item name directly into the Item column In the Qty column enter the quantity you received If necessary edit the cost of the item Repeat these steps for the other items you received Track shipping and other charges You can enter shipping charges or taxes not associated with any one item Go to the Expenses pane In the detail area enter each charge and associate it with its correct expense account amount to reflect the change Recalculate the amounts If you make changes to the charge you can recalculate the J Apply a discount to a charge To apply a discount from your vendor select the amount you want to apply the discount to in the Amt Paid column Click Discount Info QuickBooks
370. transaction 8 Click Save To process a customer s debit or credit card If you have an Intuit Merchant Services account you can process your customer s credit or debit card on the Receive Payments window 1 Be sure you select a credit card for the Payment Type 2 Be sure the Process credit card checkbox is selected 3 Enter the card information 4 Click OK You ll see a confirmation when the transaction is complete Other things to know about receiving payments Create a credit memo If the payment is less than what your invoice is for you may owe your customer money If that s the case click Credit Memo to record the credit or issue a refund Ej view payment history for the customer Click History to see the payments from the customer you selected 2 Add deposit reminder to iCal or Calendar Click the button to add a reminder to yourself to deposit the payment View the credit card information for the customer If you are using Intuit Merchant Account Service to charge customer credit cards you can click Charge Info to see the credit card information of this customer you selected Accepting your customer s credit and debit cards With an Intuit Merchant Services account you can accept your customer s credit and debit cards as payment for transactions QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 117 Q View a tutorial It says QuickBooks 2010 but all the info is still good Don t get me started sigh
371. transaction in QuickBooks e How can find a credit card transaction processed in QuickBooks A credit card transaction is like any other transaction in QuickBooks You can find it Transaction Center or in the transactions list for a customer in Customer Center Just click on the title to open up the transaction e How can I get more details about my credit card transactions Your online Merchant Service Center is the place to go Here s how you get there o On the toolbar on the Home Page click the Merchant Service icon If you ve customized your toolbar or Home Page you may not see this icon o In Customer Center edit a customer On the Payment Info pane double click the transaction o Go to https merchantcenter ptcfe intuit com qbmsmac QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 119 You ll need your Merchant Service username and password You created these when you first signed up for your Merchant Service account Entering your customer s credit debit card information When you re processing a customer s credit or debit card QuickBooks asks you for the card information You can either swipe the credit card with a USB card reader or enter the information manually Important You should always swipe the credit card when you have it in hand even if you already have the credit card on file Only transactions from a card swipe are eligible for a lower discount rate Card swiped rate requires the card reader issued by Intuit Mercha
372. transactions talk about here I ll tell you where to enter the others Remember you only need to enter the transactions between your company file s start date and today OK now start entering your sales transactions in this order Be sure to enter the correct transaction date for each one QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 18 e Estimates If you use estimates you ll need to first turn on this feature Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences and select Sales and Invoicing to turn on estimates Then go back to the Home page and click Estimates The estimates you create will be the basis for other sales transactions such as invoices You don t have to enter estimates for jobs or sales you didn t get unless you just want a record of them e Invoices Click Create Invoices and create a copy of each invoice you ve written between your company file s start date and now Be sure you enter items in the Item field so QuickBooks can track your sales in the correct accounts Sales receipts for cash sales If you were paid for work or goods on the spot you probably gave your customer a sales receipt Click Sales Receipts and enter copies of your sales receipts from your start date until today Be sure to enter the amount of each item you sold and received payment for at the time of sale You can also enter multiple sales on one sales receipt form if you don t track sales by customer If possible group them so that the money received f
373. ttings 2 Select Use Contact Sync and click Apply QuickBooks creates a group in Address Book named QuickBooks CompanyFileName All your contacts in the current company file will be organized in this group Note The first time you sync a company file with Address Book QuickBooks will prompt you that it is making a backup of your Address Book file before syncing You can choose to cancel Contact Sync skip the backup or continue with the backup and turning on Contact Sync Step Two Sync your contacts 28 Customer Groups 1 After turning on Contact Sync go to any list of names such as the customer list in Customer Center Click bel a Custo CustomerJob S Balance Total gt Abercrombie Kristy 0 00 2 Control click one or more names and choose Sync With b Allard Robert saan Babcock Sa Hel Address Book perc Hele gt Balak Mi New Customer gt Barley i Add Job R s zan New Transaction gt Or edit the name and click Sync at the bottom of the Edit poring Edit CustomerdJob gt Burch Ja F wi n d ow Fe a QuickReport Open Balance Carr s Pie Make Customer Job s Inactive gt Castillo How do I sync all my contacts Sn Select all or multiple names then Control click and choose Sync With Address Book e Command A to select all names No need to click just press Command A to select the entire list e Shift click to select a range of names Select the first na
374. ttlesquare com 2011 05 adding or changing an opening balance QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 59 Changing an account s color When you change an account s color your change affects the account s register and associated data entry forms For example if you make your checking account blue both the register and the Write Checks window for that account will be blue Changing an account s color is useful if you have several accounts of the same type such as two or three checking accounts You may want to make each account a different color to avoid mistakenly writing checks from the wrong account To change an account s color 1 Inthe Chart of Accounts double click the account you want to change to open the register 2 Choose Edit Change Account Color to display a standard color palette like the one shown here 3 Click to select the color you prefer The register or form changes color immediately 4 Click the color palette s close button to dismiss it Note You can only change the color of balance sheet accounts that is accounts with registers Moving a transaction to a different account If you enter a transaction into the wrong account you can easily correct your mistake without having to re enter the transaction To move a transaction to a different account 1 Open the register where you mistakenly entered the transaction 2 Double click the transaction QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide
375. u select You can t split an expense If you REDUCE the amount of an expense QuickBooks assumes that you do not intend to charge your customer for the balance You will not see the balance the next time you display the Choose Billable Time and Costs window for the customer Tracking time If you charge your customers for time you can enter that time in QuickBooks to be included on bills you send your customers Note If you d like to use the free QuickBooks integrated application My Time turn on time tracking QuickBooks gt Preferences gt Time Tracking and then download your copy of My Time Find out more about My Time on Little Square http www qblittlesquare com 2011 04 my time a free app for time tracking Setting up time tracking If you track time you can set the first day of your workweek and choose which time entry form QuickBooks displays when you click the Timesheet button on the toolbar To set up time tracking 1 Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences and click Time Tracking QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 182 2 Be sure that Keep track of time is checked 3 If the first day of your workweek is a day other than Monday choose that day from the First Day of Work Week list QuickBooks adjusts your timesheets so that each weekly period begins with the day of the week you select If a timesheet happens to be open when you make this change the change does not occur in the timesheet until you c
376. u want to edit and choose Edit Customer Jobs from the shortcut menu a Or in Customer Center select the name of the customer you want to edit in the Customer Jobs list and click Edit Customer in the top right corner of the center Note You can click Expand to expand the Customer Jobs list to the full Customer Center 2 Inthe Customer field enter the name of the customer as you d like it to appear on your Customer Jobs list For example if the customer is Hayley Green and you want the list to show last names first you would enter Green Hayley If the customer is a business like Babcock s Music Shop the enter the name that way 3 Continue to enter the information you want to keep on the customer Address pane On this pane enter the contact information for the customer If you entered a business name for the Customer name then you may want to use this area to enter the name of your contact at the business such as the bookkeeper because that s who you ll be sending your invoices to How is are the Email and CC addresses used When you create a form like an invoice you can email that form to your customer QuickBooks uses the email addresses you enter in Email and CC to email that form You can enter multiple addresses in each field separating each address with a comma e What s the difference between Bill To and Ship To o Bill To Enter the address as you want it to appear on printed invoices checks and other forms Clic
377. unique number that identifies an entry in the list QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 273 APPENDIX C Preferences Preferences let you set up QuickBooks to work the way you need it to Use Preferences to do things like set up backups your company information and many other features of QuickBooks Do preferences affect every company file use in QuickBooks If you ve been a QuickBooks user in the past you may be looking for Company Settings in the Company menu These settings are now located in Preferences What about Company Settings used in earlier versions of QuickBooks Nearly all preferences are set for the company file currently open This gives you the freedom to customize QuickBooks per file A few preferences affect how QuickBooks works for all company files To change your preferences 1 Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences 2 Select the preference you want to change 3 To change another preference choose Show All to show all preferences 4 When you re done dismiss Preferences QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 274 1099 preferences 1099s See 1099 preferences to set up to track the amounts you report on 1099 MISC and 1096 tax forms For each category on the 1099 MISC form you can associate one or more of your QuickBooks accounts If a threshold amount is no longer valid for a particular 1099 category you can change the amount To set up 1099 preferences 1 Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences 2
378. use job types without customer types customer types without job types or neither Creating jobs for a customer QuickBooks lets you track each job you do for a customer separately from all other jobs That way your reports can show your income and expenses by job You can add multiple jobs for a customer See how a business owner like you uses jobs http www qpblittlesquare com 2011 01 video introduction to jobs utc_source iph gt Watch a demo of how to create customers and jobs http www qgpblittlesquare com 2011 01 video overview of the customer center utc_source iph To add or edit a job 1 Choose Lists gt Customer Jobs or choose Customer gt Customer Center 2 Select the customer you re doing the job for 3 Click the menu at the bottom of the customer list and click Add Job Or Control click anywhere in the Customer Jobs list and choose Add Job from the shortcut menu 4 Enter the name of the Job 5 To mark a customer as inactive select the Customer is inactive checkbox More info 6 If anything shown in the General Information section is incorrect for this job change it The information QuickBooks fills in comes from your customer s record If you make any changes here the changes affect only this job For example if your customer s billing address is different for this job you can enter the job address without affecting the customer s main address 7 Click the Job Notes pane Enter the
379. ustomer You can create a job to track that project And then good news a few months later the same customer requests another video You can then create a new job for that customer which allows you to separate revenue and expenses for each video project that produce This enables you to understand the profitability have on a per project basis For example tracking Unbilled Costs by Job helps ensure you don t forgot to invoice a customer for additional expenses All the jobs you do for a customer are tracked in the Customer Center Jobs are a super flexible QuickBooks feature which you can use to associate one entity with another for billing and reporting purposes Types of Jobs Job types let you group and subtotal similar jobs on your reports By using them you can determine which kinds of jobs are the most profitable for your business Here are a few examples e In construction Decks Kitchens Bathrooms e In graphic arts Logos Brochures PR In real estate Brokerage Property Management QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 88 How do customer types fit in Customer types let you categorize your customers independently of the types of jobs you do They are useful for grouping your customers into categories that are meaningful to your business Some examples Wholesale and Retail Commercial Residential and Industrial From Advertisement By Referral You can use customer types in addition to job types You can also
380. ut Command comma Command H Option Command H Command Q Option Command N Command O Option Command W Command W Command P Command M Command Control click Command 1 Shortcut Command Z Command X Command C 256 Editing Edit Edit Edit Edit Edit Edit Edit Edit Edit Edit Edit Edit Edit Edit gt Paste gt Insert Line gt Delete Line gt Edit gt New gt Delete gt Memorize gt Transaction History gt Copy Transaction gt Cut gt Go To Transfer gt Show List gt Use Register gt Find Delete character to left of insertion point Increase check or other form number by one Decrease check or other form number by one Cancel QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide Shortcut Command V Command Y Command B Command E Command N Command D Command plus Command vU Option Command C Command X Command G Command L Command R Command F Delete plus key minus key Command period 257 Moving around a window Next field Previous field Report column to the right Report column to the left Report row below or line below in form detail area Report row below or line above in form detail area Customers gt Create Invoices Banking gt Write Checks Reports gt Transaction Journal Display list if cursor is in combo box field like the Customer Job field in the Create Invoices window Note This keyboard shortcut may interfere with the same sho
381. utton does The new toolbar s also totally customizable drag and drop buttons to put the ones you use most where you can find them fastest e Gorgeous new Company Snapshot We ve also revamped the Company Snapshot It s got a whole new look plus it includes the Income Tracker e Search your reports Some QuickBooks reports get really long so what if you need to find one specific fact or figure in a long report We ve made it much easier Just type the words or number you want to find into the Search field and we ll both take you it and highlight it for you in the report e More and better Guide Me We ve put Guide Me assistance bubbles where you need them when you need them Click into a field and Guide Me pops up to tell you how to put the right info into that field Hover over a button and Guide Me pops up to tell you what that button does We ve got Guide Me available in more than 20 features of QuickBooks and we ve put an On Off control at the top right corner of all those features so you can turn it off when you re comfortable using a window and turn it back on when you re exploring new features e And other cool stuff o Choose the info you want to see with customizable columns in the Centers o Adjust your sales tax amounts before you pay o Track more info about your sales reps o Print your bill stubs QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 4 o Print your general journal entries QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide
382. ve applied payment to the er wrong invoice 122 Creating jobs for a customer 89 Setti e etting up for finance charges 123 Tracking items ordered especially for a Assessing finance charges 123 job f 90 Using Intuit PaymentNetwork with Paying subcontractors 90 QuickBooks for Mac 125 Tracking services performed by an Step 1 Set up QuickBooks for Mac to owner or partner 91 work with Intuit PaymentNetwork 125 Estimating work you re going to do 92 Step 2 When you create invoices add a Getting paid for work you ve done 95 link to Intuit PaymentNetwork that your Sending your customer an invoice 95 customer can click to pay you online 125 Invoicing a customer over time progress Step 3 Get paid 125 invoicing 97 Step 4 Download the payment to Modifying your progress invoice 98 QuickBooks for Mac 125 Invoicing groups of customers 99 When you owe a customer 126 Creating a group for batch invoicing 99 Creating a credit memo and refund 126 Sales Batch invoicing 100 Getting paid for time and costs 128 Statement charges 103 Assigning costs or time toajob 129 Entering Statement Charges 103 Invoicing for actual costs 129 Creating Statements 104 Applying a different markup to each Setting up for automatic charge entry 105 expense 432 Memorizing charges for new customers Tracking time 132 107 Setting up time tracking 132 Correcting overcharges on statements107 Which way should you enter time 133 Correcting undercharges on statements Fillin
383. venient and slow you down In multiuser mode you both can work in your company file at the same time How does it work One computer is set up with QuickBooks Server QuickBooks and your company file Then with f QuickBooks Server running the company file is shared with other computers on the same network When other g QuickBook IckBook users open QuickBooks on their computer they will be meee e Seis able to open the company file and work on it Note You must buy a multiuser license of QuickBooks 4 4 4 add users to your current license or buy multiple pi _ coon ee copies of QuickBooks to use it in multiuser mode To P3 ER m add users open QuickBooks and choose QuickBooks gt Manage License gt Buy Additional Licenses What do you need A license of QuickBooks with more than one user You can buy QuickBooks for more than one user or you add user seats to the license of QuickBooks you already have QuickBooks gt Manage Licenses gt Buy Additional Licenses In addition QuickBooks will also allow for different registered copies of QuickBooks to work together e One computer to use as the QuickBooks Server This computer will host the company file for all your QuickBooks users Find out what you should consider when picking which computer to user for your server QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 28 Setting up multiuser Ready for multiuser Here s what you do to get it going Step
384. voice Clear how you ve split the bill or item receipt by items and expenses Click Clear Splits to clear the items on the Expenses and Items panes on the bill Recalculate the amounts If you make changes to the bill you can recalculate the amount due to reflect the change Add payment reminder to iCal or Calendar Click the iCal button to remind yourself BBE to pay the bill QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 208 Receiving items with a bill included If the items arrive with a bill you can enter your receipt of the items and the bill in a single step To receive items with a bill included 1 Choose Vendors gt Receive Items and Enter Bill Note You can also receive items and enter a bill using the Vendor Center and Transaction Center Enter the vendor s name the amount due date reference number bill statement or invoice number and your vendor s payment terms Optional Enter a memo about the bill The memo you enter appears on reports that include the bill If you pay the bill by check and you did not enter an account number when you set up the vendor s record QuickBooks puts the memo in the Memo field of the check If you did enter an account number the account number appears in the Memo field of the check Click the Items tab Did you write a purchase order for the items o Yes When you click Select PO QuickBooks asks you to enter the name of the vendor you re receiving from then display
385. w a link to the QuickBooks for Mac online forum and or to an online form for submitting feedback 6 Finance Charges preferences Finance Charges Financial Charges preferences determine how QuickBooks applies charges to overdue customer balances for the current company file 1 Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences 2 On the Preferences pane select Finance Charges 3 Set the preferences described below 4 Close the Preferences window Annual Interest Rate Enter the interest rate percentage to use to calculate finance charges For example enter 12 5 if your rate is 12 5 Minimum Finance Charge Enter a minimum finance charge if you want to apply a finance charge regardless of the amount overdue Grace Period Enter a grace period in days before finance charges apply The grace period delays the starting date for assessing finance charges For example if the starting date would have been June 1st and the grace period is 3 days QuickBooks uses June 4th as the starting date e Finance Charge Title Change the title of the finance charge e Calculate Charges from Select either Due Date or Invoice Date o Due Date Use the date an invoice is due as the starting point for assessing finance charges For example for a customer who has 30 days to pay an invoice but is five days overdue QuickBooks assesses finance charges for 5 overdue days but not the original 30 days o Invoice Date Use the date you write an invoice as the sta
386. want to be able to reconcile my account but my bank account opening balance is from the statement prior to my company file s start date If I m only supposed to enter transactions between my company file s start date and today what do I do In this case go ahead and enter all the unrecorded checks and deposits from the period between your statement date and your company file s start date This will make sure that your bank account balance is correct Entering your bank transactions QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 20 Now you re ready to go Enter all your unrecorded bank transactions the ones not already in the bank account register asked you 2 to look at earlier in this article between your company file s start date and today You can use the Reconcile Banking area on the Home page to enter many of these transactions Be sure you o use the actual transaction date rather than today s date You can enter these transactions in any order Checks Choose Write Checks and enter all miscellaneous checks that aren t already in your register Be sure you enter the actual check i number in the No field Enter Credit Since you ve already Card Charges written these checks click to clear the To Be Printed check box e f the check is for an expense select the expense account at the bottom of the check e f the check is a payment for a liability you track for example a loan ent
387. when you click Next on the Create Invoices window but there are no more invoices to show e Memorize sound Choose the sound you want to hear when you memorize something in QuickBooks like a bill you ve entered or a report e Volume Slide the volume bar to increase or decrease the volume level of the sounds e Open Sounds Folder If you want to add your own sounds click this button to open the sounds folder Copy the sound file you want to use to this folder QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 291 2 O _ tm ime Tracking preferences Tracking Time tracking preferences set up how time tracking works in QuickBooks 1 Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences 2 On the Preferences pane select Time Tracking 3 Set the preferences described below 4 Close the Preferences window Note If you d like to use the free QuickBooks integrated application My Time turn on time tracking and then download your copy of My Time Keep track of time Turns on time tracking in your company file Track your time and or your employee s time by entering hours worked on weekly timesheets or single activity entry forms you can use the two forms interchangeably You can also assign time to particular customers or jobs bill hours back to your customers and create time reports that show how your company allocates and uses time You ll see time tracking items on the Employees menu a Timesheet button on the toolbar and four time related reports on the
388. with the Merchant Service for QuickBooks by email over the phone or by similar means All you need is the customer name the customer s address the card number and the expiration date This processing method gives you more flexibility for example you can accept credit card payments over the phone and enables you to download your payment transactions directly into QuickBooks However using this method also means that you as the user of the merchant account have full responsibility for safeguarding against fraudulent transactions To help reduce the amount of fraud the Merchant Service for QuickBooks performs an address verification check for each credit card transaction by comparing the customer address you enter with the credit card bank records Processing credit and debit cards FAQ If you re processing credit and debit cards in QuickBooks you may have a lot of questions The answers below may help You can also check the QuickBooks for Mac support site and community site for your answers e If remove a credit card number what happens to the transactions associated with that card They re still there QuickBooks maintains a record of all transactions for a customer You can still click on the transaction in the Transaction Center which will take you to the online Merchant Service Center where you can view your full transaction detail e If void a credit card payment what happens It s like it never happened You won t see the
389. wnloads using DirectConnect or WebConnect However transactions can only be added to the account register One at a time and not as many financial institutions support QuickBooks for Mac Full list Online Bill Pay QuickBooks for Mac currently doesn t support online BillPay Price levels QuickBooks for Mac currently doesn t support price levels Reports QuickBooks for Windows has more reports than QuickBooks for Mac Premier and Enterprise versions There s only one version of QuickBooks for Mac Inventory QuickBooks for Mac does not have units of measure or assembly items Multicurrency QuickBooks for Mac does not support multicurrency QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 23 Converting your file from Windows So you re switching from QuickBooks for Windows to QuickBooks for Mac Welcome We re glad you re here So you re probably wondering if you can convert your QuickBooks for Windows company file into QuickBooks for Mac The answer is Yes You can convert any company file from U S 2012 2013 and 2014 versions of QuickBooks Simple Start Pro Premier and Premier Accountant Edition for Windows If you are using a QuickBooks for Windows version that is earlier than 2012 you can still open your file in QuickBooks for Mac It ll just be a couple of steps more An article on our support site explains exactly how to do this http www gblittlesquare com 2010 07 winmac Before you start be sure that you re famil
390. works in QuickBooks If you need more detail on using any of the features in this article the Help in QuickBooks gives you step by step instructions Setting up tax rates and agencies If you collect one tax for one agency you may have already set up your sales tax rate and agency when you created your QuickBooks company If you did not complete the first and third steps listed below If you collect several taxes Step 1 Create a tax item for each single tax you apply See page 73 QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 215 Step 2 Set up tax groups if needed See page 73 Step 3 Identify your most common tax Identifying your most common tax rate If you use one tax or tax group more often than any other you can automatically apply that tax when you enter a sale If you set up a tax item when you created your company file QuickBooks uses it as your most common tax To use a different tax item or group as your most common tax follow the procedure below To identify your most common tax rate 1 Choose QuickBooks gt Preferences and click Sales Tax 2 Select the Customers are charged sales tax checkbox 3 Choose whether you pay sales tax monthly quarterly or annually This choice sets up the period of time covered by your sale tax reports 4 Choose when you owe tax to this tax agency o As of invoice date You are liable for tax from the moment you write an invoice or make a sale accrual basis o Up
391. x transaction o Taxes you record on invoices and sales receipts appear as increases and payments you make to tax agencies appear as decreases o The ending balance of the register is your current tax liability To get more information e To see a list of all the transactions that involve a particular tax agency select any transaction in which the agency s name appears Then choose Reports gt QuickReport e To see the details of a transaction in which you charged or paid sales tax double click the transaction Paying sales tax Now it s the dreaded time time to pay your sales tax But you ve been tracking everything in QuickBooks so at least you have an accurate picture of what you owe To pay sales tax 1 Choose Vendors gt Pay Sales Tax 2 Ifyou have more than one checking account choose the checking account from which you want to pay the tax 3 Check the date that QuickBooks shows in the Show sales tax due through field If necessary edit the date To change your sales tax period choose QuickBooks gt Preferences click Sales Tax from the Show pop up menu and then set how you pay sales taxes Monthly Quarterly or Annually 4 Inthe detail area select the tax agencies you want to pay 5 To select agencies individually click in the Pay column 6 To select all the agencies click Pay All Tax 7 To make a partial payment to an agency edit the amount that QuickBooks shows in the Amt Paid column
392. y Timesheet 2 Inthe Name field enter the name of the person who performed the work 3 If the week you want to see is not the current week change the date range of the timesheet o To change to the previous week click Prev Week to change to the next week click Next week o To change to any other week click Set Date and enter a date in the week you want to display 4 Change as needed the entries for that week To edit a single activity entry 1 Choose Employees gt Time Tracking gt Enter Single Activity 2 Press Prev until the entry you want appears 3 Change as needed any of the information shown What happens if you change the time QuickBooks lets you change the time you originally entered but it won t update any transactions based on that time The same is true for the other parts of a time entry customer or job name or service item QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 137 Tracking mileage Mileage is a common expense for a lot of businesses You can either charge customers for mileage you drive while doing business with them or you can deduct your mileage from your taxes To manage your list of vehicles Before you can enter mileage you need to add each vehicle you are using for your business to the Vehicle list You can come back later and make any changes 1 Choose Lists gt Vehicles 2 Add anew vehicle o Click the at the bottom of the Vehicle list o Control click anywhere in the list an
393. y the amounts 1 Return to the first report you created the 1099 Summary In the report buttonbar click Only 1099 Vendors This report should now include ALL the vendors to whom you send 1099 MISC forms and it should represent ALL the accounts you use to track 1099 related payments The report shows only amounts that are at or above the minimum you must report to the IRS 2 Check the report for amounts that are too low o Inthe report buttonbar click Use Thresholds Choose Ignore Thresholds from the list o Check the amounts in the report Make a note of each amount that seems too low 3 For each low amount do the following o Double click the amount to display the transactions from which QuickBooks calculated the amount A new report appears listing the transactions o Inthe new report check the list of transactions If a transaction is missing from the list it means that you did not assign the transaction to a 1099 account To display QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 166 the transaction in the report click Only 1099 Accounts in the report buttonbar and choose All allowed accounts from the list o Inthe updated list of transactions find the transaction that you want to include in the 1099 total Double click the transaction to display it o Inthe detail area of the transaction find the incorrectly assigned account Change the account to the 1099 account you use to track that type of expense 4 Asa final check
394. ying a credit card bill 172 Managing your checks and credit cards 172 Transaction Center 172 QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide Tips and tricks 173 Editing a check 173 Managing deposits 173 Making a deposit 173 Editing or deleting a deposited payment 175 Entering credit card fees when making a deposit 175 Online Banking 177 Web Connect vs Direct Connect 178 WebConnect 178 DirectConnect 178 Connecting Directly to Online Banking 179 Online Banking Tips and Troubleshooting 180 Manually Importing Online Banking 182 Updating your register 184 Example of updating your register 184 Downloading or importing your transactions 184 What to do with matched transactions 185 What to do with unmatched transactions 185 Other things to know about matching transactions 185 Renaming rules for payee names 186 Renaming rules example 186 Creating a new renaming rule 186 Editing a renaming rule 187 Unlinking a QuickBooks account from an online banking account 188 Reconciling your accounts 189 Before you begin 189 Step 1 Choose the account you want to reconcile 189 Step 2 Mark your transactions 190 Step 3 Finishing Up the Reconciliation 190 Congratulations Viewing and printing reconciliation reports 191 Reconciling fast with Mark All 191 What to do if your account doesn t balance 192 Undoing a Reconciliation 192 Troubleshooting reconciliation 193 What to look for 193 Tips for finding problems 194 Fixing the incorrect amount 1
395. ymentNetwork 3 Follow the instructions on the Preference pane o If you haven t already got an Intuit PaymentNetwork account click Step 1 Sign Up Tip Make sure you pick the bank account you want your customers payments deposited into And be sure to use the email address you want linked up to these payments 4 Back on the Preferences pane click Step 2 Enable IPN 5 Enter the email address you re using on Intuit PaymentNetwork 6 Re enter your email address Click OK 7 If you re planning to use the PaymentNetwork for all your invoices check the Use Intuit PaymentNetwork for all customers box Uncheck the box if you don t want links to IPN added to all your invoices by default Note Don t worry you can change your mind about whether or not you want a link to the PaymentNetwork on any invoice you create Check the help on the Create Invoice window 8 Click the red X at the top of the pane to close Preferences Your choices get saved automatically Can change my Intuit PaymentNetwork email address Yes you can change your Intuit PaymentNetwork email address But Important Before you change your email address either in your Intuit PaymentNetwork account on the web site or here in QuickBooks Preferences you need to make sure you ve got no open invoices or pending payments that use your current email address After you ve made sure you ve got nothing open or pending here s how you change your PaymentNetwork email addres
396. you decide how best to spend your marketing dollars e Different types of clients you serve Residential Commercial Individual This lets you create reports that show exactly where you generate the most revenue e Record a client s market segment Residential Commercial Industrial e By location North Bay South Bay East Bay Local Out of State International e Type of membership Complimentary New Renewal e Job title Marketing Executive Director e Order type Catalog Order Phone Order Internet e Acustomer s age 55 and Under Over 55 You can then track senior citizens who may be eligible for discounts or special mailings e Donation type Donor Patron Corporate Sponsor Subscriber e Frequency of service you provide Monthly Weekly Drop In e By service tier One Time Basic Premium QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 140 By type of rental Sublet Tenant Property Manager A tenant who gets a discount on rent in return for doing some on site residential management such as collecting rent or taking care of small repairs Categorize your jobs Just like customers you can also categorize your jobs To create a job type choose Lists gt Customer amp Vendor Profile gt Job Types You can then categorize the job on the Job Info pane when you edit the customer by choosing one of the job types from the list This gives you much more flexibility when you create reports about your jobs For example i
397. you sell as taxable 217 Assigning a tax rate to a customer 217 Applying tax to a sale 218 Keeping track of how much tax you owe 219 Creating a sales tax liability report 219 Using the Sales Tax Payable register 220 Paying sales tax 220 Adjusting sales tax 221 CHAPTER 9 Finding out how you re doing 222 Income Tracker 222 Company snapshot 222 Information found on the Company Snapshot 224 Tips and tricks 225 Reports and graphs 226 Report Center 226 Customizing your report 227 Adding a filter 227 Types of filters 227 Grouping and subtotaling data 229 Viewing more of a report on your screen 230 Formatting your reports 230 Customize columns 230 Specifying a header or footer 230 Formatting fonts and numbers 231 Reports FAQs 231 Working with graphs 232 Creating a graph 232 Changing the data you see on the graph 232 Hiding data in graphs 233 Seeing the small groups of data that may not show up 233 Other things you can do with reports 234 Memorize a customized report 234 Export a report to Microsoft Excel or Numbers 234 Zoom in for more detail in a report 234 CHAPTER 10 Other cool things about QuickBooks 236 Your toolbar Picking the icons you want 236 Attaching documents and other files to QuickBooks Tips and tricks for attaching files in QuickBooks and using the Attached Documents Library Attachments Center Layout Designer Opening Layout Designer Choosing what goes on a template Formatting a template La
398. you use to track discounts you give to customers You can use either an expense account or an income account When an income account tracks discounts on sales the account is often called a contra income account 8 Indicate whether you want this discount to reduce sales tax when you apply it toa sale o To reduce the tax select the Apply discount before sales tax checkbox This causes QuickBooks to include the discount when it calculates tax on a sale QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 71 o To keep the tax the same clear the Apply discount before sales tax checkbox This causes QuickBooks to exclude the discount when it calculates tax on a sale Creating payment items A payment item subtracts the amount of a customer payment from the total amount of an invoice You need or before a payment item when you receive a partial payment toward the amount of an invoice at the time you create the invoice If you receive full payment at the time of the sale use a sales receipt form instead of an invoice with a payment item To create 1 payment items Choose Lists gt Items Click the at the bottom of the list ut In the Type field of the New Item window choose Payment Enter an item name such as Payment Enter the description that you want QuickBooks to put on your sales forms when you use the payment item Optional Enter the payment method Tip If you enter a payment method you can grou
399. your downloaded transaction You can use renaming rules to rename the payees to the same vendor Renaming rules for payee names When you download or import transactions the names of payees in your downloaded transactions may not match the names of payees in QuickBooks That means you need to go through and match each one with a payee in QuickBooks and that can burn a lot of time you could be doing something more useful QuickBooks makes this a lot easier with renaming rules Renaming rules example Say you re a landscaper and you ve bought supplies from several locations of the Guzman s Nursery When you download or import transactions from your financial institution with the Downloaded Transactions window the names under Downloaded Payees are GUZMAN S NURSERY 010 and GUZMAN S NURSERY 020 and so on It clutters up the payee list and with the all caps it sounds like your payees are yelling at you You can set up a rule so that any transaction with a downloaded payee with the text GUZMAN is renamed to the vendor Guzman s Nursery Creating a new renaming rule When you create a renaming rule it applies to transactions currently listed on the Downloaded Transactions window or future transactions you will download There s two ways to create a renaming rule In either case the first thing you do is choose Banking gt Downloaded Transactions and download or import transactions from your financial institution If QuickBooks recognizes a
400. yout Designer FAQs Budgeting Setting up a budget Graphing a budget Creating reports about your budget Printing in QuickBooks Printing forms credit memos 237 239 240 241 241 242 243 243 244 244 245 245 248 estimates invoices purchase orders and sales receipts Printing checks Printing everything else Troubleshooting printing Emailing forms Adding Email Addresses Adding a Note to the Emails Troubleshooting email Restoring Your Company File from a Backup APPENDIX A Keyboard shortcuts 248 249 250 252 253 253 253 253 254 256 APPENDIX B Intuit Interchange Format 260 Chart of accounts ACCNT Budgets BUD Class list CLASS Customer Type list CTYPE Customer Job list CUST Employee list EMP QuickBooks for Mac 2014 User s Guide 261 262 262 263 263 264 Header information HDR Item list INVITEM Customer Message list INVMEMO Other Names list OTHERNAME Payment Method list PAYMETH Ship Via list GHIPMETH Transactions TRNS and SPL Vendor list VEND Vendor Type list VTYPE APPENDIX C Preferences 1099 preferences Attachments preferences Backup preferences Checks preferences Contact Sync preferences Data Entry preferences Feedback preferences Finance Charges preferences Inventory preferences Jobs preferences Merchant Service preferences My Company preferences 265 265 267 267 268 268 268 272 273 274 275 276 277 278 279

Download Pdf Manuals

image

Related Search

Related Contents

5.3 F 425 S-41/34,F 425 PP  Bedienungsanleitung - HD2_druck  Version PDF : 20 pages, 1 484 Ko.  仕様書  Bosch PRH626B90E hob  Field oriented control of PMSM motor exploiting SLLIMM™ nano  Téléchargez le manuel de directives  SN-360Ⅱカタログダウンロード (PDF 532KB)    Guia da Handycam  

Copyright © All rights reserved.
Failed to retrieve file